Game Design Foundations
Game Design Foundations
Game Design Foundations
Foundations
Roger E. Pedersen
2002154127
CIP
ISBN 1-55622-973-9
10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
0301
All brand names and product names mentioned in this book are trademarks or service marks
of their respective companies. Any omission or misuse (of any kind) of service marks or
trademarks should not be regarded as intent to infringe on the property of others. The
publisher recognizes and respects all marks used by companies, manufacturers, and
developers as a means to distinguish their products.
All inquiries for volume purchases of this book should be addressed to Wordware
Publishing, Inc., at the above address. Telephone inquiries may be made by calling:
(972) 423-0090
Contents
Chapter 1
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
. .
. .
. .
. .
. .
1
1
2
2
2
Chapter 2
Chapter 3
War Stories .
Lesson One . .
Lesson Two . .
Lesson Three .
Lesson Four . .
Lesson Five . .
Lesson Six. . .
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
. .
. .
. .
. .
. .
. .
. .
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
. .
. . .
. . .
. . .
. . .
. . .
. . .
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
. .
. . .
. . .
. . .
. . .
. . .
. . .
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
. . .
. . . .
. . . .
. . . .
. . . .
. . . .
. . . .
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
. . 11
. . . 11
. . . 12
. . . 12
. . . 13
. . . 13
. . . 14
Chapter 4
Game Concepts . . . . . .
Games Are NOT Linear . . . .
Games Have a Goal . . . . . . .
Games Must Be Winnable . . .
Start of the Game . . . . . . . .
Middle/Ending of the Game . .
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
. .
. . .
. . .
. . .
. . .
. . .
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
. .
. . .
. . .
. . .
. . .
. . .
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
. . .
. . . .
. . . .
. . . .
. . . .
. . . .
.
.
.
.
.
.
. . 15
. . . 15
. . . 15
. . . 15
. . . 16
. . . 16
Chapter 5
Game Genres. . . . . . . . .
Action Games . . . . . . . . . . . .
Top-Selling Action Games: . . .
Adventure Games . . . . . . . . . .
Top-Selling Adventure Games: .
. .
. . .
. . .
. . .
. . .
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
. .
. . .
. . .
. . .
. . .
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
. . .
. . . .
. . . .
. . . .
. . . .
.
.
.
.
.
. . 19
. . . 19
. . . 20
. . . 20
. . . 21
.
.
.
.
.
.
. .
. .
. .
. .
. .
. .
. .
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
Contents
Casual Games . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Top-Selling Casual Games: . . . . . . . . .
Educational Games . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Educational Game as an Adventure Game .
Educational Game as a Sports Game. . . .
Top-Selling Educational Games: . . . . . .
Role-Playing Games (RPGs) . . . . . . . . . .
Top-Selling Role-Playing Games: . . . . .
Simulation Games. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Top-Selling Simulation Games: . . . . . . .
Sports (Including Fighting Games) . . . . . .
Top-Selling Sports Games: . . . . . . . . .
Strategy Games . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Top-Selling Strategy Games: . . . . . . . .
Other Games (Puzzles and Toys) . . . . . . .
Top-Selling Puzzle Games: . . . . . . . . .
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
Chapter 6
Game Ideas . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Sports . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Board Games . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Card and Gambling Games . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Simulations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Science . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
History . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Literature . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Authors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Art . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
A Pulitzer Prize-Winning Play Based on a Painting . . . .
Music . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Dance and Instruments. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Movies and Film . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
. . 31
. . . 31
. . . 33
. . . 33
. . . 34
. . . 34
. . . 34
. . . 35
. . . 35
. . . 35
. . . 35
. . . 36
. . . 36
. . . 37
Chapter 7
Research . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Simulation Game: The Survival of the Fittest . .
Homo Erectus . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Neanderthals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Cro-Magnon Man . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Final Thoughts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Classic Game: Poker . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
The Shuffle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Hand Rankings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Poker Variations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Special Considerations . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Strategy Game: The Navy SEALs . . . . . . . . .
History and Facts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
SEAL Platoon . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Platoon Loadout (Uniforms) . . . . . . . . . .
SEAL Weapons . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
SEAL Vehicles . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
. . 51
. . . 57
. . . 57
. . . 58
. . . 58
. . . 59
. . . 60
. . . 60
. . . 60
. . . 61
. . . 63
. . . 64
. . . 64
. . . 64
. . . 65
. . . 65
. . . 66
vi
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
. . .
. . . .
. . . .
. . . .
. . . .
. . . .
. . . .
. . . .
. . . .
. . . .
. . . .
. . . .
. . . .
. . . .
. . . .
. . . .
. . . .
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
21
23
23
23
24
24
25
25
26
27
28
29
29
29
30
30
Contents
SEAL Training . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Break Time . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Navy SEAL Games . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Electronic Arts SEAL Team, 1993 IBM PC-DOS . . . . . .
Zombie Interactives SPEC OPS, 1998 IBM PC . . . . . . .
Yosemite Entertainments Navy SEALs, PS2, and IBM PC .
Novalogics Delta Force . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Novalogics Delta Force 2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Novalogics Delta Force Land Warrior . . . . . . . . . . . .
Novalogics Delta Force: Task Force Dagger . . . . . . . . .
Novalogics Delta Force Urban Warfare. . . . . . . . . . . .
Novalogics Delta Force: Black Hawk Down . . . . . . . . .
Red Storms Rainbow Six . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Red Storms Rogue Spear . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Rogue Spear: Black Thorn . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Rogue Spear: Urban Operations. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Red Storms Ghost Recon . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Ghost Recon: Desert Siege . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Rainbow Six: Eagle Watch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Rainbow Six: Covert Operations Essentials
(aka Covert Ops) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Red Storms Rainbow Six: Raven Shield . . . . . . . . . . .
Sports Game: Baseball . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Baseball Basics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Baseball Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Baseball Games . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Interplay Sports Baseball 2000 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Microsofts Baseball 2001 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Electronic Arts Triple Play Baseball . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Electronic Arts/3DO High Heat Baseball. . . . . . . . . . .
Electronic Arts Triple Play 2002 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
3DO High Heat Baseball 2003 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Acclaim All-Star Baseball . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Acclaim All-Star Baseball 2003 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
66
68
68
68
69
70
71
72
73
75
76
77
77
78
79
80
80
80
81
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
82
82
83
83
84
86
87
89
90
91
93
93
94
95
Chapter 8
Chapter 9
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
. .
. . .
. . .
. . .
. . .
. . .
. . .
. . .
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
. 103
. . 103
. . 104
. . 104
. . 105
. . 106
. . 106
. . 107
vii
Contents
Softimage|XSI (www.Softimage.com) . . . . . . .
Softimage|XSI 3.0 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
NewTek LightWave 7.5 (www.Newtek.com). . . .
Discreet 3D Studio Max 5.0 (www.Discreet.com/
products/3dsmax5/) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Poser 4 by Curious Labs (www.CuriousLabs.com)
LIPSinc Mimic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
NXN Softwares alienbrain (www.Alienbrain.com)
PVCS Merant (www.Merant.com/pvcs) . . . . . .
Rational Software ClearCase (www.Rational.com/
products/clearcase/) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Starbase StarTeam (www.Starbase.com/) . . . . .
Telelogic CM Synergy (www.Telelogic.com). . . .
. . . . . . . . . 107
. . . . . . . . . 109
. . . . . . . . . 110
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
113
114
116
116
118
. . . . . . . . . 118
. . . . . . . . . 119
. . . . . . . . . 119
Chapter 10
Chapter 11
Chapter 12
viii
.
.
.
.
. 127
. . 128
. . 129
. . 130
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
3D Game Engines . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
New Definitions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Economy 3D Engines . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Genesis3D from Eclipse (www.Genesis3d.com) . . . . . . .
Quake Engine GLPd by id Software (1996)
(www.idSoftware.com/Business/Home/Technology/) . . . .
Torque Engine by GarageGames (www.GarageGames.com)
Power Render 4 Engine by Egerter Software
(www.PowerRender.com) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Quake 2 Engine by id Software (1997)
(www.idSoftware.com/Business/Home/Technology/) . . . .
Midsize 3D Game Engines . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
WildTangent Web Driver
(Internet 3D Engine) (www.WildTangent.com) . . . . . . .
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
130
130
131
132
133
134
136
140
142
154
. 165
. . 165
. . 166
. . 166
. . 167
. . 167
. . 169
. . 171
. . 171
. . 171
Contents
WildTangent Multiplayer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Licensing the Web Driver . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
LithTech Game Engine by Monolith (1998)
(www.LithTech.com) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Nocturne Engine by Terminal Reality
(www.TerminalReality.com) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Serious Engine by CroTeam (2000) (www.CroTeam.com)
Unreal Engine by Epic Games (2002)
(www.epicgames.com) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Luxury 3D Game Engines . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Criterion Softwares RenderWare (www.renderware.com)
About RenderWare . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
More About RenderWare Platform . . . . . . . . . . .
More About RenderWare Studio . . . . . . . . . . . . .
NetImmerse 3D Game Engine by Numeric Design Ltd.
(www.NDL.com) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Documentation and Support . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Quake 3 Arena Engine by id Software (1999)
(www.idSoftware.com/Business/Home/Technology/) . . .
. . . 174
. . . 175
. . . 176
. . . 177
. . . 178
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
178
180
180
180
180
184
. . . 186
. . . 188
. . . 189
Chapter 13
Chapter 14
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
. 199
. . 202
. . 203
. . 203
. . 206
. . 206
. . 210
. . 211
Chapter 15
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
. 215
. . 216
. . 217
. . 217
. . 219
. . 220
. . 221
. . 221
. . 223
. . 223
. . 225
. . 227
. . 227
. . 229
. . 231
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
. .
. . .
. . .
. . .
. . .
. . .
. . .
. . .
. . .
. . .
. . .
. . .
. . .
. . .
. . .
ix
Contents
Chapter 16
Testing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 233
Chapter 17
Chapter 18
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
. 247
. . 247
. . 248
. . 249
. . 252
. . 253
. . 253
. . 253
. . 256
. . 256
. . 256
. . 258
. . 259
. . 259
. . 260
. . 260
. . 260
. . 260
. . 260
. . 260
. . 261
. . 262
. . 263
. . 265
. . 266
. . 266
. . 266
. . 269
. . 271
. . 273
. . 275
. . 276
. . 276
. . 276
. . 277
. . 277
. . 277
. . 277
. . 277
. . 277
. . 278
Contents
Credit Screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Statistics Screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
The Prize Vault . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Chips . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Tournament First Prizes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Floor 1: $5,000 Tournament Prizes . . . . . . . . . . .
Floor 1: $25,000 Tournament Prizes . . . . . . . . . .
Floor 2: $25,000 Tournament Prizes . . . . . . . . . .
Floor 2: $100,000 Tournament Prizes . . . . . . . . .
Floor 3: $100,000 Tournament Prizes . . . . . . . . .
Floor 3: $500,000 Tournament Prizes . . . . . . . . .
Special Floor: $2,500,000 World Championship . . . .
Exit Game . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Betting/Raising . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Scriptwriting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Programming . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Basic Poker AI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
The AI to Determine the Best Poker Hand Using
Five to Seven Cards . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Draw Poker (No Openers and Jacks or Better) . . . .
Five Card Stud . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Seven Card Stud, Chicago Lo, and Chicago High . . .
Texas Hold Em and Omaha . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Game Variations Order of Play . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Draw Poker No Openers and Jacks or Better to Open
Five Card Stud . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Seven Card Stud, Chicago Lo, and Chicago High . . .
Texas Hold Em . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Omaha . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
278
278
279
280
280
280
281
281
282
282
283
283
284
284
285
293
294
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
294
295
296
297
300
302
302
303
303
305
305
Appendix A
Appendix B
Appendix C
Appendix D
Index . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 375
xi
Acknowledgments
Special thanks to Wes Beckwith, John Neidhart, Benjamin Foley, Ruth
Pedersen, Megan Pedersen, Michael R. Hausman, Bessalel Yarjovski,
Dorothy Cimo, Dr. Eugelio Joe Gonzalez, The Montvale, NJ Library,
The Waterloo, and IA Library
Professional thanks to (in alphabetical order):
Acclaim EntertainmentAlan B. Lewis
Alias|Wavefront MayaLei Lei Sun and H. Kernahan
CakewalkSteve Thomas
Chris Crawford
Corel CorporationMonica Fergusson
Criterion Software RenderWareChad Barron and Tim Page
Discreet 3D Studio MaxKevin G. Clark
Egerter Software Power RenderChris Egerter
Electronic Arts (EA)Jennifer Gonzalez, Ben Brickman and Steve Groll
Epic Megagames Unreal EngineMark Rein and Tim Sweeney
FMJSoftMarkus Jonsson
GarageGames Inc.Jeff Tunnell
Hollywood EdgeJohn Moran
InterplayKathryne Wahl
JASC ProductsKristin McDuffee and Sandi Scott
Lithtech Monolith EnginePaige Young
NewTek, Inc.Chuck Baker and William Vaughan
NovalogicLee Milligan and Georgina Petrie
Numerical Design Ltd.
The NetImmerse 3D Game Engine
Phantom EFXJim Thompson
Sonic FoundryChristopher C Cain and Trish Monone
Sound IdeasMike Bell
Terminal Reality Nocturne EngineBrett Evan Russell and Jeff Mills
The Art Institute of Chicago (Georges Seurat)Hsiu-ling Huang
The Neanderthal Museum, GermanyPetra Schiller
Ubi SoftClint H.
Walker Boy StudioEric and Chad Walker
Wild TangentAlex St. John and Kelly Enstrom
xii
Chapter 1
Chapter 1
Chapter 2
Pedersens Principles
on Game Design
Since 1983 I have worked in the computer and video gaming industry in
various roles including executive producer, producer, game designer, technical director, and programmer. Throughout the years I have learned many
principles from my years of industry experience. In keeping with my philosophy that game developers should share and exchange information
relevant to our industry, I present ten principles of game design and production that everyone in the industry should be acquainted with.
Chapter 2
progress of the game and be honest about its features, performance, and
other claims that will be made to consumers. These teams must understand the gameplay, its features, and the story line to generate great ads,
media hype, magazine previews, and so on. In return, these nontechnical
team members, by virtue of their continuous contact with the public, provide the game developers with feedback from the public, magazines, and
retail channels about what features are currently hot in games.
The producer needs to facilitate communication between the whole
team and provide timely support for each developer, which includes ensuring that:
n Artists and animators provide artwork, animations, and temporary
placeholders to the programmers on time, until the final artwork is
available
n Programmers provide the artists with current versions of the game so
they can see their artwork in a real-time gameplay mode. The producer
must also make sure that the programmers provide a current version of
the game to the sales, public relations, and marketing teams, along with
various reports about the latest version of the game. These reports
describe gameplay, special features, hardware requirements and supported hardware and peripherals, and contain screen shots that best
portray the product for ads, promotional sheets, previews, and reviews
for magazines. The producer also needs to make sure that programmers work with the quality assurance (QA) testers and provide them
with the play instructions, special key combinations, hints, and undocumented features and actions.
n Audio and sound engineers provide voice, background, and atmosphere
sounds and music. These engineers also need to view and play the current version to check and validate the timing, usage, and clarity of their
work.
n The designer (if not a member of the day-to-day team) sees the current
version to confirm that the product is in line with the design specifications and the concept originally set forth
n The QA testers report problems to the producer. The problems must
be categorized as major (crash, function or action not working), minor
(text misspelling, character movement too fast or slow, response time
feels wrong), glitches (sound or graphic problems), improvements (add
a new feature, improve the characters interaction or behavior, clarify a
confusing aspect of the design or gameplay), a videogame standards
issue (the triangle button does not perform as the standard function
definition), and multiplatform inconsistency (PC version vs. video game
version).
Whether one person assumes the role of both producer and designer or
several people handle these tasks, there must only be one producer whose
word is final, whose decisions are followed, and whose leadership is
trusted and motivating.
Chapter 2
Principle 2: No Designer
or Producer Is an Island
Chapter 2
about the activity, they will gain experience and be able to brag to their
friends and associates, and/or theyll be able to someday beat the game.
Ive received a great deal of fan mail in which consumers have cited the
aspects of my games that they enjoyed. These letters also tell me what
additions to the game they would like to see in future releases. Magazines publish readers letters that praise and criticize the products.
Market research and beta test groups of potential and previous customers can be worthwhile in the final design stages to tweak the product
before its release.
n Are the teams ideas and opinions seriously evaluated in the design of
the product? See Principle #3 for more information about this.
n Can the addition of a feature expand the customer base and get more
publicity? In Villa Crespo Softwares Flicks, a product that reviewed
30,000 films, a field for close-caption was added during the development, instantly adding four million members of the hearing-impaired
and non-English speaking audiences to the products customer base.
Newsletters reaching this consumer sector gave the product free, positive reviews because the product included information vital to their
readership.
The producer should collect information from team members about
improvements that can be made to the product and relay this information
to the designer. The producer must be able to recognize a good idea when
he hears it and implement that idea in the game to make it a better
product.
Designers should be adaptable and open-minded to ideas that can make
their games better. Producers need to be managers, leaders, and diplomats
who are able to take information from others and incorporate good suggestions in the final product. These new ideas must then be communicated by
the producer and understood by all involved.
The producer must not only trust the team members but also rely on
them for input to create the best product.
Chapter 2
Chapter 2
Chapter 2
10
Chapter 2
mechanics of using a Summagraphics tablet and the functions and features of various graphics packages. He learned quickly and produced
some of the finest artwork that CGA (four-color palette) and EGA
(16-color palette) would allow. After the release of this title, he went to
work for a Florida publisher as a computer and video game graphic artist. When the company moved to California, he moved with them. The
last I heard, he was moving on to one of the big publishers as a senior
graphics person.
n A high school student sent me a concept for a game show. The description read well, but the demo he sent me was terrible. Over several
months on the phone, we fixed many of the games rules and aspects of
the gameplay, which greatly improved the game show. I programmed
the game and hired an artist to provide the graphics. When I went to
Villa Crespo Software outside of Chicago, we published this game show,
which we called Combination Lock. The game was fun to play, and it
was the first product to feature on-screen players of all races. The high
school student and I shared in the profits for several years.
The reason I relate these stories is that I want to emphasize the benefit to
those who help budding game developers. When the opportunity to help
someone comes knocking on the door, offer that person hospitality and
kindness. The results will benefit the seeker of knowledge, honor you,
the master, and benefit the industry as more creative thinkers join in.
Chapter 3
War Stories
The following stories are passed down to you as game industry folklore.
The truths they reveal to future game designers are more important than
their accuracy.
Lesson One
In the late 1990s Acclaim Entertainment licensed the movie Batman Forever to be developed as a video game. The movie was to be a major hit
with hot stars like Michael Keaton as Batman, Jim Carrey as the Riddler,
and Tommy Lee Jones as Two Face. At the time, Acclaim was among the
top video game publishers in the world.
When I was hired at Acclaim as producer and then executive producer,
many staff members including producers, assistant producers, and QA
(quality assurance testers) had protested the release of Batman Forever
due to extremely poor gameplay.
Management wanted the game released to coincide with the movies
opening. They felt that the reputation of Acclaim and the anticipated success of the movie would be the selling point and that gameplay was least
important.
The Batman Forever video game almost destroyed Acclaim Entertainment. Their stock plummeted, they lost millions of dollars, and a large
percentage of employees (including the author) were laid off.
Lesson: Nothing is more important than gameplay.
11
12
Chapter 3
Lesson Two
In March 1997 an experienced game designer,
John Romero, from the team that created the
first-person shooter Doom, and his staff (equally
famous and talented) began Daikatana (a Japanese word for big sword).
Like Doom, Daikatana was touted as the next
super game. Its designer, John Romero, was
quoted as saying Daikatana is a super-fast,
Doom-style blast-a-thon. If people dont like it,
they dont need to buy it.
Daikatana was an FPS time-traveling game
that was marketed early on by publisher Eidos Interactive. The ads that
ran in magazines stated, John Romeros about to make you his bitch.
Suck it down. With delay after delay and two years late, reports of staff
conflict and mass exodus of team members didnt help, and the publics
anticipation turned sour. Romeros attitude of Damn the lot of you was
not the way to turn the situation around.
A release in March 1997 of Daikatana would have had the game ahead
of the pack in gameplay and technology (using the Quake 2 engine). Being
released two years later with the Quake 3 engine available, the game
seemed simple and not what one would expect from the hype and its
famous designer from id Software.
Lesson: The Dream Team can easily turn into a dictatorship nightmare.
(See Pedersen Principle 2: No Designer or Producer Is an Island.) A
designer must respect the team and the audience. Hard work and great
gameplay, not hype should be written on the designers wall.
Lesson Three
First Row Softwares The Honeymooners game took a great license and
produced a game with poor gameplay. The game was designed with several mini-games featuring Ralph and Ed. One game had Ralph driving the
streets of New York in his bus picking up various passengers throughout
the city. For some reason, the designers had Groucho Marx as one of the
random passengers. This gimmick not only added nothing to the game,
but the publisher was in violation of copyright and trademark infringements since they had not received permission to use Groucho.
Research and double-check your sources for story lines, artwork, and
sound (especially sound bites).
Lesson: Research is critical and must be accurate. Dont take anything
for granted.
War Stories
13
In Capstone/Intercorps Search for the Titanic, the player reenacts the discovery of the Titanic.
One of the gimmick features of the game was that the first player to
solve the adventure would win a valuable prize. Obviously, the designer
didnt want players winning too soon, so the game was made with one
extremely difficult level of play.
Just before the games release, the licensor, upon learning of the
prize gimmick, demanded that it be removed. The game was released as
a tough, almost impossible adventure to solve.
Reaction: Think of designing a Titanic game with multiple levels from
novice (easy) to championship (prize-worthy tough). Perhaps the player
can master the controls and map out the underwater terrain in the easier
levels. In the harder levels, new areas of exploration open up and there are
new objects to discover.
This multilevel design approach would work whether the prize gimmick was offered or not. For a player to purchase and spend time playing
an extremely tough game is just frustrating and wrong. Players who have
conquered lower levels of play and then are elevated to an extremely
tough level feel they have earned the right to be frustrated.
Design multiple levels and options of play in your game. When heading
toward an iceberg, avail yourself of multiple options well in advance. Having only one option, just a straight path through the iceberg, may leave
you with a sink or swim result.
Lesson: Design multiple scenarios for playing and winning the game.
Dont let gimmicks sell the game, let good gameplay sell it.
Lesson Five
Patton from Broderbund was designed by legendary game designer Chris Crawford. He reasoned
that war games are fun, yet only a small percentage of game players are buying them.
Perhaps that would change if there were a new
type of war game designed for the non-wargaming
audience. If the game were easier to use, different
from the standard hex-based war games, it would
reach a larger base of players.
This seemed reasonable; in fact testers seemed
to confirm these thoughts. So what could possibly
go awry? Well, first, the sales and marketing people failed to express this
new type of war game for the rest of us concept. Next, the magazines
assigned their war game experts to review Patton. These experts were
not the intended audience, so they knocked the game for lacking the
Chapter 3
Lesson Four
14
Chapter 3
standard controls, not having hexes, and lacking the NATO markings.
Then, the expert war gamers warned the novice players away from
Patton.
Lesson: Sometimes the obvious isnt worth anything.
Lesson Six
In the late 1990s Southpeak Entertainment showed me a licensed game
design involving the cartoon The Jetsons.
The Jetsons game was a standard space racing game using the characters as drivers. My response was What a waste of a great license and a
real disappointment for Jetsons fans.
I suggested a Jetsons space road rally game where each player as either
George Jetson, his wife Jane, his daughter Judy, his son Elroy, the dog
Astro, or Rosie the robot housekeeper would navigate their space car
throughout the Jetsons world, looking for clues leading to various objects
to collect.
Licenses attract an audience who know the property, its characters,
venues, storylines, and interactions. Licenses are valuable assets that
need to be exploited as an advantage in your game.
Lesson: Use to your advantage your license and its fans.
Chapter 4
Game Concepts
Games Are NOT Linear
Books and movies are linear forms of storytelling. They have a straight
path from the beginning to the end.
There have been numerous attempts in both mediums to allow the
reader or viewer to select the next path leading to one of several endings,
but I would say these attempts are trying to be more gamelike
(nonlinear).
15
16
Chapter 4
In a multiplayer game, give each player equal strengths and weaknesses at the start. A good game lets each player have an equal chance
and ability to win. You should spend time and pay attention to designing
balance in your game.
Let random events and the players decisions and actions determine
the new game situation (players current position).
Game Concepts
17
Chapter 4
Think of your gamer as the conquering hero who is entering the city to
pay homage to you, the designer, or the parade for the sports team that
has won the national championship, or the audiences excitement and
atmosphere before an encore at a concert.
Chapter 5
Game Genres
When describing a game to others, you must express its genre or type.
Genres can fall into categories like action, adventure, casual, educational,
RPGs, simulations, sports (including fighting games), strategy, and other
(puzzle games and toys). Many games cross genre boundaries (hybrids)
or are truly several genres in one.
Some games, like RPGs or adventure games, have been labeled by the
games point of view (POV). A first-person POV is viewing your environment through the lens of a video camera. A third-person POV has
the players character or persona in view as though a video camera is following the characters movements. In the third-person POV, the video
camera may be stationary (like on a tripod) or free moving, showing various angles of the player. First-person shooter (FPS) is another way to
describe the POV for combat/shooter games like Doom or Quake.
Action Games
Action games are nonstop, finger flying (twitch) games.
In the early games, arcade-style action games involved shooting vector
spaceships to dot-munching balls. Later came platform, rail, or side
scrollers, which dominated the action game genre. Now, FPSs are the
current trend in action gaming.
Action games have always been move, attack, move, react, and move
again type games. They revolve around the gamer who is always central to
the play and in control. During an action game, action is the emphasis, not
storytelling. Action games will use pre-game splash screens and animation as well as interlevel screens to tell their story. Even in an FPS, the
main emphasis is action by fighting, gathering weapons and ammunition,
shields, and objects like health and experience points.
The next genre for the multiplayer masses will be MMFPS (massively
multiplayer FPS) where millions of Internet weapon-toting, truck-driving
fans will swarm planet-sized terrain hunting huge alien monsters the size
of dinosaurs.
19
20
Chapter 5
Adventure Games
Adventure games are quests where puzzles are presented along the
journey.
In the early days of interactive gaming, adventure games ruled. They
were easily ported from the mainframe computer paper output days to the
low-resolution monitors of the 1980s microcomputers.
Gamers (in those days, computer geeks and nerds) loved Tolkien
(author of The Hobbit and Lord of the Rings trilogy) and Star Trek, which
were a prominent part of the first text adventure games from the mainframe era.
Soon many companies were formed and products hit the shelves based
on text adventure games (no graphics, just text and your imagination).
The stories were compelling and addictive.
As the computers advanced with more memory and better graphics,
graphic adventure games appeared and became popular.
Computer gaming fanatics loved solving the designers tricky puzzles.
But eventually the other genres began to win the consumers popularity
contest. In the late 1990s publishers and distributors had an adventure
games is dead attitude.
Hybrid adventure games soon appeared, and out of the ashes several
successful adventure games entered the realm of major hits and
mega-sellers.
In an adventure game, you (the player) start with a limited inventory of
supplies, weapons, and food. You are sent on a quest (to save the princess,
free the slaves being held captive by an evil emperor, or find and return
the Golden Fleece). Along the journey you are presented with puzzles to
solve. The designer can make it an obvious puzzle or hide the puzzle
within the story (but nevertheless its still a puzzle to solve). Usually all
gameplay, storytelling, or advancement is paused until the puzzle is
Game Genres
21
Casual games include games like board games, card games (gambling
games included), and game shows.
Board games can include classic games like chess, checkers, Othello,
and Go, as well as versions of retail board games. Board games are popular
and addictive, as well as commonly known by a wide (mass market) audience. For instance, gamers may buy a chess program even if they dont
play chess just because theyd like to own a chess program (especially one
that everyone is talking about). For the chess enthusiast, they may buy
several chess programs because of the varied playing strengths, game features (Internet, various time controls and analysis features), or game
gimmicks (a Civil War set where the pieces shoot and combat each other).
In the 1980s I developed several computer versions of popular children
and young adult board games. The executives at these companies worried
Chapter 5
Casual Games
22
Chapter 5
that the computer versions of their games would cannibalize (take sales
away from) the retail toy sales.
In a phone conversation, I stated several key factors comparing the
retail toy board game version with the computer version of their games.
n The retail toy board game has sold in stores for many years and will
continue to sell as predicted.
n The computer version of their game:
n will add additional revenue for them, a new market of customers
owning computers, who most likely own the toy board game version.
n will ensure that the gameboard and pieces will not get lost, which
often happens to the retail toy version.
n will ensure that players must follow the rules and cheating cannot
happen.
n will address each player by name and reward the player for successful interactions and through animation and sounds get/train the
player to successfully complete his/her turn.
n can be saved and continued at any time without setting up the board
and pieces.
n can be played by a solo player, perhaps an ill child home from school.
Game shows are addictive and popular. Everyone wants to be a contestant
on his or her favorite show! Gamers can feel through sound and animation
the thrill of being on a game show without leaving their office or home.
They can play against real opponents (via networks or the Internet) or
against the programs AI (artificial intelligence). Intelligent gamers can
feel successful by doing well and winning the game shows prizes, cash, or
whatever. Other gamers can practice and perform better without the
embarrassment of performing poorly in the real world.
Licensing game shows is financially costly (all publishers are willing to
pay for the rights of a successful show). The success of the games sales
and markets desire often depends on the success of the TV show and not
how well the games designed.
Card games include trading card games, solitaire, cribbage, hearts,
rummy, Old Maid, bridge, and all gambling games (poker, blackjack, keno,
slot machines, roulette, craps, and baccarat). Card games are similar to
classic board games in that gamers want to own good versions (good skill
level or interesting features) of these games.
Gambling games have a unique attribute in that gambling gamers are
always seeking an edge against the casinos and their poker night buddies.
They believe that if one gambling game teaches you one expert strategy,
then buying another isnt repetitive but may teach you another much
needed lesson.
Besides entertaining gamers, casual games can train, educate, and
improve the gamers knowledge and skill level.
Game Genres
23
Casual games have a mass-market audience that knows and understands the product based on its name and package graphics. They have a
longer shelf life than this months popular game. Publishers and developers can easily understand the games concept and concentrate on the
games features and graphics.
Educational Games
Educational games emphasize learning. They are designed to teach or
reinforce a learned concept. Educational games look like games of other
genres, but they are their own genre because they emphasize education.
The most basic (and to me, boring) educationally designed game would
be text exercises like fill-in-the-blank, multiple choice, or essay. With a little imagination, you could turn the multiple-choice game into a fun
gameshow where the host asks the student an educational-oriented question and correct answers earn points or virtual cash.
History games could be turned into adventure games or RPGs, where
the student plays the key character and must answer relevant historical
questions or resolve a historical situation properly.
English games could be graphic stories with relevant questions that
when answered correctly proceed to the next chapter.
Throughout my career I have developed many educational games.
In 1983 a major book publisher had me design and program several games
that were to accompany their new school textbooks. World-Wide Reporter
was a game where the player, as a top-notch reporter, was sent around the
world to get the scoop on headline stories. Based on 50 cities covered in
the accompanying textbook, over 20 facts about each city were saved as
clues. The student would receive one to two clues about a city and a clue
about the story to cover. At the airport, the student would see five cities to
fly to and had to select a city. If they understood the clue(s) and flew to the
right city, theyd get another clue for the next city. If a mistake was made,
additional clues were given directing them to the right city. After the student had traveled to five cities, he would receive one of several citations
and make front-page news (students name in huge, bold letters).
Lets say youre interested in chemistry and would like to create a fun
and educational chemistry game. In your travels adventuring throughout
the human body, you need to find nitrogen. In your inventory you have a
container of carbon dioxide. The player would have to figure out or know
Chapter 5
24
Chapter 5
that the carbon dioxide is comprised of carbon (atomic weight 6) and two
oxygen (each atomic weight 8) and the sought-after nitrogen has an atomic
weight of 7. The player would examine each element found and weigh it
against the carbon and the oxygen. Nitrogen is the only element heavier
than carbon and lighter than oxygen. This design could make learning
chemistry (the atomic weights and names) interesting and fun.
Barbie Secret Agent, Blues Clues Learning Time, Cosmopolitan Virtual Makeover 2002 Deluxe, Oregon Trail 4th Edition,
Shrek Gameland Activity Center, Tonka Dig n Rigs Playset
Game Genres
25
Chapter 5
PC:
26
Chapter 5
Simulation Games
Simulation games (or sims) let gamers experience real-world situations
from a safe, practice area. Since the 1950s, the Department of Defense has
trained the military with computerized simulators like flight sims, tank
sims, and wargaming sims (missiles launching and combat).
Simulations are exciting and have a real world feeling to them. Most of
the real-world applications we are trying to simulate would be extremely
dangerous and very expensive outside of the computer. Navigating and
reproducing practice scenarios are more practical and easier to set up
inside a simulator.
Simulations can be classified as either a vehicle simulation or a managing simulation. Vehicle sims are trucks, cars (stock, Formula-1,
high-performance), airplanes, helicopters, boats, submarines, spaceships,
space stations, motorcycles, and so on. Managing sims include managing a
nuclear power plant, a brokerage company trying to predict the stock market, being mayor of a city or president of the United States, being owner of
a golf club, being manager of the city zoo, being Emperor of the Roman
Empire, being owner of an amusement park (rollercoasters and rides), and
even managing the lives of families or ant colonies.
Many gamers dream of sitting in a Formula-1 racecar with the engine
purring as the green light signals the start of the race, and then driving at
high speeds of 200 mph around the track until the checkered flag waves
them in as the winner.
What about the car crashes that we often see or the high-speed turns
that sometimes slam cars into the wall? How can a driver safely practice
against these obstacles? Drivers cant really practice driving expensive
Formula-1s at various tracks in various weather conditions. This is where
a good simulation becomes valuable. Even the novice drivers can access
racing simulations and live out their dream. Scenarios can be set up for
various weather conditions like rain, fog, snow, or hot, dry heat. Various
car situations can be set up like various tire, radiator, or engine conditions.
The drivers can practice turns and curves at various speeds without the
fear of injury to the car or themselves.
The key to vehicle simulation is realism, quick and accurate responses
to the gamers input and the situation being simulated.
Theres an old, comical story that goes
Aboard a commercial flight from New York to Miami, the pilot passes
out. The flight attendant enters the passenger cabin and announces,
The captain has passed out. Is there any passenger on board who has
experience flying a jet? Possibly someone who flew jets in the Air
Force?
No one answers.
The flight attendant again pleads to the passengers, Does anyone have
a pilots license, either commercial or private?
Game Genres
27
Chapter 5
Yes, simulators have gotten that good. In fact, many flight simulators running on PCs can be used to log flight hours for private licenses. Gamers
can learn how to use the airplanes controls and instruments, lift off and
land an airplane, and navigate it in the simulation. They can make mistakes and test normally dangerous situations like stalling, flying upside
down, or spiraling downward without the fear of injury and costly damage.
Scenarios can be safely tried and retried. Reading from a manual about the
how-tos and whys is fine, but trying an action and failing is a better
reinforcement of the concepts. Simulator pilots can crash and live to tell
about it.
In a simulation, we can fly anything from a Cessna to an F-18 jet. The
first PC F-18 jet simulation was so accurate and realistic that (the story
goes) the military advisors forced the developers to reverse the controls.
The Apollo 13 astronauts practiced their procedures using a simulator
weeks before the launch. When Apollo 13 experienced trouble, it was the
backup team and the onground simulator that solved the problems and
advised the crew in space how to get back to Earth.
Managing simulations have gamers acting as the U.S. president, making executive decisions that affect the entire country, reviewing
Congressional bills, meeting with senators to vote for bills, interviewing
with the press, and chatting with voters.
Some of the recent, most popular sims have the gamer acting as the
mayor of a large city. As mayor you decide on issues like building and road
construction and public safety like police and fire personnel.
Other sims are more concerned with overseeing a neighborhood and
dealing with the daily activities of families and neighbors.
Regardless of the type of simulation you want to design, accurate
research, realism, and fun gameplay are the critical issues to address.
28
Chapter 5
Game Genres
29
Fighting games are usually from the fighters POV (eye of the fighter)
or third-person POV. Fighting games would include martial arts, boxing,
wrestling, and weapons combat.
Strategy Games
Chapter 5
Strategy games are games that require thought and planning. The
games winner is determined through a battle of the minds.
Strategy games differ from other genres because the designer creates
rules and goals, but it is the gamer who decides what strategy to use to
achieve those goals and outwit the opponent(s).
War games are strategy games although they are simulations of actual
or fictitious events.
Strategy games can be played as real-time or turn-based games. In real
time, all players including the computer-controlled (AI) players are competing nonstop, simultaneously. In turn based, each player completes his
turn before the next player begins.
A typical POV or perspective of strategy games is an overhead view to
allow all players to see the entire playing area.
30
Chapter 5
Chapter 6
Game Ideas
At this stage, you understand the gaming genres and have an eagerness to
become a game designer. You may now think that you still dont have a
clear vision of a game concept.
Well, you can always creatively borrow ideas from other sources and
tailor them to your liking. Sources that are great to borrow from are
books, movies, science, history, sports, art, and everyday life itself.
If ideas are truly worth a dime a dozen, theres over $10 worth (1,200
plus ideas) for you to use as the basis for a game design concept in an
expanded version of this chapter on the companion CD. Here is a
sampling.
Sports
1 Archery
2 Arm wrestling
3 Badminton
4 Baseball
5 Basketball
6 Biathlon
7 BMX biking
8 Bobsled (and Skeleton)
9 Boogie boarding or bodyboarding
10 Bowling
11 Boxing
12 Cricket
13 Croquet
14 Cross-country skiing
15 Curling
16 Cycling
17 Darts
18 Demolition derby
19 Diving
20 Dog racing
21 Dog sledding
31
32
Chapter 6
22 Equestrian
23 Extreme fighting
24 Fencing
25 Field hockey
26 Fishing
27 Football
28 Formula-1 racing
29 Golf
30 Gymnastics
31 Hockey (ice or roller)
32 Horse racing
33 Horseshoe pitching
34 Hunting
35 Ice skating
36 Jai alai
37 Jet skiing
38 Jousting
39 Judo
40 Karate
41 Kayaking
42 Kendo
43 Kung fu
44 Lacrosse
45 Luge
46 Miniature golf
47 Monster truck rally
48 Motorcycling
49 NASCAR racing
50 Paintball
51 Pentathlon
52 Polo (horse)
53 Pool
54 Quoits
55 Racquetball
56 Rodeo
57 Roller derby
58 Roller skating
59 Rowing
60 Rugby
61 Sailing
62 Shuffleboard
63 Skateboarding
64 Skeet shooting
65 Skiing
66 Snowboarding
67 Snowmobiling
68 Soccer
Game Ideas
33
69 Softball
70 Speed skating
71 Squash
72 Sumo wrestling
73 Surfing
74 Swimming
75 Table tennis
76 Tennis
77 Tobogganing
78 Track and field
79 Trapshooting
80 Triathlon
81 Volleyball
82 Wakeboarding
83 Water polo
84 Water skiing
85 Wrestling
Board Games
1 Backgammon
2 Checkers
3 Chess
4 Dominoes
5 Go
6 Hangman (like Wheel of Fortune)
7 Mahjong
8 Othello
1 Baccarat
2 Blackjack
3 Bridge
4 Caribbean Stud Poker
5 Craps
6 Cribbage
7 Gin Rummy
8 Go Fish
9 Hearts
10 Keno
11 Old Maid
12 Paigow Poker
13 Poker: Draw Poker, Five Card Stud, Seven Card Stud,
Texas Hold Em, Omaha
14 Red Dog
15 Roulette
16 Sic Bo
17 Slots
18 Solitaire
Chapter 6
34
Chapter 6
19 Spades
20 Video Poker
21 War
Simulations
1 Become a rock star
2 Be a train engineer
3 Pilot a helicopter
4 Be an automotive technician
5 Be a dentist
6 Race a 4x4 truck
7 Build and operate a casino
8 Run a corporation
9 Manage a gaming company
10 Manage a hospital
11 Manage a movie studio
12 Manage a railroad
13 Manage a restaurant chain
14 Manage an amusement park
15 Manage a university
16 Run for senator
17 Operate a nuclear power plant
18 Simulate the stock market
19 Operate a semi-truck for crosscountry delivery
20 Drive a motorcycle across the
country
Science
Ecology
Biology
Chemistry
Chemistry topics
Earth science
Physics
Astronomy
History
People
Time periods
Wars
Exploration
Game Ideas
35
Literature
The Bible
Classics
Mythology
Heroes
Mythological creatures
Irish mythology
Norse mythology
Authors
Hans Christian Andersen
Albert Camus
Michael Crichton
Arthur Conan Doyle
Gilbert and Sullivan (musicals)
John Grisham
Henrik Ibsen (plays)
Christopher Marlowe
Robert Ludlum
Alexander S. Pushkin
William Shakespeare
George Bernard Shaw
John Steinbeck
Mark Twain
Art
How can artwork be made into a game?
Sunday in the Park With George was inspired by the art of Georges
Seurats painting entitled A Sunday Afternoon on the Island of La Grande
Jatte.
Georges Seurat was the founder of the 19th-century French school of
Neo-Impressionism whose technique for portraying the play of light using
tiny brushstrokes of contrasting colors became known as Pointillism.
Director and book writer James Lapine collaborated with Stephen
Sondheim on Sunday in the Park with George, the winner of the 1985 Pulitzer Prize for Drama based on Georges Seurats masterpiece.
Chapter 6
36
Chapter 6
Music
How can music be made into a game?
We could go back in time and aid each composer in creating his or her
masterpiece. We could use the music as the basis for our game design as
in Tchaikovskys Peter and the Wolf or Rossinis William Tell Overture (also known as the Lone Ranger Theme). We could educate
ourselves about the different types of music, and in an RPG where we
have several towns and cities, we could have a different type or style of
music being played in each town.
The Tom Hanks film That Thing You Do was based entirely on a band
that really only played that one song for the entire film.
Music topics to research include composers and music styles.
Game Ideas
37
1
2
Chapter 6
When obtaining game ideas from a film (or movie), we want to utilize the
films premise (plot, theme, and action) and not its character names, costumes, creature design and look, and names of places and objects.
The film Alien has a unique character (the alien), a specific spaceship
design, a famous cast, and particular character names. If we want to mimic
Alien in our game design, first we would call our game something interesting and descriptive like Space Predator or Space Cannibal to get the
audience, publishers, and stores interested and to give a preconceived
notion about our game.
If we decided that our alien creature was to look like a carnivorous
dinosaur, we might title the game Space Raptor to bring in the Jurassic
Park audience. We would design our own alien, perhaps describing it or
using an artist to sketch our scary alien vision. We may use the crew
dynamics of the film Alien like each members rank, sex, age, and race and
then change the characters name and face design to differ from the film.
In our pitch to publishers and in future sales and marketing material,
we would utilize the Alien basis to correlate potential sales, audience
interest, and a marketing strategy. We would obviously claim that our
game is scarier and better than the film that spawned two sequels, Aliens
and Alien 3, as well as several lesser rip-off films. Our pitch would include
the facts that in 1979 Alien was the top-grossing film and in 1997 Alien 3
was that years top-grossing film. Also based on the film data, we could list
the demographics of our audience like age, sex, income level, and international appeal.
As in life and in books, films, and games, there is nothing new under
the sun.
38
Chapter 6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
39
Chapter 6
Game Ideas
40
Chapter 6
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
61
62
63
64
65
66
67
68
69
70
71
72
73
74
75
76
77
41
Chapter 6
Game Ideas
42
Chapter 6
78
79
80
81
82
83
84
85
86
87
88
89
90
91
92
93
94
The End: A terminally ill man decides to end his suffering and
attempts various methods of committing suicide.
End of Days: Satan must have an heir, and an alcoholic ex-cop is the
only hero who can save a young woman from this fate.
Enemy Mine: Two warring planets pilots (a human and a reptile
man) crash onto a planet where they are captured as slaves, and they
must unite to survive and escape.
Eraser: A federal marshal fakes elaborate deaths for people entering
the Witness Protection Program.
Erin Brockovich: An unemployed mother bullies her way into a law
office where she uncovers and investigates a public utility companys act of dumping toxic waste into a local water supply.
Escape From LA: In Los Angeles circa 2013, the hero, who has been
poisoned and has ten hours to live, is sent in to deal with the kidnapped daughter of the President and a doomsday device.
Escape From New York: Futuristic Manhattan, now a pile of rubble,
becomes the federal prison housing the worst elements. When the
presidents plane crashes in New York, he becomes a hostage, forcing an unwilling war hero to begin a rescue mission.
Eyes of Laura Mars: A female photographer can foresee murders in
her pictures, and she becomes the focus of the killer.
F/X: A Hollywood special effects expert is hired to fake a mobsters
assassination, and he becomes a loose end that must be terminated.
He must use his skills to survive and rectify this life.
Face/Off: A federal agent surgically exchanges his face for that of the
terrorist who killed his son. The unaware agent soon discovers that
the terrorist is not only alive but wearing his face.
Falling Down: An average law-abiding citizen snaps and goes on a
rampage, and a retiring detective on his last day must stop him.
Family Man: A single, wealthy investment banker finds out the
answer to the question what if I married my college love? with the
help of his guardian angel.
Fantasy Island: Vacationers get to live out their most desired
fantasies.
Fatal Attraction: A married New York lawyer has an affair with a
beautiful associate, and when he tries to end the relationship, she
threatens his family, his home, and his life.
The Fifth Element: To save the Earth from a maniac arms dealers
destructive plan, a New York City taxi driver must help an alien
woman and a priest to save the day.
54: Running New York Citys most popular disco, Studio 54, requires
a unique staff who desire wealth and stardom and an owner who will
do anything for pleasure.
The Final Terror: A group of campers in a remote wooded area are
stalked by a crazed killer.
95
96
97
98
99
100
101
102
103
104
105
106
107
108
43
Chapter 6
Game Ideas
44
Chapter 6
109
110
111
112
113
114
115
116
117
118
119
120
121
122
continuum of repeating the same day and events until he finds love,
happiness, and the meaning of life.
Hackers: Teenage cyber geeks get outhacked by a super hacker who
frames them for industrial conspiracy. The teens must use their
techno skills to resolve the problem as police, federal security, and
the superhacker all want to delete them.
Heaven Can Wait (Here Comes Mr. Jordan): A second string football
player (or a boxer) is taken too early by his guardian angel and is
sent back to Earth assuming the body of a millionaire with athletic
aspirations.
Highlander: Aliens on Earth are immortal and cant be terminated
unless theyre decapitated and must never fight on sacred, holy
ground. In the end, there can be only one.
The Hills Have Eyes: Inbred mountain cannibals invite lost guests to
(be) dinner.
House: A horror novelist moves into his deceased aunts haunted
house where rooms transform into nightmares and monsters are no
longer closet bound.
Idolmaker: A hot talent agent can turn teens into superstars. He creates one rock star who gets replaced by a younger upcoming talent.
The In-Laws: An importers son and a dentists daughter are to be
married. The importer, a CIA agent, entangles the dentist in a
counterfeiting and robbery scheme that has the two men avoiding
federal agents and traveling to South America to meet with a lunatic
dictator.
Invasion of the Body Snatchers: Alien pods take over a town and its
citizens.
Island of the Dead: A business tycoon, a policewoman, a prison warden, and three convicts are stuck on a burial ground island as the
disturbed dead resurrect.
Its a Wonderful Life: An angel shows a suicidal man what life would
be like if he was never born.
Jerry Maguire: A sports agent gets a conscience and is fired for it,
forcing him and a co-worker girlfriend to start their own company
that encounters a rocky road in business and romance.
Johnny Mnemonic: A data courier gets an overload of critical data
downloaded into his head that contains extremely confidential information that a rich corporate head wants to remain a secret. An
assassin seeks his head, a female enhanced bodyguard needs his
protection money, rebel hackers need him to transport the data
unharmed, and an ex-doctor tries to keep his head from exploding so
the battle against a technology-induced epidemic can be stopped.
Joyride: Three friends steal a car that belongs to a revengeful, beautiful blonde assassin.
Jumanji: A board game that turns each move into reality transports a
man back, who as a boy got stuck in the game world 26 years ago.
45
Chapter 6
Game Ideas
46
Chapter 6
135 Made in Heaven: To remain eternal lovers, two heavenly souls are
reborn on Earth and must find each other or lose each other forever.
136 The Man Who Knew Too Little: A video store clerk from Iowa visits
his successful brother in London as his own birthday surprise. His
brother is having a very important business party with clients and
decides to send the naive American birthday boy on a special night
out, participating in a real-life role-playing theatre experience. He
mistakenly gets involved with a hit man and an international plot to
initiate a global war. He truly believes that he is playing a wellrehearsed game and is totally oblivious to the real danger he is part
of.
137 Mannequin: An ancient Egyptian woman is brought to life as a mannequin by a department store clerk who falls in love with her,
despite his successful fiance who works for a competing store. The
mannequin only comes to life for him as he climbs the company ladder and is the target of the stores security and idol of the stores
flamboyant window designer.
138 The Mask: A quiet bank clerk discovers an ancient mask with supernatural powers that animates him. He falls in love with a mobsters
sexy singing lady.
139 Memento: In Los Angeles, a man searches for his wifes killer while
unable to remember current events due to an accident that
destroyed his short-term memory (every 15 minutes he forgets
everything). Polaroids, Post-its, and tattoos remind him of vital clues
and suspects.
140 Men In Black: Two top-secret government agents dressed in black
and wearing sunglasses keep track and maintain the order of alien
visitors on Earth, mainly in New York City. When an assassination of
a diplomat occurs and a galaxy is threatened, alien destruction of
Earth must be dealt with.
141 Michael: The archangels last visit to Earth is filled with wine,
women, and dancing as reporters from a Chicago tabloid newspaper
want his story.
142 Midnight Run: An ex-bounty hunter must bring the mobs
ex-accountant and embezzler from New York to California by car
(since he refuses to fly), but the mob, the FBI, and an eager, meaner
competing bounty hunter are also interested in the accountant.
143 Moon Over Parador: When a Latin American dictator suddenly dies,
an actor who resembles him is hired for the role of a lifetime while
an ambitious political rival seeks eventual control of the country and
a desirable woman needs his help.
144 Most Wanted: A Marine sergeant guarding the first ladys press conference is framed for her assassination and must evade the CIA, FBI,
LAPD, and team he was assigned to and its leaders until he can
solve his dilemma.
145 Never Been Kissed: A young female Chicago newspaper copy editor
gets her first undercover assignment to go back to high school as a
student and write a front page story.
146 Nick of Time: An evil psycho kidnaps an accountants young daughter and forces the accountant (a conservative widower) to assassinate the female governor of California in 90 minutes. This film is
shot in real time where all events happen within the 90-minute
window.
147 Night of the Living Dead: Space radiation creates flesh-eating zombies from the recently deceased as a group of scared humans occupy
an isolated farmhouse.
148 The Ninth Gate: An unscrupulous rare-book dealer gets hired by a
wealthy publishing mogul to search and authenticate three copies of
a 17th-century book, which has secret writings that can forcefully
enslave the devil.
149 Not Without My Daughter: An American woman married to an Arab
medical doctor travels to Iran only to find out that she has no rights,
doesnt speak the language, and since her husband has taken her
passport she cant leave the country.
150 Oceans Eleven: A gang of eleven friends decide to rob five Las Vegas
casinos at the same time.
151 The Omen: An American diplomat adopts the son of Satan who has
special powers. Sequels follow Damien (son of Satan) throughout his
life.
152 Other Peoples Money: A corporate raiders computer indicates top
profitable companies that are ready for a takeover like the New England Wire and Cable, a family owned company that is worth more
sold than to leave it operating. Whats a raider to do when a prime
target is worth more to his pocket, but the owners beautiful lawyer
daughter has stolen his heart?
153 Out of Towners: A naive Ohio couples misadventures in New York
City, where everything goes awry.
154 Planet of the Apes: A member of a space team accidentally lands on a
planet where apes rule and humans are their slaves.
155 Poseidon Adventure: A cruise ship capsizes and the surviving passengers must roam the leaking upside-down ship and survive until help
arrives.
156 Predator: A space-hunting alien visits Earth seeking humans as
trophies.
157 Proof of Life: When an American engineer is kidnapped by South
American anti-government guerrillas, a professional hostage negotiator is hired and begins to have an interest in his assignments wife.
158 Pure Luck (or La Chevre): An accident-prone heiress with extremely
bad luck disappears in Mexico, and a hard-nosed detective and a
clumsy accountant (himself a bad luck magnet) travel south to find
and rescue her.
47
Chapter 6
Game Ideas
48
Chapter 6
Game Ideas
49
Chapter 6
172 They Live: Aliens are secretly living among humans and can only be
spotted when the human is wearing special sunglasses that ignore
color and show the real world, which is in black and white.
173 Thrill Seekers: A tabloid reporter researching great catastrophes of
the past notices in photos the same person in events that span centuries. He along with another female reporter discovers that a future
travel agency offers its clients a vacation to historic disasters.
174 Total Recall: With nightly dreams of visiting Mars, a married construction worker buys an implanted vacation where he is a secret
agent in search of alien artifacts and interacts with the mutant
underground while evading government assassins. When he awakes,
his co-workers, his wife, and government agents want him dead,
forcing him to try to discover whether its all a dream or reality.
175 Wages of Fear: Four eager citizens who desperately want to leave a
Central American poor, desolate town volunteer for a suicide mission to transport trucks of nitroglycerine to extinguish a raging well
fire 300 treacherous miles away. Each person will receive $2,000,
enough money to happily leave town.
177 The Warriors: At a New York City street gang rally, the leader of
New Yorks toughest and largest gang is assassinated. The Warriors,
a Brooklyn-Coney Island gang, are mistakenly blamed for the murder, and they must safely return home as the word is spread through
the radio to destroy the Warriors.
178 West World: An adult resort island where human-like robots in a
western fantasy town interact with human vacationers until an electric malfunction turns friendly robots into terrorizing ones.
179 White Mans Burden: A reverse of life concept where blacks have all
the wealth and power and the white race struggles. A bigoted black
CEO fires the white main character who kidnaps his black boss and
shows him how the other half lives.
180 Wishmaster: An evil genie grants wishes to his victims in a destructive and evil version of their desires.
Chapter 7
Research
As game designers, we first get a great idea, our vision. Then we play a
sample game in our head and have a very basic concept of our fantastic
game.
Now begins the hard part, the reality of game design. We need to
thoroughly understand the games subject matter as though we are professionals at it. This is done in the phase called research. This is the first
mountain that we must cross. Many wannabe game designers start the
climb upward and eventually lose interest and quit. To the professional
game designer, this is the fun phase, where the dream first hits the
paper and the vision becomes real.
Over the years Ive helped many newbie game designers iron out
their ideas and concepts (Pedersen Principle 9: Share Your Toys!). One of
their first concerns is If I tell you my great game concept, how do I know
you wont steal it? My answer has always been, You are the one with a
burning desire to create this vision, and Im not. Theres a lot of hard work
ahead, several months of painstaking decision-making work, and you have
that determination to make your vision a reality. I have a lot of my own
visions that to me are important to design. I dont have enough time to
design my own visions, so why would I want to steal yours?
Would I rather have the original visionary design the game and get
rewarded later financially and credited, or steal the idea and work
extremely hard for free? Thats why I enjoy mentoring. Let others do their
work and hopefully well all get rewarded at some point.
The best way to protect your game design is to spend $30 or so to register a copyright of your document(s). To copyright a document, you need
to get a form from the U.S. Copyright Office in Washington, D.C., fill it
out, and mail it along with your document(s) and filing fee. The Library of
Congress web site (http://lcweb.loc.gov/copyright/circs/circ1.html) has
information of copyright basics. To copyright a design document or a computer program, you must fill out Form TX, which is available in Adobe
Acrobat Reader PDF format (www.copyright.gov/forms/formtxi.pdf).
On all of your documents place the copyright notice on the first page. I
like to place this notice on the top of every page, so if copies are made the
notice is included. The notice should look something like 2002 Roger
51
52
Chapter 7
E. Pedersen where either the symbol or the word Copyright precedes the copyright year and the copyrights owner.
The titles of films and books cannot be trademarked, but computer and
video game titles can be. If the name of your game is unique and catchy,
you should spend the couple of hundred dollars and get a lawyer to perform a trademark search and then file a trademark for your games name.
It will help that your title is trademarked later when talking to publishers.
I worked for a game company that had a future game title on their web site
for several years, and then another company advertised their game by the
same name. We contacted a lawyer and found that the other company had
filed that name for a trademark. We decided not to fight the costly and
most likely un-winnable fight to challenge the trademark. Therefore, we
lost that title.
Remember, ideas are truly a dime a dozen. Concepts are worthless in
gaming until the designer commits the idea to paper, a design document.
To prove that ideas without supporting documentation is meaningless,
look on the companion CD-ROM or in Chapter 6, Game Ideas, where
hundreds of ideas for free gaming concepts from other mediums such as
books, film, and history are listed.
When I begin researching a gaming concept that Im developing, I make
a list of similar and competing games. Then I ask, What current and past
games are close to the game Im developing? and What games in my
games genre are currently selling?
Even if you think your game is unique and theres nothing close to its
concept, youll need to explain your vision to publishers and convince
them that other games like yours have been successful.
One of the first places I look is magazines. I want to see what current
products are reviewed in my games genre and perhaps competitors to my
game. Even more insightful are the advertisements by gaming mail order
stores. They list many games under genre headings and their prices. This
is useful information you will later need, such as competitive selling titles,
their platform (PC, PlayStation, GameCube, or Xbox), and their selling
price (retail price).
The next place I look is the magazines and gaming web sites lists of
top games in each genre for the current and previous year. People associate future success with the current winners. Youll want to associate your
game with the top-awarded games in your games genre when youre selling your concept to a publisher.
Then I look at the similar and competing game publishers web sites to
view how they are marketing their product so I can get an idea how to
market my game. Let their highly paid marketing and sales departments
benefit you and get ideas to use for free. Read their descriptions and features and copy them down so your game will have the same features and
gameplay. Look at any screen shots they display to see what the gamers
are familiar with and how your screen should look. Some sites will include
favorable reviews of their game, so print them and highlight the reviewers comments.
You will also search other sources (magazines and web sites) for
reviews of similar and competing games. When I look at a review, I make a
list with two columns marked Good and Bad. Under Good, I write
down the reviewers favorable comments and the standard features that
the game must have plus any extras that the designer is being praised for.
Under Bad, I list the reviewers unfavorable comments, like problems
with the game or features designed that didnt work or werent as good as
they should have been. I pay special attention to graphic and sound issues.
Features that were missing or not handled correctly are noted, and later I
address these so I dont fall victim to the same criticism by other reviewers and gamers.
The important issues are the games interface (what does the gamer
view and how does the gamer interact with the game?), the POV of the
game (first or third person), the games options, the computer requirements (RAM, hard disk minimum space required, Windows version
needed, CD speed required), and special devices required (driving wheel,
force-feedback joystick or mouse, 3D accelerator card).
As a designer, I also value buying the top-selling games hint books or
strategy guides. These books discuss the games basic strategy and the
games design in depth. Hint books reveal each sides or characters
strengths and weaknesses. Many times gamers favor one side or character above the others without fully understanding or realizing the strengths
and weaknesses they are dealt. Likewise, many gamers dont understand
or realize the strengths and weaknesses of their opponents in the game.
Hint books and strategy guides discuss these issues in detail. Many
gamers and designers dont have the time it would take to play all variations and situations for one side or one character, let alone all sides and all
characters. This problem of not understanding the strengths and weaknesses of their characters and sides becomes more of an issue in online
(web-based) games where the gamers time and money (cost of playing,
connection costs, and so on) are needed to play.
As designers, we need to understand the top successful games intricate design details and balanced play as references to follow. Playing
games is a great start to understanding the gamers POV, but we, as
designers, need to understand the game designers POV. This viewpoint
requires us to research and study these games as well as play them.
Hint books and strategy guides may also tell us the why behind the
decisions that were made. Internet games may suffer from latency (a slow
down) when the server(s) get(s) too populated. To solve this technical
dilemma, the game must move players from the current server to another
less-populated server. To the gamer, they might experience a magical
cloud that overshadows the terrain and teleports all of the players currently in that area into another area (one controlled by a less-populated
server). The key is to make the gamers unaware of the why and still
have a fun and meaningful experience.
Another interesting area is the designers notes written on many sites
(see Appendix A) where the development team, after the product has
53
Chapter 7
Research
54
Chapter 7
shipped, tells about the project, especially where things went wrong or
what they would do differently.
If our desire is to become a game designer, we must master our trade
by first learning from other masters as their apprentice (study existing
games, research our games subject matter, and play games from the best
to the near best) and then become masters ourselves by designing our
vision through research, documentation, and play testing.
An important concept in both researching and documenting your game
is to assume that the player and audience know nothing about the subject
matter and gameplay issues. Document your concept and research findings as though the player and audience are not technical and totally new to
the game concepts and ideas. Think of explaining these issues to a willing-to-learn and eager-to-be-taught child-like audience.
Lets examine how to document a simple game I call Two Heads. The
player flips a coin twice. If both tosses result in heads, the player wins.
This simple game should be more accurately described with more
details that explain the concepts and issues in greater detail:
The player freely tosses a coin so that it randomly spins in the air (also
called a toss). The coin is a metal, two-sided, flat circle in which one
side is called heads and the opposite side is called tails. Commonly,
a coin has a persons head on one side (the head of a president or monarch), which is known as the heads side. The opposite side of the
coin often has a bird, such as an eagle, on it so it is often known as the
tails side. If the first toss results in the heads side appearing on
top, the player continues. If the tails side appears on top, the player
loses. If play continues (the first toss resulted in heads), the player
tosses the coin for a second time. If the result is another heads side
on top, the player wins. Otherwise, the player loses.
This description clearly expresses the games rules in simple, understandable terms. The games object (the coin) is described with its identifying
features. The games process is described in detail with the common lingo
explained for future references. The winning and losing conditions are
identified so the player(s) can easily understand the goals.
At this point, we understand the market and have an idea of what our
competitors have done and what our customers expect from our game.
Now we need to fully understand our games subject matter. We need to
find free, unlimited information that can help us.
Lets think
Libraries have books, magazines, and encyclopedias for us to use and
take notes from. Also, the Internet will supply information that we can
use. The Internets information may be more recent than books, and there
are pictures and sounds that we can access and save for samples of what
our game may need. Many of the libraries I have visited have computers
available with word processing capabilities and Internet access.
A wannabe game designer wanted my mentoring. He had three game
design concepts that he thought would earn him millions and have the
major publishers begging to sell his games. His background was working
as an international contract lawyer, and he had a graduate degree in international business law and an undergraduate degree in paleontology
(dinosaur scientist). Hed played a lot of recent games, especially sims,
RPGs, and FPS. He played on his PC alone as well as multiplayer versions
on the Internet. He had never designed a game, let alone worked on a
game in any capacity.
Lets look at and critique his three concepts.
Intergalactic Council is a space diplomacy, strategy simulation game
where up to ten players are members of the council. Each of the ten
players are diplomats representing their galaxy. Each diplomat presents
the council treaties, trade agreements, and his galaxys requests (bills).
If negotiations fail, the diplomats can declare war or boycott the council
meetings. Each galaxy has its own inhabited planets, a galactic space
armada (ships), and tradeable resources. The laws and treaties follow
the international laws established for venues outside the Earth as far as
format and regulations. The goal of the game is for each diplomat to
successfully create and get his bills, treaties, and trade agreements
passed or, by intergalactic warfare, force the acts to be accepted by the
council.
How does this concept sound to you? Would it make for an interesting
game? What issues need to be researched in order to get a better understanding of the rules and gamers play options?
I thought the concept sounded interesting but wanted to see more of it
developed through research. The designers education and work gave him
the expertise to design such a game. My concern was simpler: Is this a
game that a newbie game designer should start with? My thoughts were
that even to a seasoned game designer with some international business
law background, this design was a Herculean task. I suspected that trying
to research and properly design this concept would take six to twelve
months to complete, and the new designer would most likely quit in the
research phase.
I advised him to put this design on hold and start his design career off
with an easier, less complex concept. After having a few titles finished
(not necessarily published), hed feel more confident in tackling a major
research and design project, and a publisher might be willing to be financially involved. It is equally important that the team (in this case, the
designer) doing the project have credentials (proof that they can finish a
started task).
The second concept was The Lost Kingdoms.
The Lost Kingdoms is a fantasy simulation where the player(s) represent the kingdoms of humans, elves, dwarves, centaurs, trolls, orcs, or
giants. The kingdoms have co-existed in peace for hundreds of years
where the human, elf, and dwarf kingdoms were allies, the centaurs
were neutral, and the troll, orc, and giant kingdoms were evil. As the
55
Chapter 7
Research
56
Chapter 7
game begins, the evil kingdoms of trolls, orcs, and giants are expanding,
looking for more land and food (they eat humans, elves, dwarves, and
centaurs). The kingdoms must sign peaceful treaties or go to war.
How does this concept sound to you? Would it make for an interesting
game? What issues need to be researched in order to get a better understanding of the rules and gamers play options?
At first I felt that The Lost Kingdoms was somewhat similar to the
Intergalactic Council game. Just like the first concept, this one is an enormous undertaking for a first game design. The concept is good and similar
to the popular Lord of the Rings books. The races in this game are familiar
to RPG and fantasy RPG players. Research is critical to show good judgment and an educated concern for the fans who know and understand
these races.
While researching each race, you must be able to answer the following
questions and do so through the eyes of an avid fan. (Substitute the specific race involved where elves appear.)
What do elves look like (male and female)?
What do elves wear (daily dress and war clothing)?
How do elves talk (common elf phrases)?
What weapons and fighting styles do elves favor?
What do elves do each day?
What do elves cherish and care about?
What do elves believe in (family, gold, customs, and ideology)?
These are just a few starting issues to research in this game. Your job is to
understand like the avid fan does the characteristics and thoughts (social,
political, and economical) of your games kingdoms and individual heroes.
Again, as in Intergalactic Council I thought The Lost Kingdoms was
another good concept that would take at least six months to document and
not an ideal first game to design.
The third concept was The Survival of the Fittest.
The Survival of the Fittest is a prehistoric simulation where mankind
must survive from the Neanderthal man era to the Cro-Magnon man
era. In solo and multiplayer versions, each player controls the destiny
and daily activities of a clan. Hunting, fishing, and making clothes and
shelter are necessities for survival. The goal is to survive through several generations and keep mankind from becoming extinct.
This third design is the most feasible and within the realm of a first-time
game designer, especially one who has a degree in paleontology. The Survival of the Fittest is a nice twist from all those hunting FPS games that
flooded the stores after Deer Hunter.
Lets do some research for our game, The Survival of the Fittest.
Homo Erectus
Homo erectus appeared 1.5 million years B.C. and traveled from Africa to
Europe and Asia. They were the first hunters and gatherers with primitive
weapons like stone axes and knives. They lived in the midst of the Ice
Age, so traveling across bodies of water was as simple as crossing a vast
terrain of frozen, natural ice bridges. Homo erectus traveled in search of
food in the frozen desert after the animals in Africa either headed north or
became extinct. They had the skills to make fire. Fire was an important
key to life since it protected them against wild, hungry animals that feared
fire, gave the tribe heat when traveling through cold regions, and allowed
them to cook their food, killing possible diseases and softening their meat.
The elders could share stories around the fire.
57
Chapter 7
Research
58
Chapter 7
Homo erectus had a large face, a thick skull, a large, powerful lower
jaw, and a receding forehead. They could grow to 5'9" and often lived in
caves. They traveled over 8,500 miles from Africa to Europe or China
(8,700 miles) in over a million years, following the herds that moved
northward seasonally.
Neanderthals
Neanderthals, or Homo sapiens (wise man), lived 200,000 to 250,000
years ago. They lived in Europe (Germany, Italy, Switzerland, France, and
Portugal), Asia (Siberia, Poland), and the Near East (Turkey, Syria, Lebanon, and Israel).
A clan was comprised of 6 to 25 members. Males lived to ages 40 to 45,
while females, many dying in childbirth, lived to 30. Clans often stole
women from neighboring clans. Neanderthals were cave dwellers. The
men hunted within their 30-mile territory. Since they lacked in-depth planning, they hunted in zigzag paths after their prey. Neanderthals cared for
their wounded and disabled members and buried their dead in a ceremony
where they painted the deceased body.
Neanderthals had brawny, short bodies, short arms, and broad trunks
and were large brained (low, sloping forehead). They walked with bent
knees, heads leaning forward, and were very strong. They were well
adapted for cold, harsh climates.
Neanderthals made elaborate use of stone tools. They had hand axes
for skinning and cutting game into pieces and choppers for breaking bones
to eat the marrow, pound meat, and chop wood. Deniculates could shape
and remove bark from wood. Scrapers could clean hides. Curved-back
knives could cut flesh easily. Spears were cut with pointy ends, or stone
points were placed at the end of the spear. Neanderthals made wooden
clubs. They used bones for needles and fishhooks. They could craft warm
boots and make a fire by spinning a pointed stick with kindling.
They were hunters and used spears to kill animals as well as force
herds off cliffs. They hunted reindeer, red deer, horses, wild cattle, gazelle,
rabbit, sheep, and goats. They fished and speared salmon. Neanderthals
were also preyed upon by saber-tooth tigers, ten-foot-tall cave bears,
foxes, cave lions, woolly mammoths, hyenas, and dogs with huge teeth.
Cro-Magnon Man
Cro-Magnon man, or Homo sapiens sapiens, lived around 25,000 B.C.
and followed their food throughout the seasons. In winter they returned to
their shelters while in summer they traveled, following the herds. Like
their ancestors, they ate seeds, berries, roots, nuts, and salmon. They
sweetened their foods with honey.
Cro-Magnon man could grow to six feet tall and could live into their
50s. They had a huge frontal lobe and could plan ahead. They hunted in
groups or individually. They had stone axes, knives, spears, harpoons,
wooden bows, and sharp stone-tipped arrows. They used traps and fished
Final Thoughts
From this information, gameplay starts to run through your mind. Thousands of Homo erectus tribes leave Africa in search of food (herds) and
travel over 8,500 miles into Europe and Asia (think both solo and
multiplayer versions). During the journey, they must hunt with their primitive weapons and seek shelter (ideally a cave). Gamers will have the
Homo erectus tribe perform daily duties (hunting, cooking, and seeking
and making shelter and clothing) through 10 to 15 generations (depending
on skill level). The Homo erectus tribe must not become extinct.
Upon successfully arriving at the tribes final destination, Europe or
Asia, Neanderthal clans of six members will emerge as the gamers new
tribe, and gameplay will continue through six to eight generations
(depending on skill level) with the clans membership reaching 25 members. Then Cro-Magnon man dominates the Earth and, through a more
advanced intelligence and tool skill, is able to hunt better, survive the
environmental conditions, and create art.
Gameplay in The Survival of the Fittest will have the clan or tribes
hunting for food and skins with their eras primitive weapons. As the
group is hunting, predators will be hunting them. Another possible
59
Chapter 7
Research
60
Chapter 7
The Shuffle
Most computer languages have a random function, which is critical to
most games. A good idea is to set the initial randomizer to a truly unique
number like the current time in military formata 24-hour clock including hour (0 to 23), minute (0 to 59), second (0 to 59), and millisecond (0 to
999).
When the poker game is first entered and a poker variation is selected,
the initial deck of suits and ranks in order should be initialized. Using two
random numbers (called A and B) from 1 to 52 (positions of the cards
in the deck), you can exchange the two cards so that card in position A is
relocated to position B and card in position B is relocated to position
A. The shuffle can repeat this exchange many times. Some designers
like to make this number a prime or an odd number of exchanges. For the
most part, a shuffle of 1,000 exchanges is fine.
After the first shuffle of the initialized deck, the remaining shuffles
throughout the game start the next shuffle process with the current shuffled deck.
Hand Rankings
The following examples are in ranking order, meaning the best hand has a
ranking of one and the worst hand is of rank ten.
Rank
Hand Name
Description of Hand
Royal Flush
A, K, Q, J, 10 of same suit
10 , J , Q , K , A
Straight Flush
Four of a Kind
Full House
Rank
Hand Name
Description of Hand
Flush
Straight
Three of a Kind
Two Pair
One Pair
10
High Card
Poker Variations
Poker has many variations with each variation having its own rules. The
more popular poker variations are Draw Poker, Five Card Stud, Seven
Card Stud, Chicago Hi, Chicago Lo, Texas Hold Em, and Omaha. Most
poker variations can be played with two to eight players. The cards are
shuffled and distributed by a player called the dealer. In all variations,
the first card is given to the player to the left of the dealer. A round of betting consists of each player deciding whether he should bet (or raise after
the first bet was made) an amount from the groups agreed-to minimum to
maximum, fold (quit this round of play), or check (agree to cover the current amount due to the pot). When three raises to the original bet have
been made or all players have checked, the betting round is completed.
In Draw Poker, all players make a small blind bet or ante before receiving any cards. Then players, starting with the player to the left of the
dealer, receive cards until each player has five cards. Players carefully look
at their cards and determine which cards to keep and which cards to discard. Players can discard up to three cards, four cards if they are keeping
an ace. Before discarding, each player may bet or raise, fold (quit this
round of play), or accept the current bet amount (check). Then the
remaining players discard their cards. Another round of betting occurs
where each player can bet, fold, or check. After all players have checked
or three raises have occurred, the players must show their cards and the
player with the highest hand wins the pot (all bets made). If only one
player remains (no showdown), he wins and his cards can remain
unexposed.
One variation of Draw Poker commonly played is Draw Poker Jacks or
Better, where to open the first round of betting, the player needs a pair of
jacks or better (a better ranking like three of a kind) to bet. This lets the
other players know that he has a hand containing a pair of jacks or better.
If no player can bet (no hand has at least a pair of jacks), the cards are
reshuffled and a new round begins (ante and all). This variation can build
the pot quite large with antes, and players with bad hands can fold earlier.
61
Chapter 7
Research
62
Chapter 7
Five Card Stud is a variation where each player receives his first card
face down (called the hole), the next three cards are dealt face up, and
the last card is dealt face down. The player to the left of the dealer
receives the first card. The player with the lowest first card must bet the
minimum. Some variations have all players at the start ante up (a small
bet). After all players have received their up card (cards two through four),
a round of betting occurs. Then after the fifth card (a down card) has been
received by all players, the last round of betting occurs. In each betting
round after the first, the player with the highest ranking hand showing
(only the up cards) starts the betting process. If only one player remains,
he wins the pot and his cards can remain unexposed. Otherwise, the
remaining players show all five cards, and the player with the highest
ranking hand wins the pot.
Seven Card Stud is a variation where the first two cards are dealt face
down (the hole) and the third card is dealt face up. On the first card up,
the player with the lowest card must make the minimum bet. Each player
must either bet (raise), fold, or check. After the first round of betting, the
player with the highest ranking hand of shown cards opens the betting
round. Cards four through six are dealt face up, and after all players have
received that rounds card, betting occurs. The last card (the seventh card)
is dealt face down unless in an eight-player game all eight players remain;
then the last card is dealt as a community card (shared by all players). If
only one player remains, he wins (no showdown) and his cards may be left
unexposed. Otherwise, all remaining players must show their cards, and
the player with the highest ranking hand wins the pot. If more than one
player has the highest ranking hand, they split the pot or the player with
the highest suit wins. The suit order is usually spades (the highest),
hearts, diamonds, and clubs (the lowest).
Chicago Hi plays exactly like Seven Card Stud, except the player with
the highest spade in the hole splits the pot. The ace of spades is the
highest card. If the last card (seventh card) is a community card, it cannot
be used as a hole card.
Chicago Lo plays exactly like Seven Card Stud, except the player with
the lowest spade in the hole splits the pot. Players must decide whether
the ace of spaces is the lowest card or the two (deuce) of spades is the
lowest. If the last card (seventh card) is a community card, it cannot be
used as the hole card.
Over the last few years, Texas Hold Em and Omaha have become popular variations. Texas Hold Em is a seven card poker game where each
player receives two down cards and the remaining five cards are called
community cards, which are shared by all of the players. Each player
must make his best five-card poker hand using five out of the seven cards
(his two cards plus the five community cards). After the two down cards
have been dealt to all of the players, the player to the left of the dealer
must make a small blind bet. Then a round of betting occurs where each
player must bet (raise), fold, or check. Then five cards are placed face
down in the center as community cards.
The middle three community cards are turned over (face up) and
another round of betting occurs. Then the first community card is flipped
over (face up) and another betting round occurs. Finally, the fifth community card is turned over (face up) and the final round of betting occurs. If
more than one player remains, the player with the highest ranking hand
wins the pot. Any combination of the players own two down cards and the
five community cards can be used to make the best five-card poker hand.
The pot is split if a tie occurs.
Omaha is a form of Texas Hold Em that is popular in casinos and on
poker night. Omaha is a nine-card poker variation where each player is
dealt four down cards and the remaining five cards are dealt face down as
community cards (for all players to use). Each player must create the best
ranking poker hand by using two of their four cards plus three of the five
community cards. Just as in Texas Hold Em, after the first four cards are
dealt, the player to the left of the dealer must make a small blind bet.
Then players must bet (raise), fold, or check. The middle three community cards are turned face up and another round of betting occurs. The first
community card is flipped and another round of betting occurs. The last
(fifth) community card is turned over and the last round of betting occurs.
The players remaining show their cards, and the player with the best
ranking poker hand wins the pot.
Special Considerations
A deck of cards contains 52 cards. If there are eight players playing Seven
Card Stud, the number of cards needed is 56. If all eight players are still in
the game, the seventh card dealt is dealt as a community card, where all
players must use the same card as their seventh (or down) card.
The same scenario can occur in Five Card Draw poker where there are
eight players with five initially dealt cards and each player discards three
cards, thereby totaling 64 cards needed. If additional cards are needed in
Five Card Draw poker, then before a players discarded cards are added to
the pile of discarded cards, the pile of discarded cards are shuffled and the
discarding player receives his replacement cards. Then the discarded
cards are added to the pile of discarded cards. This way no player can
receive his discarded cards, and each player will receive replacement
cards.
A players hand is defined as nine cards, where the first seven cards are
used to analyze the players hand value (ranking). A hand can hold five
cards (Five Card Draw and Five Card Stud), seven cards (Seven Card Stud,
Chicago, and Hold Em), or nine cards (Omaha), so the maximum would be
nine.
63
Chapter 7
Research
64
Chapter 7
SEAL Platoon
A SEAL platoon consists of 8 to 16 members, including two officers, one
chief, and 5 to 13 enlisted men such as a point man, a patrol leader, a radioman, 60 gunners, and a rear security man.
The West Coast SEAL teams are responsible for the Pacific Rim, Far
East, and Africa/Middle East. The East Coast SEAL teams are responsible
for South and Central America, Europe, Russia, and the Mediterranean/Eastern Block territories.
The commander is of rank lieutenant or higher and is in communication
with the Task Unit Headquarters with his PRC 117, which his radioman is
equipped with, and an MX-300 UHF to instruct his snipers and shooters.
The commander patrols as the leader and trails the initial chaos of entry to
better control the platoon.
The assault force commander wears a helmet/radio headset, a SPIE rig
harness hookup, Nomex gloves, a UDT life jacket, a sit harness, and a
Nomex flight suit. He also carries an MP-5 (primary weapon), a secondary
weapon (a pistol), flash crashes in a pouch, tie ties for prisoner handling,
an UHF MX300-R hand-held radio, medical IV, a one-quart water bottle, a
gunshot kit, a gas mask, and grenade inside the grenade pouch.
The breacher is responsible for forced entry into a closed area by utilizing explosives (breaching charges) that accurately blast objects forward,
away from the assault team. He can also use his sledgehammer to break
down doors and walls and is an expert at picking locks if a stealth entry is
needed. They train in specialized courses like applied explosive technology and SEAL weapons systems. The breacher wears a helmet, body
armor, a Nomex flight suit, Nomex gloves, SPIE rig hookup, a UDT life
jacket, and a sit harness. He carries a Remington 870 12-gauge shotgun
(primary weapon), spare magazines of ammo, a secondary weapon, a crow
bar, a mag light, a sledgehammer, SPIE rigging, a one-quart water bottle,
flash crash grenades, a gas mask, MK-13 flares, and a gunshot medical kit
and IV.
The sniper is a skilled assassin utilizing deadly skills and camouflage
outfits. Snipers rely on real-time intelligence data from the commander.
Some missions have the snipers precede the assault team by several days
and perform special reconnaissance for the team from a hidden position.
When instructed by their commander, the snipers will initiate the assault
by removing any guards or terrorists and cover the assault teams entry
into the target area. The snipers are a valuable asset of the assault team.
The assault force sniper wears a helmet/radio headset, SPIE rig hookup,
body armor, a sit harness, and a Nomex flight suit. He carries an M-16
(primary weapon) with an Aimpoint 3000 optical sight, a .45-caliber handgun (secondary weapon), 40mm grenade vest fully loaded, a UHF
MX300-R hand-held radio, and a gunshot kit.
SEAL Weapons
A Colt .45 is a handgun with an immense amount of power for its size. The
Colt .45 large caliber has a force that will stop any aggressive assailant (a
huge advantage, especially in trenches). Many SEALs still prefer the Colt
.45 over the new P226.
65
Chapter 7
Research
66
Chapter 7
Another SEAL handgun, the P9, is a 9mm automatic that utilizes the
H7K roller-delayed blowback technology. The P9 is an inch shorter than
the Colt .45 and half a pound lighter.
The M16 and M203 assault rifles have 40mm grenade launchers. The
M203 can be attached to the barrel and foregrip of the M14, M16, and Colt
727.
The MP5 compact submachine gun can shoot 9mm rounds at 800
rounds per minute. The gun uses the unique roller-delayed blowback
technology, which allows the gun to fire in a fully locked breach position.
The MP5 chamber is sealed off by a series of locks and cams, which gives
the shooter accuracy when the first round is fired and can mean the difference between success and failure. The MP5 can fire a single shot, a
three-round burst, or a full automatic at 800 rounds per minute.
The M60 is a tripod-mounted weapon weighing 23 pounds and using
7.62mm caliber ammunition. Normally, the M60 is a three-person operating weapon, but SEALs operate it as a one-man weapon. A SEAL platoon
may have two to three members carrying an M60 so opposing forces may
think the SEAL platoon has more members than it really has.
SEAL Vehicles
A desert HumVee is a new SEAL workhorse desert terrain vehicle.
A desert patrol vehicle (fast attack vehicle) is good for long-range
reconnaissance and rescue missions. It has no armament and is vulnerable
to attack. The DPV can travel fast, is very agile, and can traverse any
terrain.
A rigid inflatable boat (RIB) is an extremely fast inflatable boat with a
solid hull. The RIB comes in two sizes: the 24-foot and the 30-foot high
buoyancy extreme weather craft. The 30-foot craft can get close to the
beach if the SEAL platoon is under fire due to its water jet propulsion
system.
The Mark V is an 82-foot craft propelled by two 2,285 horsepower HP
MTU 12V386 TE94 engines with two KaMeWa K505 water jets. The craft
holds 2,600 gallons of fuel and can cruise at speeds between 25 and 45
knots (with a top speed of 50 knots). It can hold a payload of 6,400 pounds
and has a range of over 500 nautical miles.
SEAL Training
Land warfare training begins with small tactical unit basics to full mission
profiles training in a simulated combat scenario. The platoon will practice
shooting for hours on end using .556, .762, and 9mm rounds. Immediate
action drills (IADs) are fire and maneuver drills through live fire, day and
evening practices, with pop-up flares, smoke bombs, practice drop-off
charges, and incoming rounds of ammo. This training is followed by a
week of field training exercises where the platoon is semi-isolated in a
simulated combat scenario. During this week, they will practice special
reconnaissance, standoff weapons direct action raid, body snatch, point
ambush, and combat search and rescue. The training may include a desert
patrol vehicle or a helicopter assist.
In Puerto Rico, hydrographic (water) reconnaissance includes underwater demolition of submerged obstacles, a combat swimming course, and
three weeks of diving. A full mission profile consists of being dropped off
by a sea vessel or an aircraft for a 30-mile over the horizon swim, followed by a turtleback (full dive gear surface kicking toward a dive point), a
four-hour, multi-leg dive into an enemy harbor to set limpet mines on the
hulls of the target ships, and then evading the anti-swimmer measures
designed by the training staff.
Puerto Rico also hosts the jungle warfare training along with Panama.
Missions through the dense jungle are practiced using a pump shotgun to
clear the dense foliage. Thousand-yard patrols are done, which can take
several hours as the path is cleared and the extreme humidity has sweat
dripping down your back. Setting up jungle hammocks is required and
practiced. The jungle training simulates the SEAL teams in a Vietnam
scenario as well as SEAL Team Fours territories in South and Central
America fighting the drug war.
SEAL Teams Two and Five operate in cold, snowy regions. In Alaska,
Montana, Upstate New York, and Norway the extreme cold weather/winter training is conducted. This training includes cross-country skiing,
snowshoeing, winter and mountain warfare tactics, survival, escape, and
evasion techniques. Drills using the combat rubber raiding craft (CRRC)
are conducted over 60 miles of open ocean.
Entering and exiting a moving submarine is practiced (also called submarine lock out/lock in). Exiting and entering the submarine through a dry
dock shelter is also practiced (DDS MSLO/LI or dry dock shelter mass
swimmer lock out/lock in).
Close quarter battle (CQB) requires extensive training, fast recognition, and good reflexes. Some CQB situations include taking down a house
one room at a time, hostage rescue in a bus, train, or airplane, and securing a ship after boarding it by air or sea. Advanced courses in explosive
entry methods (like blowing open a door without injuring the platoon),
room entry techniques (firing your CAR-15 or MP-5 submachine gun), and
blinding techniques (using flash bangs) are part of the SEAL training. The
ability to properly identify the hostages and the terrorists in a split second
in a terrorist/hostage situation is practiced for many hours.
Special missions called VBSS (visit, board, search, and seizure) are critical skills since these missions have the entire platoon securing and
controlling a ship.
Special mission training includes unconventional warfare (UW) simulated behind the guerrilla lines scenario, foreign internal defense (FID)
training foreigners during peacetime, direct action (DA) where a potential
use of force is warranted (ambushes, hostage rescue, target assaults),
counter terrorist (CT), and special reconnaissance (SR) where information
gathering is done.
67
Chapter 7
Research
68
Chapter 7
Break Time
At this point we have learned a lot about the Navy SEAL team and platoon
responsibilities.
Lots of gaming ideas and concepts should be circling your brain. One
idea is a SEAL team game with several missions, such as a hostage rescue
in a Middle East town like Beirut, Lebanon, a VBSS mission to seize and
control a ship, and a mission to neutralize a South American drug
operation.
Perhaps SEAL training is the design you want to begin with, which
could lead to several choice missions utilizing the skills learned. There are
so many different design concepts that can arise from just a few pages of
information about Navy SEALs that a day ago you might not have known.
Research helps solidify your initial vision and puts real life situations and
facts into your design. Players require a believable storyline and realistic
gameplay.
Multiplayer games of this nature have several types of play: deathmatch, capture the flag (CTF), cooperative, and king of the hill (KOTH).
In deathmatch, all players compete against each other to eliminate the
most opponents. In capture the flag, players must seek out and capture
the opposing sides team flag and return the flag to their own home base
to win. In cooperative play, all players control one of the single players
squad mates. In king of the hill, the player who occupies a specific marked
area for the longest cumulative time wins the game.
them all vital experience. The key to winning SEAL Team is patience and good
observation skills.
Good: Team coordination and authentic
hand signals used for tactical operations is
well done.
Bad: Underwhelming graphics and long
pauses waiting for realistic action to occur
really hurt this game.
Zombie Interactives SPEC OPS, 1998 IBM PC
Spec Ops had a few versions, such as SPEC OPS: Rangers Lead the Way,
SPEC OPS: Ranger Team Bravo, SPEC OPS: Stealth Patrol, SPEC OPS 2,
SPEC OPS: Omega Squad, and SPEC OPS: Ranger Elite.
SPEC OPS: Ranger
SPEC OPS: Ranger was one of the first games of this genre. Ranger was a
first-person shooter with a slower tempo, simulating real world objectives.
The team used standard issue weapons for missions based on modern day
political hot spots.
Good: A sound AI system.
SPEC OPS: Ranger Team Bravo
SPEC OPS: Ranger Team Bravo had several new missions. The first mission was in Pale, Bosnia, where the team had to track down a Serbian war
criminal. Rough terrain and snow made the task slow. The mission was
difficult: wipe out an entire small, Serbian mountain base and capture the
Serbian war criminal alive and return him to the UN base.
The second mission takes the team to 1968 Thon An Thai, Vietnam,
where the dense jungle must be traversed in order to save a downed B-52
pilot as hard rain and the dark night skies impair vision.
The third mission is to Rayat, Iraq, where your team must search and
destroy a biochemical facility (five targeted buildings) without causing a
toxic cloud explosion. The team must return the evidence though enemy
fire by truck to the UN base.
Good: Team Bravo had multiplayer capabilities via LAN or TCP/IP connections, which allowed six players to control two rangers each. The host
player could set time limits, number of lives, level, and mode of play
(deathmatch, cooperative play, or team vs. team). Single and multiplayer
modes contained the 15 original single-player levels, 9 new single-player
levels, and 7 special deathmatch levels. The graphics had crisper textures
and enhanced lighting effects.
69
Chapter 7
Research
70
Chapter 7
Ranger and enemy skins were more defined and cleaner. Special effects
like muzzle flashes were more realistic. Weather conditions functioned
better, which included snow, lightning, thunder, and hard rain.
Bad: The snow effect, while functional, was not well done graphically.
Each mission had a set of criteria that had to be met for a successful mission. Any unsuccessful mission had to start again.
The game contained poor AI (the first version). Enemies were stationary
and easy to kill, and the computer-controlled team members had weak
path finding.
Algorithms had enemies often getting stuck behind trees, bushes, and
objects. The team members also wouldnt move when fired upon. Many
2D sprites were used to simulate a 3D object so trees, bushes, and objects
looked repetitive and fake. Special effects like smoke, explosions, and
weather were obvious 2D sprites, and the human characters had a low
polygon (poly) count.
SPEC OPS: Rangers Lead the Way
Rangers Lead the Way is a realistic,
action oriented, real-time 3D-person
game based on the elite warfare units.
The goal is to control your team of
rangers and eliminate the opponents
targets in a timely manner while completing your missions subtasks.
Good: Extraordinary visuals like fancy fireworks and light sourcing. Realistic team movements and terrain features, full mouse support, and the
annoying timer was removed (time allotted to complete a mission).
Yosemite Entertainments Navy SEALs, PS2, and IBM PC
Navy SEALs is a squad-based action game where players select a team of
highly trained commandos by recruiting each team member, equipping
them, and setting their exact path for the mission. During the mission, the
player controls one team member, and the computer (AI) controls the
remaining team members. Navy SEALs has a unique helmet interface that
lets the player switch between the team members that they control. To
successfully complete a mission, understanding each team members special abilities (such as technical specialist, explosive expert, sniper, and
weapons specialist) is required. Navy SEALs missions include invading a
small island and infiltrating corporate buildings. Each mission has three
squads of four team members each.
Good: Great graphics
The weapons used in Delta Force are: Barret .50 light fifty model 82A1
is a long-range, high powered rifle perfect for snipers. M249 SAW (squad
automatic weapon) is a hand-held, portable machine gun that can fire 200
rounds of 5.56mm ammo. M4 5.56mm carbine assault rifle is a lightweight
and accurate, gas powered rifle used extensively for close quarter combat.
M40A1 sniper rifle is a hand-made rifle based on the Remington 700 and
made by gunsmiths at the rifle team equipment shop at Quantico, Va. for
superior accuracy. Heckler & Koch 9mm MP5 SD submachine gun is a
silent and accurate submachine gun capable of single-shot, burst, and automatic firing. Cot M 1911A1 .45 is a superior handgun that is handmade by
gunsmiths at the rifle team equipment shop at Quantico, Va. High standard
.22 pistol is a silent and super accurate handgun. M-72 LAW (light antitank
71
Chapter 7
Research
72
Chapter 7
weapon) launches a single 66mm explosive round that can penetrate a target with up to 350mm of armor. M18 claymore is an anti-personnel mine
combining a sheet of C4 plastic explosive and 700 ball bearings inside a
curved plate. An M57 remote firing device (called a clacker) has the
exploding ball bearings propelled in 60-degree arcs traveling at a high
speed up to 50 meters. Satchel charges are packed with high explosives
for demolishing buildings and walls.
Good: Free Internet support
Bad: Lack of control over the computer controlled teammates and squads
Novalogics Delta Force 2
Delta Force 2 has over 40 day and night missions in
weather conditions like snow, rain, and fog. The
multiplayer mode has new games like Attack and
Defend, Search and Destroy, and Flag Ball.
New weapons include a
silenced Heckler & Koch .45
USSOCOM (United States Special Operations Command), the
Heckler & Koch P11 (an underwater pistol), a Russian-made underwater
rifle, time-delay grenades, a laser designator, and tracer rounds. A LAR V
rebreather for extended underwater submersion is also available as well
as a field-surveillance video camera.
A lot of veteran fans requested a mid-mission site to change and fix weapons. So an armory building was created to allow players to change gear
and fix machine guns and grenade launchers.
Weapons: Heckler & Koch 9mm MP5 SD 3 submachine gun, M249
SAW (squad automatic weapon), M-72 LAW (light antitank weapon),
M40A1 sniper rifle, Barret .50 light fifty model 82A1. These five are the
same as in Delta Force.
Other weapons: 5.66mm APS underwater assault rifle shoots penetrating 150mm long darts. The master key (a M4 combined with a shotgun)
is a gas-operated rifle and an attached shotgun that can easily remove any
door. Heckler & Koch P11 underwater pistol is a silent, electrically
charged pistol. Heckler & Koch USSOCOM semiautomatic .45 pistol. M4
5.56 carbine assault rifle and M203 grenade launcher fires 40mm
73
Chapter 7
Research
74
Chapter 7
The multiplayer mode has capture the flag, king of the hill, and cooperative modes, and up to 50 players can play at a time. Players can choose
their teams from sniper, demolition, close quarter battle specialists,
aquatic experts, and heavy gunners.
Weapon loadouts have increased from four (primary weapon, sidearm, grenades, and ammo or a LAW) to five (primary, secondary, sidearm,
explosives, and auxiliary gear). The newest weapon of the future is the
Alliant Techsystems OICW assault rifle. Additional weapons include the
Steyr AUG light assault rifle, MM-1 grenade launcher, the Pancor
jackhammer shotgun, the PSG-1, the FN mag light machine gun, the
Heckler & Koch G11 assault rifle, Calico submachine gun, the Heckler &
Koch .45 SOCOM, the Glock 18 submachine gun pistol, the AT-4 light
anti-armor weapon, and a medic pack for multiplayer medics.
Another feature is picking up weapons from dead opponents. They use
the same weapons to which you have access.
Good: Sharper, more detailed graphics
Basic System Requirements:
Video Card: Direct 3D compatible video card required. 3dfx Voodoo 3 or
NVIDIA TNT2 recommended. Supported 3D cards include: 3DFX Voodoo
2, 3, 5, NVIDIA TNT, TNT2, GeForce, GeForce2, ATI Rage Fury Max,
Matrox G400
Operating System: PC, CD-ROM, Windows 95, 98, Me, 2000 (DirectX 7.0
or greater)
CPU Type and Speed: Minimum Pentium II, Celeron 400, or equivalent
required, Pentium II 400 MHz or equivalent recommended
Hard Drive Space: 200 MB available
System Memory: 64 MB required (with AGP video card: 128 MB
recommended)
CD-ROM Speed: 4x CD-ROM drive
DirectX: DirectX 7.0 or greater required (included on CD)
Sound Cards: Windows compatible. Voice-over net (VON) requires full
duplex sound card
Supported Controllers: Windows compatible mouse
Delta Force: Task Force Dagger uses NovaLogics updated Land Warrior
engine and is designed as a stand-alone mission pack with new characters,
weapons, and single and multiplayer levels.
Delta Force: Task Force Dagger includes 25 all new missions designed
to test the teams reactions and bravery while operating under fire. This
version is the first Delta Force game where the player represents different
Special Forces soldiers with unique abilities and has over 30 weapons to
select from, including 17 brand new weapons. Each mission is realistic and
includes a strategic recon and objective, such as locate and neutralize,
infiltrate and secure, and escort and protect civilians. UAVs (unmanned
aerial vehicles) can be used for spying and calling in devastating air
strikes. Missions include a takeover of the Kandahar airport, a raid of
rebel headquarters in Mazar-i-Sharif, an ambush to a convoy near the
Pakistani border, the elimination of a command and control compound in
Kandahar, the demolition of bunkers in the foothills of Kabul, destroying a
75
Chapter 7
Research
76
Chapter 7
SAM site, escorting a journalist through hostile territory, and raiding the
Abu Khabab chemical weapons facility.
The 17 new weapons in Delta Force include primary and secondary
weapons, sidearm weapons, grenades, and explosives. The primary weapons are the Diemaco C8 carbine with ELCAN scope, M16A2 with M203,
M4 SOPMOD with ACOG scope and Knight Rail accessory system, SA80
individual weapon, M60 assault rifle, M60E3 assault rifle, M24 sniper rifle,
M40A3 sniper rifle, and AW sniper rifle. M4 SOPMOD has a telescopic
butt-stock with ACOG scope and KRAS, which is a 5.56mm assault
weapon produced for the U.S. Army, and Knight Rail accessory system.
The AW sniper rifle is a 7.62mm sniper rifle, a second-generation sniper
rifle developed for Artic warfare functioning in temperatures below 30.
The secondary weapon includes the F89 Austeyr. The sidearm weapons are the Browning HP, Sig P226, FN Fortynine, and F97 (Glock 19).
The Browning HP is a 9mm side arm that was designed in 1935 by John
M. Browning. The Browning HP is in active service all over the world.
The grenades include the US Mk3A2 concussion grenade, and the
explosives include the Alliant SLAM (selectable lightweight attack munition) and the M72 LAW (light anti-tank weapon). Mk3A2 concussion
grenade is an offensive hand grenade, commonly referred to as the concussion grenade, designed to produce casualties.
The tactics include scenarios like spying on the enemy and calling in air
strikes, controlling the cameras on unmanned aerial vehicles to gather
visual intelligence and plan your attack with the element of surprise, and
calling in devastating air strikes to take out key SAM and SCUD missile
sites.
Multiplayer mode NovaWorld or LANs have ten new multiplayer maps,
deathmatch, capture-the-flag, and co-op modes. Players can create infinite
game types and maps with the mission editor.
Novalogics Delta Force Urban Warfare
The Delta Force franchise set the standard in
first-person military action shooters when it was
released and has a customer base of 2.6 million PC
gamers globally. Now Delta Force Urban Warfare is
designed for the PlayStation
game console in an all-new
Delta Force experience by
Rebellion.
Diverse, intense gameplay includes wild shoot-outs combined with
stealth tactics, close quarters combat (CQC) with strategic infiltration,
time-sensitive ops, sniping, and demolition. An advanced enemy AI lets
players engage and defeat enemies that react to gunfire, dive for cover,
employ tactical maneuvers, and pursue using a players blood trail.
The new firepower and hi-tech gear includes assault and sniper rifles,
grenade and rocket launchers, plus remote explosives, night vision and
thermal goggles, combat radar, and a security camera scrambler.
77
Chapter 7
Research
78
Chapter 7
plant a phone bug and a surveillance camera in a key area, and leave
unnoticed.
After a mission is successfully completed, two new modes are available: lone wolf and terrorist hunt. In lone wolf the player traverses the
map alone with thirty randomly played enemies on alert. In terrorist hunt
the player wanders the map and must kill all enemy characters.
Rogue Spear still has the practice mission and branch campaign options
as in Rainbow Six. There are new orders that can be given, which are
cover, defend, and snipe.
Rogue Spear has weather conditions like snow and rain. The characters
can now crouch, limp, die in realistic manners, and peek around corners.
Rogue Spear has three new sniper rifles and new assault rifles.
The watch mode allows players to see the mission as it is carried out
and enter it at any point.
Good: Better graphics with greater levels of detail, larger mission terrain,
and better character animations. Highly decorated buildings with
nice-looking interiors including randomly wandering civilians. The textured planning map looks great. Graphics support now includes 1024x768
resolution. The snipers are much better to control. Multiplayer has great
options like the ability to play Rogue Spear on Mplayer and MSN Gaming
Zone. Also, the assassination mode in multiplayer (to defend an NPC, a
building, or a base) is great.
Bad: Graphics have polygonal clipping problems. First- to third-person
switching has misaligned texture and clipping problems. The AI was
fine-tuned (enemies now act more realistic) but perhaps too much since
enemies rarely miss. Computer-controlled team members move and react
worse than in Rainbow Six. Team members still get stuck in doorways,
stuck on ladders, and fall off elevated walkways. The new planning interface is cluttered and hard to understand. The team members still cant
jump, crawl, or swim, which would make the game better.
The first three missions are rather boring to play.
Rogue Spear: Black Thorn
Team Rainbow has a new deadly enemy that knows how
Rainbow thinks, how Rainbow acts, and how to stay one
step ahead.
Black Thorn features new multiplayer mode (lone
wolf), up to 16 players in multiplayer mode, six new
training/multiplayer maps, more than ten new weapons
for single and multiplayer modes, and a bonus CD (The
Making of Tom Clancys Ghost Recon) containing developer interviews, gameplay video, hints and tips, weapon previews, and
more.
Minimum system requirements include a CPU with 266 MHz Pentium
II processor or better, an operating system with Windows 95/98/2000, 64
MB RAM (128 MB recommended), a video card with DirectX 8 or higher,
79
Chapter 7
Research
80
Chapter 7
81
Chapter 7
Research
82
Chapter 7
included in Raven Shield, and you have a lot of high-tech weaponry that
matches real-world available weapons.
Some of the new weapons in Raven Shield are the MTAR-21 9mm submachine gun, the Mac-11/9 9mm submachine gun, the Micro-Uzi 9mm
submachine gun, the SR-2 9mm submachine gun, the USAS-12 12-gauge
shotgun, the TAR-21 5.56mm assault rifle, the Type 95 5.56mm assault
rifle, the VSS Vintorez 9x39mm sniper rifle, and the 23E 5.56mm machine
gun. Also at your disposal are claymore mines, tear gas grenades, gas
masks, smoke grenades, and frag impact grenades.
Baseball Basics
A baseball team consists of nine main players, which include the pitcher,
catcher, infielders (first baseman, second baseman, third baseman, and
shortstop), and the outfielders (left fielder, center fielder, and right
fielder).
The baseball game lasts nine innings, unless a tie exists; then it continues until one side has outscored its opponent. An inning consists of each
team playing until they have three outs by a strikeout, pop-out, or tag out.
If a batter has been thrown four pitches outside the strike zone, that
player advances or walks to first base (called a BB or base on balls).
A strike occurs when a pitch is swung at and missed, hit in foul territory
on the first two strike counts, or called a strike by the umpire. Three
strikes and the player is out (called a strikeout or SO). Three outs
retires the side (half of an inning). A fielders choice is when a batter
pops the ball into the infield, which becomes an automatic out regardless
of whether the ball is caught or not. A double play is when two outs
occur in one play. A triple play is when three outs occur in one play. A
doubleheader is two baseball games with the same teams back to back.
83
Chapter 7
Research
84
Chapter 7
The infield, or diamond, has a home plate and three bases that are 90
feet apart with 15-square-inch bases. The pitchers mound is 60.5 feet
from home plate and is raised ten inches above the field.
The pitchers arsenal consists of the fast ball (an up-spin pitch), a curve
ball (a down-spin pitch), a change-up (slower to fast curve ball), a slider (a
side spinner), or the breaking ball (change of direction ball). The pitches
can fly over the plate from 50 to 100 mph.
A foul ball is a ball batted that lands in foul territory, an area behind
home plate, the area left of the left foul line, or the area right of the right
foul line. A foul ball cannot be the third strike. A fair ball is a ball batted
that lands in the outfield or anywhere between the first base foul line and
the third base foul line (including over the outfield wall). On either side of
home plate is the batters box, which is six feet long by four feet wide. A
run is when a player advances around the bases and safely touches
home plate. A steal occurs when a player advances to the next base
without the ball being hit. Stealing usually occurs when the ball is being
pitched.
Umpires judge pitches that the batter hasnt swung at and determines if
they are within the strike zone or not (they are ruled as a strike or a
ball). A swung-at ball is always a strike or a hit. A tap (usually light) of
the ball is called a bunt.
A baseball is 9 to 9.25 inches in circumference. The bat (wood or metal)
can be up to 42 inches long and 2.75 inches in diameter. Fielders (all nine
of them) wear padded leather gloves on their non-throwing hand. The
catcher and first baseman wear special gloves. The catcher also wears a
face mask, shin guards, and a chest-protecting pad.
In Major League baseball there are two leagues, the American and
National League. The baseball season starts in April and ends in October.
The best teams win their conference championship (two divisions in each
league) and play the World Series. The All-Star game is played by players
who are voted on by fans to play on their leagues team, either the
National League or American League team. The All-Star managers are the
previous years championship teams managers who select their All-Star
teams pitchers.
Baseball Data
The first and oldest rule in research is check and recheck your facts.
Never assume that the data given to you by a reputable source is accurate
and complete. Check other reliable statistics sources like CBS sports or
ESPN web sites.
When I received the data for General Mills All-Star Baseball, the data
was missing important statistic fields and individual player statistics, had
inaccurate or jumbled statistics (like 367 was 376), and needed significant
checking to verify the given data and supply the missing data needed.
Baseball data was divided into two major groups: team data and player
data. Team data included the team name, team graphics (logo, 3D stadium,
team uniform for home and away games, and so on), stadium location,
franchise facts, ticket prices, and club owner. The player data was categorized by player bio, graphics, all batting information, fielding information,
and pitching info (if the player is a pitcher).
Player bio information included the players birthday, hometown, position (manager, coach, pitcher, catcher, infielder, or outfielder), salary,
height, weight, and so on. The graphics included the players face texture
or skin file name, the players uniform (including the number and special
patches worn), and so on. The players batting information included batting statistics, batting side right, left, or switch hitter, special batting
stance, batting swing and running to base animations, and so on. The fielding information included catches right- or left-handed, fielding statistics,
special running and catching animations, and so on. The pitching information included the pitch type thrown, pitching statistics, pitching specialty
(like relief pitcher or starting pitcher), and so on.
I wanted the players personal data (like birth date) to tell gamers interesting facts when they played the game, like Today is the following
players birthday. This feature becomes an easy one by reading the computers internal clock (date and time) and reading all of the players
birthdays from the database that youve created and modified. Like baseball trading cards, I wanted to supply the players height, weight, and
hometown for announcers to add to their colorful commentary or as a statistic used along with the players thumbnail photo as theyre coming to
bat. The players hitting statistics are needed to properly compute the
results of the games hitting eye and hand twitch skills used in sports
games. A home run hitter would more often strike out or hit triples and
home runs over hitting singles and doubles. Pitchers, on the other hand,
generally strike out or hit singles. Given the exact same swing data (the
same pitch type and strike zone location, the same hit type like a power
swing, and the same connection timing of the bat with the ball), you
would expect the real world results to vary greatly if the batter was a
home run hitter rather than a pitcher.
One rule I decided early on in the data gathering process was to be consistent and able to explain my decisions to a hardcore fan. One such
example of this was with American League pitchers who do not bat,
except in certain games in the World Series. The first data I used was the
last year the pitcher had a valid batting statistic. Then I would use that
pitchers lifetime statistics for batting. Lastly I used any minor league or
previous (to becoming a professional pitcher) batting statistic I could find.
Generally, I found most of the statistics I needed.
One hard-to-find statistic was running and throwing speeds for all players to accurately calculate base running and field throwing to tag a runner
out. I tried to find a 100-yard dash timing statistic to grade players into
several speed categories (for both running, stealing, and throwing).
Lets examine the real world of baseball versus the computer, statistic-based AI we need to design. The situation to examine is a runner on
first base when the batter hits the ball into center field. The experienced
85
Chapter 7
Research
86
Chapter 7
center fielder picks up the ball and throws it to the second baseman. This
is an every-game, real-life situation. How can the computer accurately
recreate this scenario?
Based on the twitch indicators and that batters real-world batting statistics, the resulting hit or strike can be calculated. The twitch indicators
include the type of pitch, the selected aimed at strike zone location, the
type of batting power, and the bat-to-ball connection timing. The batters
real-world batting statistics are percentages for a strike, a single, a double,
a triple, a homerun, and a pop out. The balls trajectory and speed can be
accurately computed, including weather, wind, and gravity factors.
Now that the balls flight and expected landing position are known
(through calculations), each player in the field calculates, based on his
present location and running speed, who can get to the ball the fastest (in
this case, the answer is probably the center fielder). The center fielder
runs toward the balls final location, which was already calculated. Upon
picking up the ball (our calculations determined that a catch couldnt be
made in time), he looks at the runner on first base. The first calculation
needed is the distance from the first base runners current position (he
might have been leading off the base) to second base multiplied by his
standard base running time (remember that 100-yard dash statistic!).
Then the same calculation is made for the batter running from home plate
to first base. A calculation is made for the center fielder, knowing the distance from his position to first base and his position to second base and his
throwing speed statistic. Each calculated scenario is compared: (1) the
center fielders throw to first base time versus the batters running to first
base time and (2) the center fielders throwing time to second base versus
the first base runners time to second base.
Obviously, whichever scenario is quicker for the center fielder to execute is the outcome of this play. In this case, the center fielder will throw
to the second base player who (calculated as being closest to the goal of
stopping or tagging out the runner who was on first base) is closest to that
position. This is a simple description of simulating in AI the real-world
thinking and spontaneous actions that we see every day.
Baseball Games
The current selection of top baseball games are published by the majors
including Interplay (recently halted a new version of baseball), Microsoft,
Acclaim, and 3DO and Electronic Arts.
Interplay published VR Baseball, which was last published as Interplay
Sports Baseball 2000. Microsofts offering is MS Baseball 2001 for Windows. EA Sports, which proclaimed We are Sports, has their studio 3DO
and its head, Trip Hawkins, publishing High Heat Baseball 2002 for Windows, the PlayStation 2 (High Heat Baseball 2003 for PSX 2 E), and
Gameboy Advance (both in 2002 and 2003 versions). EAs predecessor
baseball offering was Triple Play Baseball. Acclaim has their All Star Baseball for 2002 and 2003 for the Game Cube, PSX 2, and Microsofts Xbox.
87
Chapter 7
Research
88
Chapter 7
89
Chapter 7
Research
90
Chapter 7
smaller swing radius but more power in his hit. Pitchers utilize the same
indicator method as hitters, where the pitching statistics are correlated to
the desired pitch type and speed.
Good: Great detailed player movements from extensive motion captured
actor sessions, 3D realistic stadiums, high resolution, and multi-polygonal
player models. Players animate and move more fluidly with high-resolution digital imaging of players faces and individual player posturing and
trademark movements. Comprehensive statistics tabulate individual
player and team game and season statistics with analysis.
System requirements are the Pentium 166, 32 MB RAM, Win 95/98,
DirectX 7, 3D accelerator card with 4 MB RAM.
Electronic Arts Triple Play Baseball
EAs Triple Play 2000 is an
arcade-style or offensive
baseball game, and fans and
critics prefer a more realistic
simulation experience in
sports games. For the PC
Windows market and the
PlayStation, Triple Play was
the best-selling baseball game.
Triple Play features stadium flyovers, was the first game with the now
common two-man announcing team, and has on-the-fly commentary based
on the players season. Smooth, well-animated graphics are apparent in
Triple Play 2000 in the players movements, like swinging, pitching, or
sliding, which all look sharp and detailed. The realistic polygonal models
look natural, and the days of blocky and stiff 3D models are long gone. The
stadiums are graphically impressive from Kansas Citys waterfalls and
Boston Fenways green monster outfield to Baltimore Camden Yards
right field brick building. Shadows based on the time of day as well as
weather are just one of the realistic details present in Triple Play 2000.
The Jumbotron screen depicts batting and running players as a
screen within a screen action. Other detailed graphic features include dust
clouds when a player slides into a base or off the players cleats when the
bat taps the footwear before entering the batters box. Even the clouds
across the sky or the orange-red sunset shows the graphic detail achievements. Players have facial animations and realistic expressions. The ball in
motion has a slight comet-tail visual showing a fast moving ball. Broadcast-quality camera angles and perspectives with zooming and panning are
so seamless you begin to think that a cameraman is controlling the viewing. Numerous home run animations depict visuals like a swing from four
different angles, instant replay montages, and animations where the ball
flies out of the stadium while another one shows the balls flight from its
POV.
91
Chapter 7
Research
92
Chapter 7
With a 3D Card
Windows 95/98
DirectX 7
Pentium 166
32 MB RAM
4x CD-ROM
110 MB disk drive
2 MB SVGA video card
DirectX7.0 sound card, 16-bit
Multiplayer:
28.8 or greater modem TCP/IP
or IPX (network play)
Multiplayer:
28.8 or greater modem TCP/IP
or IPX (network play)
Computer Gaming Worlds Top Ten Games of All Time. Gamepens Best
PC Sports Game of 2000.
Electronic Arts Triple Play 2002
Electronic Arts decided to hire a new developer (Pandemic) to design and produce Triple Play 2002. The
new version features numerous new motion capture
animations, photo-realistic player head scans, and a
TV-style look. The game has 500 animations with 40
signature animations and 160 star player face scans
with each player consisting of 4,800 polygons. The
commentators are Bob Costas and Harold Reynolds.
Triple Play offers the 2002 schedule and previous year
statistics tracking over 50 items. Fantasy draft, End of Season awards,
and create a player (over 30 traits to modify) are also included.
3DO High Heat Baseball 2003
On the consoles, 3DO High Heat Baseball competes
with EAs Triple Play 2002. High Heat has new fielding
animations and smooth batting animations. Theyve
added the ability to draft and create a player. For the
batter, there are now hot and cold batting zones. For the
pitcher, fatigue is now calculated.
The game has 1,500 animations with 200 signature
animations and 350 star player face scans with each
player consisting of 6,000 polygons. The commentators
are Dave OBrien and Chuck Valencia. High Heat offers the 2002 schedule
and previous year statistics tracking 78 (splits to 150) items. Franchise
mode, fantasy draft, End of Season awards, and create a player (33 traits
to modify) are also included. The game features wild pitches and passed
balls, dropped third strikes, injuries, on-field managers and coaches, and
home plate collisions.
93
Chapter 7
Research
94
Chapter 7
95
Chapter 7
Research
96
Chapter 7
also included. The game features wild pitches and passed balls, dropped
third strikes, injuries, on-field managers and coaches, and home plate
collisions.
Chapter 8
97
98
Chapter 8
sell your concept and get an interest in your game, like a license, anticipated audience (sex, age ranges of players), and pertinent data (sports
game number of players and world-wide audience numbers). After you
write the one pager to your liking, show it to avid game players and fans
as well as non-players. The one pager is important and should be understandable to everyone from business people to hardcore gamers.
Example 1
Note that in the following example the name in parentheses is a
placeholder.
(Megan Pedersen)s International Wakeboarding Open
(Megan Pedersen)s International Wakeboarding Open is a 3D, third-person wakeboarding sports competition that lets the player(s) (single and
multiplayer) compete in seven international venues and choreograph their
acrobatic maneuvers through each courses obstacles and wakes. (Megan
Pedersen)s International Wakeboarding Open will appeal to all extreme
sports enthusiasts and features the top womens wakeboarding champion
(Megan Pedersen). Wakeboarding has been featured on ESPN, ESPN2,
and OLN, reaching over 70 million households. (Megan Pedersen) has
won numerous wakeboarding championships, including the Van Triple
Crown of Wakeboarding Championship, the Wakeboarding National Championship, the World Championship, and the X Games Championship.
Wakeboarding is the fastest-growing water sport in the world, increasing over 100 percent in participation over the past three years.
Wakeboarding is a combination of surfing, skateboarding, snowboarding,
and water skiing. A wakeboard looks like a snowboard with a pair of bindings attached to it. The wakeboarder carves turns with body leans and by
rocking the board.
(Megan Pedersen)s International Wakeboarding Open has each player
competing in one to all seven countries in the circuit. The participating
countries will be the U.S.A. (Orlando, Florida); Sydney, Australia; South
Africa, Africa; Tokyo, Japan; Paris, France; Venice, Italy; and Buenos Aires,
Argentina. In the single-player mode, the player will practice his maneuvers and learn new ones. Based on the players learned skill level, he will
be able to compete for the championships. Players need to master the
basic skills before attempting the expert tricks and maneuvers. In the
multiplayer mode (via the Internet or network), players will take turns
competing in one or more countries for individual championships or the
Grand Prix of (Megan Pedersen)s International Wakeboarding Open Circuit Championship.
The intended audience will be males between the ages of 8 and 20 who
enjoy extreme sports. Also, since the presence of famed female
wakeboarder (Megan Pedersen) is featured, an anticipated female audience of those 8 to 17 is projected. The platform for this game will be the
Windows XP as the first release (Windows 2000, 98, Me, and XP compatible) with Microsofts Xbox, PlayStation 2, and the Nintendo Game Cube to
follow. Similar, successful games have been Tony Hawks Pro Skater 2 and
3 (IBM Windows CD version is $29.95 and Xbox version is $49.95), MTV
Sports Snowboarding, Konamis 1080 Snowboarding and X Games Pro
Boarder, and EAs Snowboard Super X (PlayStation 2 version is $49.95 and
Nintendo Game Cube version is $52.95). Activision plans to release Shaun
Palmers Pro Snowboarder, Mat Hoffmans Pro BMX, Kelly Slaters Pro
Surfer, and Darin Shapiros Pro Wakeboarder.
(Megan Pedersen)s International Wakeboarding Open is a 3D behind
the wakeboarder POV where the player controls the boarders lateral
movement, speed, or forward movement (by signaling to the virtual
motorboat), acrobatic maneuvers, and obstacle jumps (the slider, a kicker,
and a jump ramp). The game will contain realistic physics, animation, and
sound effects. Commentators, including (Megan Pedersen), will describe
and evaluate the wakeboarders performance. After each performance or
routine, the player can use the video replay feature to observe and
improve his tricks. Each of the seven unique country locations will have
an obstacle course that can be modified by the player before the competition begins. Players will be judged based on the 100-point system for their
technical difficulty (execution, worth 33.3 points), the in-air acrobats
(intensity, worth 33.4 points), and the seamless flow of the routine
(composition, worth 33.3 points). Like the real world of competition,
each wakeboarder has a two-fall limit.
In the single-player mode, the player can practice his tricks on various
obstacles and courses. In order to become a Pro Wakeboarder, the player
must successfully show an understanding of the beginner, intermediate,
and advanced tricks, grabs, spins, and inverts. (Megan Pedersen) will
coach and evaluate the player as he progresses from novice to Pro
Wakeboarder status. The beginner wakeboarder can learn simple air
maneuvers and grabs like the Butterslide 180, the Surf Carve, and the
Ollie Blind 180. Then the player can practice the intermediate tricks like
the Indy Blind 180, the Scarecrow, and the Back Roll and finally advance to
the difficult inverts, spins, and grabs like the Whirlybird, the Elephant, and
the Wrapped KGB.
(Megan Pedersen)s International Wakeboarding Open will be a highly
anticipated arrival into the extreme sports gaming world with its
fast-paced, turbo-charged acrobatic maneuvers, realistic sound effects,
orchestrated ambient sound track, and commentators describing the
wakeboarders tricks, as well as having the (Megan Pedersen) name, a
dominant female competitor in the world of extreme sports.
99
Chapter 8
100
Chapter 8
Example 2
Here is another one pager example.
Years ago I met a student studying to become a medical doctor who was
addicted to Mortal Kombat. He wanted to design a game where the player
would be inside the human body combating real life diseases like cancer.
The cancer cells would invade the body and the player would gather his
super force of red and white blood cells, the Chemo Team, and Radiation
Sensations, using their martial art techniques to fight and destroy the disease. This game would not only be fun for the fighting genre fans but
would also teach people about diseases (what the disease does, where it
attacks the human body, symptoms, and what to look for as it progresses)
and their treatments (the latest cures, various treatment options, and
length of time needed to destroy a disease or put it in remission).
We worked together to expand this concept by including the entire
human life (from infant to old age). We called this game Medical Kombat
and felt that it would appeal to all ages, especially children 13 to 18 as well
as medical students like my co-designer.
Several films have been made on this subject, such as Fantastic Voyage
and Osmosis Jones.
Medical Kombat
Medical Kombat is a third-person POV martial arts/first-person shooter
that takes place in a real human body from birth to death as the good side
combats disease and viruses. The player or players in multiplayer mode,
as the good side, will learn all about many diseases and their symptoms
and causes, as well as the past and latest medical treatments.
The player will select an age range to play from, such as an infant,
young child, or young adult to adulthood. The infant diseases will include
jaundice, convulsions, seizures, asthma, hernia, and so on. The young children diseases will include viruses and ailments like mumps, measles
(rubeola and rubella or German measles), chicken pox, polio, allergies,
acne, bee stings, hiccups, splinters, epilepsy, broken arms and legs, and so
on. Other diseases will include bacterial diseases (like scarlet fever,
whooping cough, typhoid fever, diphtheria, gangrene, cholera, conjunctivitis, and tuberculosis), viruses (like smallpox, influenza, anthrax,
pneumonia, herpes, hepatitis, trachoma, and yellow fever), fungal diseases
(like thrush and athletes foot), nutritional diseases (like beriberi, rickets,
and scurvy) and parasitic diseases (like malaria and bubonic plague). The
adult diseases will include leukemia, cancer (lung, skin, breast, and bone),
tumors, gallstones, kidney stones, AIDs, heart problems, diabetes, Alzheimers, arthritis, osteoporosis, ALS, muscular dystrophy, and emphysema.
Besides the aforementioned good guy teams, there will be vaccine and
drug-injected super heroes like penicillin, insulin, and other medications.
Some super heroes can fight an enemy one on one, some spin medicated
webs trying to capture and destroy the unsuspecting enemies, and others
shoot medication into the human body, blocking the pathways or locking
the enemy inside a region. The super team uses the human bodys blood
transit system to travel through arteries away from the heart and veins
and back to their headquarters (the heart). The object of each mission is to
survive, and the player(s) will have several medical gauges and monitors
that will give up-to-date tracking of the patients progress.
Medical Kombat has unique cross-genre appeal since it is a martial arts
fighting game, an FPS, and an educational game all in one. Parents will
appreciate its educational benefit, and the males and females 8 to 16 will
be enthusiastic about the realistic and intense fighting and destruction of
their enemies. Each year 15,000 to 19,000 high school students apply to
medical colleges throughout the U.S.
The platform for this game will be the Windows XP as the first release
(Windows 2000, 98, Me, and XP compatible) with Microsofts Xbox,
PlayStation 2, and the Nintendo Game Cube to follow. Similar fighting
games like Crouching Tiger Hidden Dragon sell for $49.95 on the
Nintendo Game Cube, PSX 2, and Xbox and $32.95 for the Gameboy
Advance. Mortal Combat Deadly Alliance sells for $49.95 on the Nintendo
Game Cube, PSX 2, and Xbox and $39.95 for the Gameboy Advance.
Medical Kombat simulates the first war that man ever fought, the first
war you have ever fought, and the last war you will someday lose. The
players will enjoy the thrill of real-life search and destroy as they battle
their way through each mission and learn about life and death in the
process.
101
Chapter 8
Chapter 9
103
104
Chapter 9
105
Equilibrium DeBabelizer
(www.Equilibrium.com)
Equilibriums DeBabelizer Pro 5 by Equilibrium is
an automating media production tool that allows
you to automatically acquire, edit, optimize, and
convert countless images of various formats.
Version 5 has embedded Digimarc digital watermarks or a composite logo
to right-protect your images, scripting to batch multiple commands, compress, and convert QuickTime, AVI, and RealVideo, and enhanced GIF and
JPEG compression.
The DeBabelizer Pro 5.0 includes hot folder processing, which
enables numerous files to be placed in designated folders, watch me
scripting, which mimics your execution and scripts the operation for you,
a global log of all executed and error operations, the ability to sort and
reorder batch lists, conditional scripting, inline scripting to click on a command and instantly edit a script or modify the settings, and the ability to
manipulate an image in high quality scale. It also includes the ability to
flip, rotate, trim, resize canvas, plus change the intensity, contrast, gamma,
hue, saturation, and brightness in full preview. Channels control allows for
quick viewing of the RGB and alpha (invisible color) channels. The Ultimate Palette Optimization feature allows for generating the best palette
for an image, series of images, or frames; it also has the ability to set pixel
depth, reduce colors, and control dithering, merge multiple palettes,
equalize palettes (better distribution of color and saturation), set palette
and remap to any of the 28 built-in palettes, remove unused or duplicate
colors; plus it has the ability to remove the Ultramat (blue screen hue
range), shave or outline an image, field interpolation to clean up video and
rendered animations on a scan line level, and NTSC and PAL Hot Pixel
Fixer (guarantees all colors conform to video display limitation standards).
Chapter 9
Animation can be created and edited using Corel R.A.V.E. (Real Animated Vector Effects), which is one of the three CorelDRAW suite
components (along with CorelDRAW and Corel PHOTO-PAINT). The
CorelDRAW suite is Windows XP compatible. CorelDRAW has an updated
interface with easier to access and use functions, dockers (detachable palettes), more high zoom level dragging of a drawing, and PerfectShapes (a
la WordPerfect Suite), which enables easy creation of various standard
shapes. PHOTO-PAINT allows for controlling text for resizing and skewing, photo correction (like red-eye removal), creating drop shadows, and
previewing various file formatted pictures. Corel R.A.V.E. is Macromedia
Flash-compatible as well as other formats that allow for live-effects creation over time, editing your work through a timeline function, and
creating roll-over graphics.
The CorelDRAW V11.0 Graphics Suite retails for $529 and Corel
DRAW V11.0 Upgrade for $249.
106
Chapter 9
Windows system requirements are a 486 or better (Pentium recommended), Windows 95, 98, Me, NT (Service Pack 6), 2000 (Service Pack
2), 64 MB RAM available, 20 MB free disk space, 256 color monitor, and a
CD-ROM.
Mac system requirements are a Power Macintosh Processor 3 or
higher, System 9.1 or above, 64 MB RAM available, 100 MB available disk
space, 1024x768 monitor, a CD-ROM, QuickTime 5.0, and CarbonLib 1.4.
Equilibrium DeBabelizer Pro 5, which also runs on the Windows 95, 98,
2000, Windows Millennium Edition, and Windows NT operating systems,
has a price of $469.
Alias|Wavefront Maya
(www.AliasWavefront.com)
The Alias|Wavefront logo is a registered trademark and Alias|Wavefront is a trademark of Alias|Wavefront, a division of Silicon Graphics Limited in the United States
and/or other countries. Maya is a registered trademark of Silicon Graphics, Inc.,
exclusively used by Alias|Wavefront, a division of Silicon Graphics Limited. The Maya
logo, Maya Personal Learning Edition, Maya Complete, Maya Unlimited, Maya Paint
Effects, Maya Artisan, Maya Fur, Maya Cloth, Maya Embedded Language and Maya
Shockwave 3D Exporter are trademarks of Alias|Wavefront, a division of Silicon
Graphics Limited. IRIX is a registered trademark and SGI is a trademark of Silicon
Graphics, Inc.
107
Professional, and Windows XP but not on Windows 95, 98, Me, Linux, or
IRIX (buy the Maya Complete version). Maya Personal Learning Edition
requires 695 MB to install and 270 MB to run (the installer is deleted).
The complete set of user documentation is included.
Softimage|XSI (www.Softimage.com)
Softimage|XSI 2.0 is Avid technologys next generation 3D software application based on their Softimage|3D, which was the leading 3D character
animation software. Softimage|3D was utilized by many films, such as
Jurassic Park, The Mask, Godzilla, and The Matrix.
Softimage|XSI has the same toolset and layout as Softimage|3D.
There are now three main modules called Model, Animate, and Render.
Animate lets you store actions (poses and animation segments). There is
an animation editor and an animation mixer, which have many nonlinear
animation tools for blending and sequencing stored actions. The Render
module has basic materials and textures defined and can separate a single
render into separate passes. A Render Tree allows combining materials,
textures, and procedural surface properties as a graphical flowchart, connecting nodes of different surface properties to other nodes as a tree
structure.
Chapter 9
108
Chapter 9
SOFTIMAGE|XSI V.2.0
SOFTIMAGE|3D
109
Chapter 9
Softimage|XSI 3.0
110
Chapter 9
111
Chapter 9
NewTek LightWaves Modeler has long held the title as the worlds best
polygonal modeler. Game developers will find it to be a major weapon in
creating efficient, yet great-looking models for fast, exciting gameplay.
LightWaves advanced UV mapping, weight maps, gradient controls, and
motion and texture baking all contribute to a powerful arsenal for the
game developer.
A few of NewTek LightWaves new feature highlights include subdivision surfaces, inverse kinematics, and nonlinear animation.
n Subdivision surfacesWith the press of the Tab key, your model
changes from a 30-polygon faceted rough to an organically rounded,
smooth, flowing sculpture (a head or a body, human, animal, or alien; a
cool sports car; or a techno-organic spaceship perhaps). Subdivision
surfaces provide modeling as complex as you need with great economy
of effort and time. You model with simple polygons at only a fraction of
the number the final model will need. You have complete control of
112
Chapter 9
your model but with a simplicity and ease you would never have
expected when creating complex natural or engineered objects.
n Inverse kinematics (IK)LightWave lets you use virtual bones to
quickly and easily make a skeleton for your character and use FK (forward kinematics) and IK to move the character. Forward kinematics:
Rotate the upper arm, and the forearm, hand, and fingers must follow.
Inverse kinematics: Put a goal just at the end of the fingers, and then
if you want your character to reach for that M&M on the table, just
move the goal toward the M&M and the characters arm will move in
proper fashion. These can be combined for realistic movement in any
situation. And LightWaves Faster Bones option makes animating a
complex character quick and responsive.
n Nonlinear animationLightWave also includes a nonlinear animation
tool, Motion Mixer. Previously saved motion cycles such as walking,
running, jumping, etc. can be mixed and matched, stretched, and shortened as needed to produce just the movement and timing you need for
your project. Animate once, customize endlessly.
LightWave 7.5 has a suggested retail price of $1,595.
Softimage 3D base retails for $1,495 and includes network licensing
(server-based floating), floating operating system capacity (server-based
cross-operating system floating license for Windows, Linux, and IRIX),
unlimited instances of SOFTIMAGE|3D in interactive and command-line
mode on same workstation with same license, unlimited command-line
rendering on multiple workstations (Softimage renderer only), launch distributed rendering (with additional mental ray 2.1 stand-alone licenses)
from the interactive application or from the command line, and
SOFTIMAGE|SDK ClothExtreme (purchased separately).
Softimage 3D extreme retails for $2,495 and includes ParticleSuite,
MetaClay, SoftBody, mental ray 2.1 renderer (single processormental
ray license enables tools such as Render Map (for lightmaps), Photon Wizard (for radiosity and caustic effects), and more), Softimage renderer,
network licensing (server-based floating), floating operating system capacity (server-based cross-operating system floating license for Windows,
Linux, and IRIX), unlimited instances of SOFTIMAGE|3D in interactive
and command line mode on same workstation with same license, unlimited command-line rendering on multiple workstations (Softimage
renderer only), launch distributed rendering (with additional mental ray
2.1 stand-alone licenses) from the interactive application or from the command line, and SOFTIMAGE|SDK ClothExtreme (purchased separately).
SOFTIMAGE ClothExtreme provides SOFTIMAGE|XSI users with
unmatched cloth realism, including collisions with geometric objects and
self-collision. Fully integrated within the SOFTIMAGE|XSI workflow, it
retails for $595.
113
Discreets 3D Studio Max (or 3DS Max) is the worlds best-selling professional 3D modeling animation and rendering application. 3DS Max delivers
a unified object-oriented platform for the artists designing visual effects,
character animation, and state-of-the-art games.
3DS Max has won over 65 industry
awards since its first publication in 1996 and
has sold over 140,000 copies on the Windows platform. Now Microsofts Xbox and
PlayStation 2 artists can utilize 3DS Max.
System requirements for Windows
include the Windows 2000 or 98 operating
systems with a 300 MHz processor minimum (dual Pentium 3 system recommended), 128 MB RAM and 300 MB swap
space minimum, graphics card supporting
1024x768x16-bit color (OpenGL and
Direct3D hardware acceleration supported, 24-bit color, 3D graphics accelerator is preferred), mouse (optimized for Microsofts Intellimouse),
CD-ROM drive, optional sound card, and speakers. Network rendering
supported for Windows 2000 only.
3DS Max supports numerous image file formats, such as AVI, BMP,
CIN, EPS, FLC, GIF (import only), JPG, PNG, RGB, RLA, RPF, TGA, TIF,
YUV (import only), Photoshop PDS (import only), and QuickTime MOV.
The geometry file support includes IGES (import only), PRJ, SHP, VRML,
Chapter 9
114
Chapter 9
3DS, 3D ASCII SCENE, Adobe Illustrator AI, AutoCAD DWG and DXF,
Adobe Type 1 (import only), and TrueType fonts (import only).
Some interesting new features of 3DS Max version 4.0 are flexible IK
independent shaded bones system for more accurate skeletal setups, previews, and skinning, and IK support of branching hierarchies, pinned
objects, and six degrees of freedom (6DOF) constraints.
Character deformations include new angle deformers and soft body
characteristics. Other features include game development support for
Direct3D, multi textures per face, opacity mapping, true transparency, and
pixel/vertex shaders like reflection maps and bump maps. An animate
button makes everything clicked on virtually animated. Shaders provided
include isotropic, Blinn, Oren-Nayar-Blinn, Phong, metal, multilayer, and
Strauss with independent sampler options.
NURBS can be projected onto mesh surfaces. NURBS surfaces include
point and CV, u-loft, uv-loft, blend, n-sided blend, offset, extrude, fillet,
lathe, ruled, cap, one rail, two rail, trim, and multi-curve trim. NURBS
curves include point and CV, fit, offset, chamfer, fillet, surface-surface
intersection, surface edge, ISO, curve on surface, and projected with trimming control.
The particle system has behavioral control, such as inter-particle collision, meta-particles, snow, spray, bubbles, explosions, spawning, and trails
that support dynamic reactions with forces and object collisions. Interchangeable light types include omni, free and target spot, free and target
directional that support plug-in shadows, shadow color and density, projected images, contrast, edge softness, attenuation, and decay.
Discreets 3DS Max 5.0 includes new bone tools, character node function, set-key animation, skin pose, morphing, spline IK, function curve and
dope sheet editors, integrated dynamics, and weighted controllers. Other
new features include a redesigned UV interface and new polygonal modeling tools.
3DS Max 5 is available for Windows 2000 and XP and retails for $3,195
with an option to upgrade from Max 4 for $795 or from Max 3 for $995.
115
Chapter 9
116
Chapter 9
LIPSinc Mimic
NXN Softwares alienbrain 5.0 is a digital production management software application for enhanced project management of gaming assets,
studio management, and bug tracking. PMX, or Project Management
Extension, allows the manager to plan the project, schedule it, and track it
efficiently by allowing maintenance of multiple project plans per team,
associated media assets on a task basis, and task distribution, with progress and completion monitored in real time.
BMX, or Bug Management Extension, enables development teams to
log, store, assign, track, and resolve bugs, feature requests, and development tasks, as well as produce summary reports. SMX, or Studio
Management Extension, provides current status reports and content
reports for production and asset (artwork, audio files, and so on) management. Reports can be based on an individual user or team based on
content and modifications.
NXN alienbrain Starter Pack is a configuration system for smaller
teams ($9,990 for a team of up to ten users that contains one team productivity server, one PowerClient, five BaseClients, and four CodeClients
with one year maintenance). Just like NXN alienbrains other applications,
the Starter Pack includes version control for media assets and source
code, project management, and workflow functionality. The Starter Pack
integrates with Discreets 3D Studio Max, Alias|Wavefronts Maya, and
Softimage|XSI. The package is designed for ten users and can be
extended to 20 users if needed.
NXN Softwares alienbrain VFX is an asset management solution specifically designed for the production of large-scale visual effects projects.
NXN alienbrain VFX is based on the technology behind NXN alienbrain
and has key features, such as asset management support for scanned and
rendered film frames; handling of large, binary files such as 3D models and
film frames; graphical clients for Linux, Mac OS X, and Windows;
scalability to tens of terabytes of production data and millions of objects;
optimized high performance file transfers in NFS (Network File System)
environments; and integration with common visual effects and animation
tools, such as Maya, 3D Studio Max, and Softimage|XSI.
NXN Softwares alienbrain 6.0 offers over 50 new features and
improvements, most of which focus on the products new software configuration management (SCM) capabilities for programming teams like full
branching, branch merging, sharing, structural history, atomic get, and
pinning featuresand these new features apply to the asset management
aspects of alienbrain as well.
Other features designed for programmers include command-line tools
for automated processes and shell scripting, event scripting to allow teams
to modify the behavior of existing functionality to suit specific development processes (e.g., create a script that aborts an import if a file does not
conform to a certain pixel depth or size), the ability to change reporting
tools, a customizable defect and request tracking module, and integration
with Microsoft Visual Studio and Metrowerks CodeWarrior. A new dedicated alienbrain Developer Client complements the pre-existing
117
Chapter 9
118
Chapter 9
Merant creates software for managing digital assets, enhancing team collaboration, and business decision support. They focus on protecting and
tracking multiple uses of software, content, and intellectual property.
PVCS lets you manage software changes across all platforms from one
repository with one tool and offers end-to-end change management across
the broadest range of digital assetsapplications, code, and content.
PVCS Professional combines PVCS Version Manager, PVCS Tracker,
and PVCS Configuration Builder into a single suite for software configuration management (SCM). PVCS Professional enables teams of any size to
protect software assets, automate development tasks, and manage the
many changes and issues involved in team development.
PVCS Version Manager is the industry standard for version control in
team development environments. It organizes, manages, and protects
software assets during revision and promotes team collaboration. PVCS
Version Manager is integrated with numerous development environments
and tools.
PVCS Tracker captures, manages, and communicates changes, issues,
and tasks, providing basic process control to ensure coordination and communication within and across development and content teams at every
step.
PVCS Configuration Builder ensures that applications can be reliably
built in a reproducible manner, ensuring components from the same version are used.
PVCS Dimensions tightly integrates SCM (software configuration management) functions under process definition and enforcement to
automatically manage workflow and change implementation.
119
Chapter 9
Chapter 10
121
122
Chapter 10
123
As you can see, our layout has a unique and smooth flow to it. The idea
behind creating a flawless interface begins with understanding how the
game will play out and how the user will read the screen. For War
Between the States, the game plays out with the users vantage point
(being one from above at a slight angle). The view can be rotated along a
Z-axis, moved directionally along the X- and Y-axis, and zoomed in and out.
With these settings, our major Play/Motion of the viewing screen will be
one that consists mostly of scrolling throughout the world. In order for us
to take advantage of this motion and use its flow consistently with that of
our user interface, we decided to divide it with a top bar and a lower bar. A
distinct difference in size is noticeable, and for our purpose the larger of
the two was placed at the bottom of the screen to give the impression of a
strong and solid foundation from which to display the Game Screen.
These two bars section off the screen in an even and calm fashion providing an almost framed impression. With the smaller top bar that supports
the more important and most-used information and the lower bar containing the broader sets of information, the UI bars divide themselves
appropriately pertaining to how we read the screen.
To continue with this thought, the layout also added a strong visual
effect for the read of the screen. The most common way of viewing a
screen is as we read from left to right and top to bottom. Therefore the UI
bars horizontal construction subtly moves the user across and throughout
the screen. Remember as a designer and artist, we must realize that it is
our job to subconsciously direct and lead the users where we want them
to go for the sole purpose of providing them the greatest experience
possible.
There are multiple UI bars to choose from in War Between the States
and each with its own distinct look and feel. When approaching the base
set of colors and tones used for the UI bars, it is best to create an image
that will stand out when it is looked at and gently fade into the background
when it is not being looked at. There are several things that can affect how
a UI bar is viewed, one being if the UI bar is too detailed and busy it
Chapter 10
124
Chapter 10
tends to distract the user from the game as well as make it difficult to
quickly access the information needed throughout the game. Dead space,
unused space, and bad negative space on a UI bar also creates eyesores
that distract the user, and it would be best to avoid such cases.
Aside from the color and other artistic renderings applied to a UI bar,
the entire shape of the UI bar also dictates how well the user will react.
For our game, we have chosen a clean-cut look with solid color schemes
and layouts. The UI bars that border our gaming screens have been created with a straight bar across. This was chosen so that we could keep the
UI bars from becoming too complex looking as well as to aide us in not
creating a feeling of parts of the scene appearing hidden behind a cut up
user interface. Now these things are very subtle, but they are what make
the difference between a UI that works well and one that does not for this
game. This does not mean that other UI screens cannot work, but for
ours, this type of layout is by far the most comprehensive and complimentary to our game type and idea.
For a visual demonstration of what I have been talking about I have prepared a few examples that compare other user interfaces.
As you can see, each is quite different and unique. Starting with Figure 3,
the major difference is the addition of a right side bar. This is an excellent
example of how the flow of the eye can be immediately stopped and the
fluid motion from point to point on the screen is disrupted. It does allow
for more options on the screen, which means more buttons but also more
distractions. If a right side bar is to be added, the best advice artistically
speaking is to frame in the entire screen. What that will produce is a much
more evenly balanced and visually pleasing layout. Examining Figure 4, it
125
Chapter 10
allows the eye to find and better focus in on what the designer wants them
to focus on. What happens without the left UI bar, simply put, is a process
where the eye will overfocus on either the game screen or the UI and not
create the smooth flow between the two, or it will cause the eye to slip to
the left of the viewing screen subconsciously because of the open area at
the edge of the screen. One other thing we avoided was breaking the UI
screen in to several pieces along its horizontal line. As you can see from
Figure 5, when a UI is broken up such as this, it again does not allow for
even flow across. It creates a definite stop and restart. This slows the process and adds more time getting the information needed.
With Figure 5, we see a segmented UI that needs some help. Cutting
up a UI can work, but not like this. If a UI is going to be cut up, it needs to
have a good reason for being cut into separate pieces. One reason that
comes to mind is that the information in each box is very different and
need not be placed next to any other UI information. Another is that there
may be so little information needed that to artistically create a
well-balanced layout, the UI bars and buttons are separated across the
gaming screen. See Figure 6.
As designers and artists, we are trying to create works of art with every
frame of motion in a game. As any artist will tell you, no matter how beautiful the painting, if its frame is bad it will only lessen the impact of the
image.
Last UI Thoughts
So as a game designer, think about your initial impression to your audience. How do you want them to view your design? What comments should
your design inspire in your audience?
126
Chapter 10
Chapter 11
The Basics of
Programming
Programming is like being a general in the military and giving absolute
commands to your troops. You say march and 100 soldiers begin to
move forward. You say halt! and they all stop immediately. This is programming. You tell a dumb machine it can only do a few things, such as
add one plus one and answer the question does one equal one? Simplistic? Yes. Realistic? Yes.
Commands (or lets call them instructions) are processed in order.
Life is processed in order.
At 7:00 A.M.: You get up out of bed.
At 7:15 A.M.: You walk into the bathroom.
At 7:16 A.M.: You turn on the water in the shower.
At 7:17 A.M.: You get into the shower.
At 7:18 A.M.: You soap yourself.
At 7:19 A.M.: You rinse off.
Repeat three more times.
At 7:20 A.M.: You soap yourself.
At 7:21 A.M.: You rinse off.
At 7:22 A.M.: You soap yourself.
At 7:23 A.M.: You rinse off.
At 7:24 A.M.: You soap yourself.
At 7:25 A.M.: You rinse off.
(end of the loop or repeated commands)
At 7:26 A.M.: You exit the shower and dry off.
This is life, but it can also be looked at as a set of instructions (or
programming).
127
128
Chapter 11
A Look at Programming
Architects design plans, builders create blueprints, and engineers draw
schematics. Computer engineers (including programmers) draw
flowcharts to visually explain the systems or modules flow that they wish
to design.
Lets start with a few common computer programming terms.
Character or Char is an 8-bit (numbers from 0 to 127) storage location that
is used for alphanumerics (numbers, letters A-Z, and symbols).
Boolean or Bool is an 8-bit storage location that is TRUE (non-zero) or
FALSE (a zero value).
Integer or Int is a 16-bit storage location that is used for numbers 32767
to 32767.
Unsigned integer is a 16-bit storage location that is for positive-only integers or numbers 0 to 65,535.
Long is a 32-bit storage location that is used for numbers 2.1 billion to 2.1
billion.
Unsigned long is a 32-bit storage location that is for positive-only longs or
numbers 0 to 4.2 billion.
Float is a 16-bit real number (decimal or fractions).
String is a group of characters (Char format) that are referenced by a common name and have a NULL (or zero)-ending delimiter.
Array is a group of common elements as an array of integers, an array of
longs, or an array of strings.
Structure is a group of elements of various types. A structure wraps these
elements together under one heading. A sample of a structure called
Employee may contain the employees name (a string), the
employees address (a string), the employees salary (a float), or the
employees age (an integer).
Class is similar to a structure where various types of elements and functions related to these elements are combined. Similar to the
Employee structure, we could have a class Employee that
includes the employees name (a string), the employees address (a
string), the employees salary (a float), the employees start date (a
date structure, three integers defining the month, day, and year), and
employees birth date (a date structure). The class Employee can
also contain the function for the employees age (no longer an integer but a function based on todays date and the employees birth
date), a yearly salary review based on the employees start date, and
a birthday e-mail function to send the employee an E-card on his
birthday (based on the birthday variables).
ASCII stands for American Standard Code for Information Interchange.
129
There are several operating systems and system graphic libraries, such as
Windows, Windows DirectX, OpenGL, and Linux.
Windows NT is a Microsoft Windows personal computer operating system designed for users and businesses needing advanced capability. NTs
technology is the base for the Microsoft successor operating system, Windows 2000. Windows NT (which unofficially may have originally stood for
New Technology) is actually Microsoft NT Workstation and Microsoft
NT Server combined. The Workstation is designed for business users who
need a more reliable and faster performance system than Windows 95 and
Windows 98.
Windows CE (which unofficially may have originally stood for Consumer Electronics) is based on the Microsoft Windows operating system
but is designed for including or embedding in hand-held computers and as
part of cable TV set-top boxes.
Windows 2000 (W2K) is a version of Microsofts evolving Windows
operating system that was called Windows NT 5.0. Microsoft emphasizes
that Windows 2000 is evolutionary and built on NT technology.
Windows XP is the latest version of the Windows desktop operating
system for the PC. Windows XP is touted as the most important version
of Windows since Windows 95. Windows XP is built on the Windows 2000
kernel and comes in a Professional version and a Home Edition version.
DirectX is an application program interface (API) for creating and managing graphic images and multimedia effects under Microsofts Windows.
DirectX includes DirectDraw (an interface for two-dimensional images),
Direct3D (an interface for creating three-dimensional images),
DirectSound (an interface for sound), DirectPlay (a plug-in for Internet
and multiplayer applications), and DirectInput (an interface for input from
I/O devices).
OpenGL (Open Graphics Library) is the computer industrys standard
application program interface (API) for defining 2D and 3D graphic images
across numerous platforms and operating systems. OpenGL is similar to
DirectXs DirectDraw and Direct3D.
Linux is a Unix-like operating system including a graphical user interface, an X Window system, TCP/IP (file transfer, electronic mail, remote
logon), and the Emacs (customizable open source text editor and application development system) with a reputation as a very efficient and
fast-performing system. Unlike Windows, Linux is publicly open, and
because it conforms to the Portable Operating System Interface standard
user and programming interfaces, developers can write programs that can
be ported to other operating systems. There are approximately 18 million
Linux users worldwide.
Chapter 11
Operating Systems
130
Chapter 11
Programming Commands
Lets look at the basics of programming commands or statements through
three styles: flowcharting, BASIC (Beginners All-purpose Symbolic
Instruction Code) language, and C (or C++) language.
BASIC
C or C++
If A=B then
if(A==B){
If A < B then
If A <= B then
If A > B then
If A >= B then
If A B then
If not A then
if(A != B){
if( !A ){
BASIC
C or C++
If A = B or C = D
then
if((A == B) ||
(C == D)){
If A = B and
C = D then
131
if((A == B) &&
(C == D)){
Flow Chart
BASIC
C or C++
A=A+B
A += B;
A=AB
A = B;
A = A
A = A;
A=A*B
A = A * B;
A=A/B
A = A / B;
A=A*2
A = A >> 1;
A = A * 2;
A=A/2
A = A << 1;
A = A / 2;
A=A+1
A++;
++A;
A = A + 10
A += 10;
A=A1
A;
A;
Chapter 11
Mathematical Statements
132
Chapter 11
A = A 10
A = 10;
Computer Concepts
The first concept we will examine is called a stack or a queue. A
checkout line in a grocery store opens up, and there is no one in the line.
A customer enters the line, and the cashier begins to ring him up. Another
customer enters the line behind the first customer, and then another customer enters the end of the line behind the second customer. The first
133
customer pays for his groceries and leaves. The second customer is rung
up as another customer enters the end of the line.
This everyday occurrence is known as a queue or a stack, where the
first person in line is the first person processed. We call this FIFO or First
In, First Out.
FIFOs cousin is FILO, or First In, Last Out, which occurs in situations
like cooking pancakes. The first pancake is nice and brown and is tossed
onto a plate. The next pancake is finished and tossed on top of the first
pancake. Another pancake is cooked and tossed on top of the second pancake. Then you sit down at the kitchen table ready to eat the fruits (or
pancakes) of your labor. The first pancake you begin to eat is the last pancake you cooked (the pancake on top). The next pancake you eat is the
second one cooked, and the last pancake eaten is the first one cooked.
This method is an example of FILO; the first pancake cooked is the last
one eaten.
Lets pretend that we are playing a game, and it is our turn. On our turn
we have two choices, A and B. By selecting choice A we will lose the
game, and by selecting choice B we will win the game. The obvious
choice would be B for the win. If we have ten choices that we can
choose from and the first choice gives us a win, the remaining nine
choices can be ignored since any other choice will not produce a result
better than the first choice, which results in a win. This is the theory
called Min-Max with Alpha-Beta pruning. You seek to find the best
result, and your opponent seeks to find your worst result (or his best
result). If choice A for your opponent leads to you winning and choice
B for your opponent leads to you losing, your opponent will choose B,
leading to your loss (or their win). As you evaluate each level or turn to be
made, you seek a positive, winning result while your opponent seeks a
negative (losing for you) result.
Once the maximum or a preset cutoff (threshold) result has been found,
all remaining decisions (or paths) are unnecessary to examine. Many
n-player games like chess, Othello, and checkers utilize these gaming
theories to quickly evaluate and determine the non-human players strategy (also called AI, or artificial intelligence, since we are simulating
intelligent thinking).
In Chapter 13, we discuss artificial intelligence in more depth.
Before we look at instructing a machine to process our commands (or
programming), lets look at a simple gaming process on paper and replicate it through a flowchart (a diagram explaining our process) and then
various methods of writing our instructions (also known as coding or
programming).
Chapter 11
134
Chapter 11
Tic-Tac-Toe
Lets look at a simple game that we all know and have played called
Tic-Tac-Toe. The three-by-three board is filled by two players (X and
O), and the winner is the player who successfully connects three of his
Xs or Os in a row (horizontal, vertical, or diagonal).
1
In Tic-Tac-Toe, the player who goes first (say, X) can choose one of nine
spaces to mark with an X (as in the above diagram spaces one to nine).
Then O has a turn and can mark any of the remaining eight empty
spaces. This gameplay continues until either player has won (three connecting marks) or all of the spaces are filled (no player wins). In mathematics, we call this process factorial, and in Tic-Tac-Toe it is 9! or nine
factorial (9 * 8 * 7 * 6 * 5 * 4 *3* 2 * 1).
This means that the full tree structure or game path would have 9! ending states (or nodes), which is 362,880 win, lose, or draw (tie) states.
When playing Tic-Tac-Toe, there are two methods of selecting a space
to mark with your X or O: randomly marking an empty space or logically
examining each empty space through an iterative process and selecting
the space that leads to a non-losing result (a winning or tying result). All
games use one of these methods, but obviously the second, non-random
method gives us a better game and stronger competition.
The following sample game will indicate the side to play (X or O) and
the next available space to mark.
(A) "X"
mark 1
(B) "O"
mark 2
(C) "X"
mark 3
(D) "O"
mark 4
(E) "X"
mark 5
(F) "O"
mark 6
2
5
8
X O 3
4 5 6
7 8 9
X O X
4 5 6
7 8 9
X O X
O 5 6
7 8 9
X O X
O X 6
7 8 9
X O X
O X O
7 8 9
X
4
7
3
6
9
(G) "X"
mark 7
X O X
O X O
X 8 9
(F) O
mark 7
X O X
O X 6
O 8 9
135
(G) X
mark 9 (win)
X O X
O X 6
O 8 X
(G) X
mark 9
X O X
O X 6
7 O X
Finally O evaluates the next empty space, which is space 9 in step (F), in
lieu of the losing choice step (F) marking space 8.
X O X
O X 6
7 8 O
(G) X
mark 7 (win)
X O X
O X 6
X 8 O
After looking at the various paths, O will evaluate step (D), O mark 4, as
the critical mistake and evaluate (D), O mark 5.
(D) O
mark 5
X O X
4 O 6
7 8 9
(E) X
mark 8 (forced)
X
4
7
O X
O 6
X 9
Chapter 11
(F) O
mark 9
136
Chapter 11
(F) O
mark 4
X O X
O O 6
7 X 9
(G) X
mark 6
(forced)
(H) O
mark 9 (forced)
X O X
O O X
7 X 9
X O X
O O X
7 X O
In step (G), X must once again stop O from winning by marking space 6
(forced move).
In step (H), O must stop X from winning by marking space 9 (forced
move).
Finally, X marks space 7, the only remaining space, and a tie or draw
occurs.
Lets examine the following Tic-Tac-Toe scenario:
X
This scenario has player O select and mark an empty space. The iterating
method would require that each empty space (spaces 3, 4, 6, 7, 8, and 9)
be examined and evaluated. After spending time and effort evaluating the
empty spaces, the process would recognize that player O is forced to mark
space 9 to stop player X from winning. The best method of handling the
selection and marking our next space would be to first check to see if any
empty space would give us the immediate win and then if we cant win,
check if any empty space would give our opponent the immediate win
before examining each empty space in order.
Forced Move
Our thinking would lead us to the following thought process:
TOP:
Set current Tic-Tac-Toe board to current scenario.
Is there an empty space to mark so that I win?
If YES, select and mark this space and
set result to WIN.
If NO, continue.
Is there an empty space to mark so that I wont lose?
If YES, select and mark this space and
set result to Forced Mark.
If NO, continue.
137
YES
1st Row
NO
YES
NO
Chapter 11
138
Chapter 11
YES
2nd Row
NO
YES
2nd Row
NO
YES
3rd Row
NO
YES
NO
YES
1st Column
NO
YES
NO
139
YES
2nd Column
NO
YES
NO
YES
3rd Column
NO
YES
YES
Diagonal left top
to right bottom
NO
YES
NO
Chapter 11
NO
140
Chapter 11
YES
Diagonal right top
to left bottom
NO
YES
NO
141
YES
NO
YES
NO
NO
Loop (go back) to label A
Lets look at how we can use the knowledge we just learned to program
Tic-Tac-Toe in Visual Basic and Visual C++.
Chapter 11
YES
142
Chapter 11
Our user interface (above) lets the player start a new game, choosing
whether he would like to go first or second as either X or O, and lists the
moves (spaces marked). The larger big board is where the current game
is played and the player marks his desired space. The smaller board displays the computer thinking as calculated by the Min-Max with AlphaBeta pruning search algorithm.
FORM1
Private Sub Form_Load()
Dim i As Integer
Form1.BorderStyle = 0
Text1.Text = " " + "Moves" + " "
Frame1.Visible = False
InitVariables
playerMark = -1
End Sub
Private Sub Option1_Click(index As Integer)
Picture1.Enabled = True
Picture1.PaintPicture BigBoard, 0, 0
Picture2.PaintPicture SmBoard, 0, 0
InitVariables
showBigBoard
showSmallBoard
playerMark = (2 * (index Mod 2)) - 1 '-1 is "O", 1 is "X"
playerDONE = 1
Option1(index).value = False
Frame1.Visible = False
Option2.Enabled = True
Option2.value = False
143
Option2.Visible = False
If index < 2 Then
' Players turn
Text5.Text = "Your turn, please mark a space"
Picture1.Enabled = True
' Player goes first
playerDONE = 0
Else
' Computers turn
opening
End If
End Sub
Private Sub Option2_Click()
Frame1.Visible = True
Text1.Text = " " + "Moves" + " "
Option2.Enabled = False
End Sub
Private Sub Picture1_Click()
Dim i As Integer
Dim flag As Integer
Chapter 11
144
Chapter 11
MODULE1
'since C++ start arrays at index Zero we will too
'Set the Global variables
Public ttt(0 To 9, 0 To 8) As Integer
Public
Public
Public
Public
Public
Public
Public
Public
Public
Public
Public
Public
Public
Public
Public
Public
Public
Public
145
wp(0 To 7, 0 To 2) As Integer
BigBoxXY(0 To 8, 0 To 2) As Integer
SmBoxXY(0 To 8, 0 To 2) As Integer
playerMark As Integer
Path As String
playerDONE As Integer
PmouseX As Integer
PmouseY As Integer
markX As Picture
markO As Picture
smarkX As Picture
smarkO As Picture
BigBoard As Picture
SmBoard As Picture
caption1 As String
Clevel As Integer
L1nextspace As Integer
Level1Data(0 To 9) As Integer
Sub InitVariables()
Dim i As Integer
Dim j As Integer
' Change the path according to your Directory
Path = "C://Wordware//VBTicTacToe//"
Set BigBoard = LoadPicture(Path + "TicTacToeBigBoard.bmp")
Set SmBoard = LoadPicture(Path + "TicTacToeSmBoard.bmp")
Set markX = LoadPicture(Path + "BigX.bmp")
Set markO = LoadPicture(Path + "BigO.bmp")
Set smarkX = LoadPicture(Path + "SmallX.bmp")
Set smarkO = LoadPicture(Path + "SmallO.bmp")
Clevel = 0
0: wp(0, 1) = 1: wp(0, 2) = 2
3: wp(1, 1) = 4: wp(1, 2) = 5
6: wp(2, 1) = 7: wp(2, 2) = 8
0: wp(3, 1) = 3: wp(3, 2) = 6
1: wp(4, 1) = 4: wp(4, 2) = 7
2: wp(5, 1) = 5: wp(5, 2) = 8
0: wp(6, 1) = 4: wp(6, 2) = 8
2: wp(7, 1) = 4: wp(7, 2) = 6
Chapter 11
Form1.Picture1.Enabled = False
146
Chapter 11
0)
0)
0)
0)
0)
0)
0)
0)
0)
0)
0)
0)
0)
0)
0)
0)
0)
0)
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
0: BigBoxXY(0, 1) =
125: BigBoxXY(1, 1)
243: BigBoxXY(2, 1)
0: BigBoxXY(3, 1) =
125: BigBoxXY(4, 1)
243: BigBoxXY(5, 1)
0: BigBoxXY(6, 1) =
125: BigBoxXY(7, 1)
243: BigBoxXY(8, 1)
0
= 0
= 0
101
= 101
= 101
196
= 196
= 196
0: SmBoxXY(0, 1) = 0
22: SmBoxXY(1, 1) = 0
44: SmBoxXY(2, 1) = 0
0: SmBoxXY(3, 1) = 22
22: SmBoxXY(4, 1) = 22
44: SmBoxXY(5, 1) = 22
0: SmBoxXY(6, 1) = 44
22: SmBoxXY(7, 1) = 44
44: SmBoxXY(8, 1) = 44
For index = 0 To 8
If ttt(level, index) = 0 Then
SpaceEmpty = index + 1
Exit Function
End If
Next index
SpaceEmpty = 0 'no empty space was found
End Function
147
ttWin As Integer
OppWin As Integer
MyWin As Integer
wpindex As Integer
i As Integer
OppWin = -3 * MySide
MyWin = 3 * MySide
For wpindex = 0 To 7 ' for each win (3 rows, 3 columns and
2 diagonals)
ttWin = 0
For i = 0 To 2 ' add the 3 spaces as per direction to check
ttWin = ttWin + ttt(level, wp(wpindex, i))
Next i
If ttWin = MyWin Then ' I have 3 connecting marks
IsThereaWin = 100 'I win plus space to move to
Exit Function
End If
If ttWin = OppWin Then ' Opponent can get 3 connecting marks
IsThereaWin = -100 'Forced plus space to block
Exit Function
End If
Next wpindex
IsThereaWin = 0
End Function
' Let's check to see if there's a forced move to make
' A forced move is a winning space or a blocking space to stop a loss
Dim
Dim
Dim
Dim
Dim
Dim
Dim
Dim
Dim
index As Integer
trys As Integer
ttWin As Integer
OppWin As Integer
MyWin As Integer
wpindex As Integer
i As Integer
FMove As Integer
sgn1 As Integer
OppWin = -3 * MySide
MyWin = 3 * MySide
For trys = 0 To 1
For index = 0 To 8
If level > 0 Then Copy_ttt (level)
If ttt(level, index) = 0 Then ' empty space
Chapter 11
148
Chapter 11
0 Then
sgn1 = 1
If FMove < 0 Then sgn1 = -1
Forced_Move = sgn1 * (Abs(FMove) + index + 1)
If level > 0 Then Copy_ttt (level)
Exit Function
End If
End If
Next index
Next trys
If level > 0 Then Copy_ttt (level)
Forced_Move = 0 'No forced move
End Function
Sub Tic_Tac_Toe()
Dim
Dim
Dim
Dim
Dim
Dim
X As Integer
MySide As Integer
spaceon As Integer
FMove As Integer
i As Integer
value As Integer
X = 0: MySide = -playerMark
If SpaceEmpty(0) Then 'Game still on
' A forced move to win or to block a win is the best mark move
X = Forced_Move(1, MySide)
149
Chapter 11
150
Chapter 11
If FMove >= 100 Then ' You may never see this message
Form1.Text1.Text = Form1.Text1.Text + " " + "WOW! YOU'VE WON!"
+ " "
Form1.Text1.Text = Form1.Text1.Text + " Play me again?"
Form1.Text5.Text = "Would you like to play me again?"
playerDONE = 100
Form1.Option2.Visible = True
Exit Sub
End If
If FMove = 0 Then ' No win found and all spaces marked
playerDONE = 0
Form1.Text5.Text = "Your turn, please mark a space"
If SpaceEmpty(0) = 0 Then ' no more empty spaces to mark
Form1.Text1.Text = Form1.Text1.Text + " " + "DRAW!" + " "
Form1.Text1.Text = Form1.Text1.Text + " Play me again?"
Form1.Text5.Text = "Would you like to play me again?"
Form1.Option2.Visible = True
Exit Sub
End If
End If
End Sub
' Just like a chess opening database, here are standard
' Tic-Tac-Toe opening marks
Sub opening()
Dim i As Integer
Dim j As Integer
Dim k As Integer
Form1.Text5.Text = "" ' clear message
' Check to see if we go first and second
j = 0
For i = 0 To 8
If ttt(0, i)
j = j + 1
k = i
End If
Next i
0 Then
If j > 1 Then
Form1.Text5.Text = ""
Tic_Tac_Toe ' find a space to mark
Exit Sub
End If
If j = 0 Then
' we go first
i = Int(Rnd * 5) ' valid first marks are spaces 1,3,5,7 and 9
i = i * 2 ' we have a random number 0 through 4 so we double it
ttt(0, i) = -playerMark
Form1.Text4.Text = "Marked " + Str(i + 1)
Form1.Text1.Text = Form1.Text1.Text + " I marked space " +
151
Chapter 11
ttt(0, i) = -playerMark
Form1.Text4.Text = "Marked " + Str(i + 1)
Form1.Text1.Text = Form1.Text1.Text + " I marked space " + '
Str(i + 1) + " "
playerDONE = 0
Form1.showBigBoard
Form1.Text5.Text = "Your turn, please mark a space"
Form1.Picture1.Enabled = True ' Player goes
Exit Sub
End If
End Sub
152
Chapter 11
Dim succval
As Integer
If X 0 Then
' a forced move has been flagged
MTlist = Abs(X Mod 100)
' space is 1 to 9
Else
For index = 0 To 8
If ttt(level, 8 - index) = 0 Then ' subtract from 8 for
ascending order
MTlist = MTlist * 10 + (9 - index)
End If
Next index
End If
While MTlist > 0
nextspace = MTlist Mod 10
' next space to mark
MTlist = (MTlist - nextspace) / 10 ' remainder of possible spaces
' to mark
Copy_ttt (level)
ttt(level, nextspace - 1) = MySide
Form1.Text4.Text = "Marked " + Str(nextspace)
Form1.showSmallBoard ' display current path scenario of board
WIN = IsThereaWin(level, MySide)
If WIN >= 100 Then
succval = WIN
Else
succval = -MinMaxValue(level + 1, -MySide, -beta, -alpha)
Endif
If level = 1 Then
' Save this space's value
Level1Data(nextspace) = succval
If succval = 100 Then ' Winning line found
MinMaxValue = succval
Exit Function
End If
End If
'The Alpha-Beta pruning code
153
Chapter 11
154
Chapter 11
#define IDB_SMALLX
#define IDB_BOARD
// extern(al) variables
extern CString
extern HINSTANCE
extern int
extern HDC
155
144
145
or variables that are defined in another file
m_msg1,m_msg2,m_moves;
m_hInstance;
Setbuttons;
my_hDC;
/////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
void LoadBMPs()
{
markX = ::LoadBitmap(m_hInstance,MAKEINTRESOURCE(IDB_BIGX));
markO = ::LoadBitmap(m_hInstance,MAKEINTRESOURCE(IDB_BIGO));
smarkx = ::LoadBitmap(m_hInstance,MAKEINTRESOURCE(IDB_SMALLX));
smarko = ::LoadBitmap(m_hInstance,MAKEINTRESOURCE(IDB_SMALLO));
BigBoard = ::LoadBitmap(m_hInstance,MAKEINTRESOURCE(IDB_BOARD));
SmBoard = ::LoadBitmap(m_hInstance,MAKEINTRESOURCE(IDB_SMBOARD));
}
/////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
void InitVariables()
{
int
i, j;
Clevel = 0;
// Columns
wp[ 3 ][ 0 ] = 0; wp[ 3 ][ 1 ] = 3; wp[ 3 ][ 2 ] = 6;
wp[ 4 ][ 0 ] = 1; wp[ 4 ][ 1 ] = 4; wp[ 4 ][ 2 ] = 7;
wp[ 5 ][ 0 ] = 2; wp[ 5 ][ 1 ] = 5; wp[ 5 ][ 2 ] = 8;
// Diagonals
wp[ 6 ][ 0 ] = 0; wp[ 6 ][ 1 ] = 4; wp[ 6 ][ 2 ] = 8;
wp[ 7 ][ 0 ] = 2; wp[ 7 ][ 1 ] = 4; wp[ 7 ][ 2 ] = 6;
// Define our two Tic-Tac-Toe boards
Chapter 11
156
Chapter 11
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
][
][
][
][
][
][
][
][
][
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
]
]
]
]
]
]
]
]
]
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
xoff2
xoff2
xoff2
xoff2
xoff2
xoff2
xoff2
xoff2
xoff2
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
][ 1
1 ][
2 ][
][ 1
4 ][
5 ][
][ 1
7 ][
8 ][
]
1
1
]
1
1
]
1
1
=
]
]
=
]
]
=
]
]
yoff1 +
= yoff1
= yoff1
yoff1 +
= yoff1
= yoff1
yoff1 +
= yoff1
= yoff1
0;
+ 0;
+ 0;
101;
+ 101;
+ 101;
196;
+ 196;
+ 196;
0; SmBoxXY[ 0 ][ 1 ] = yoff2 + 0;
22; SmBoxXY[ 1 ][ 1 ] = yoff2 + 0;
44; SmBoxXY[ 2 ][ 1 ] = yoff2 + 0;
0; SmBoxXY[ 3 ][ 1 ] = yoff2 + 22;
22; SmBoxXY[ 4 ][ 1 ] = yoff2 + 22;
44; SmBoxXY[ 5 ][ 1 ] = yoff2 + 22;
0; SmBoxXY[ 6 ][ 1 ] = yoff2 + 44;
22; SmBoxXY[ 7 ][ 1 ] = yoff2 + 44;
44; SmBoxXY[ 8 ][ 1 ] = yoff2 + 44;
157
OppWin = -3 * MySide;
MyWin = 3 * MySide;
for(wpindex = 0; wpindex <= 7; wpindex++){ // for each win
(3 rows, 3 columns and 2 diagonals)
ttWin = 0;
for(i = 0; i<= 2; i++) // add the 3 spaces as per direction
to check
ttWin = ttWin + ttt[level][wp[wpindex][i]];
if( ttWin == MyWin)
return(100);
Chapter 11
if( trys == 0 )
// Can we win on this turn
ttt[level][index] = MySide;
else
// Can our opponent win if we dont block
ttt[level][index] = -MySide; // opponent
158
Chapter 11
void Tic_Tac_Toe()
{
int X, MySide, spaceon, FMove, i;
X = 0;
MySide = -playerMark;
if( SpaceEmpty(0) > 0 ){
// Game still on
if( X != 0 ){
// A forced move has been calculated
ttt[0][spaceon - 1] = MySide;
// either a '1' or a '-1'
m_moves=_T(" I marked space ");
m_moves+=REPitoa(spaceon,2);
} // X != 0
//find a space thats not forced
if( X == 0 ){
// Initialize the level 1 available mark spaces to an extremely
// low value
for( i = 0; i <= 9; i++)
Level1Data[i] = -999;
// Call the Min-Max Function where Alpha is very low and Beta is
// very high
X = MinMaxValue(1, MySide, -999, 999); // find the best move
// find the best space to mark from the level 1 list of valid spaces
// to mark
spaceon = SpaceEmpty(0) - 1;
X = -999;
for( i = 1; i <= 9; i++)
if( Level1Data[i] > X ){
spaceon = i;
X = Level1Data[i];
}
ttt[ 0 ][ spaceon 1 ] = MySide;
159
playerDONE = 0;
m_msg1=_T("Your turn, please mark a space");
if( SpaceEmpty(0) == 0 ){ // no more empty spaces to mark
m_moves=_T(" DRAW!");
m_moves=_T(" Play me again?");
m_moves=_T("Would you like to play me again?");
Setbuttons= -2; // Reset_Buttons
return;
} // SpaceEmpty
} // FMove == 0
void opening()
{
int
i, j, k;
m_moves=_T("");
// Check to see if we go first and second
j = 0;
for (i = 0; i <= 8; i++ )
if( ttt[0, i] != 0 ){
j++;
k = i;
} // ttt[0, i] != 0
if( j > 1 ){
m_msg1=_T("");
Tic_Tac_Toe();
return;
Chapter 11
}
/////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
// Just like a chess opening database, here are standard
// Tic-Tac-Toe opening marks
160
Chapter 11
}
if( j == 0 ){
// we go first
i = (int)(Random(5)); // valid first marks are spaces 1,3,5,7
// and 9
i = i * 2;
// we have a random number 0 through 4
// so we double it
ttt[0][i] = -playerMark;
m_msg2=_T("Marked ");
m_moves+=REPitoa(i + 1,2);
m_msg1=_T("I marked space ");
m_moves+=REPitoa(i + 1,2);
playerDONE = 0;
show_boards();
m_msg1=_T("Your turn, please mark a space");
// Player goes
return;
} // j == 0
if( j == 1 ){
// we go second
// valid moves are center and the opposite corner if the opponent
// marked a corner space
i = -1;
// a flag
if( k == 4 && i == -1 ){
i=4 ;
// can't mark the center space
while (i ==4)
i = (int)(Random(4)); // valid first marks are spaces 1,3,7
// and 9
i = i * 2;
}
if( i == -1 )
i = 4;
ttt[0][i] = -playerMark;
m_msg2=_T("Marked ");
m_msg2=REPitoa(i + 1,2);
m_moves=_T(" I marked space ");
m_moves+=REPitoa(i + 1,2);
playerDONE = 0;
show_boards();
m_msg1=_T("Your turn, please mark a space"); // Player goes
return;
}
}
/////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
int MinMaxValue(int level, int MySide, int alpha, int beta)
{
int WIN, index, nextspace, X, succval;
long MTlist;
// reset current level board
Copy_ttt (level);
if( SpaceEmpty(level) == 0 ) return( 0 );
161
if( X != 0 )
// a forced move has been flagged
MTlist = abs(X % 100);
// space is 1 to 9
else{
for( index = 0; index <= 8; index++)
if( ttt[level][8 - index] == 0 ) // subtract from 8 for
// ascending order
MTlist = MTlist * 10 + (9 - index);
}
// else
while (MTlist > 0){
nextspace = MTlist % 10;
// next space to mark
MTlist = (MTlist - nextspace) / 10; // remainder of possible
// spaces to mark
Copy_ttt (level);
ttt[level][nextspace - 1] = MySide;
m_msg2=_T("Marked ");
m_moves+=REPitoa(nextspace,2);
show_boards();
WIN = IsThereaWin(level, MySide);
if( WIN >= 100 )
succval = WIN;
else
succval = -MinMaxValue(level + 1, -MySide, -beta, -alpha);
// While
return( alpha );
// return a draw
}
/////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
// Convert as number to a character array with a length of lval1
// (may have preceding zeroes)
char *REPitoa(long val1, int lval1)
{
long x;
int sgn=1, i, j, k, zeroflag=0;
Chapter 11
if( level == 1 ){
// Save this spaces value
Level1Data[ nextspace ] = succval;
if( succval == 100) return succval; // Winning line found
}
// level == 1
162
Chapter 11
163
if (playerDONE == 1)return;
flag = -1;
// check the area the player has selected to mark
for (i = 0; i < 9; i++)
if ((PmouseX >= (BigBoxXY[i][0])) && (PmouseX <= (BigBoxXY[i][0]
+ 120)))
if ((PmouseY >= (BigBoxXY[i][1])) && (PmouseY <=
(BigBoxXY[i][1] + 95)))
if( ttt[0][i] == 0){
ttt[0][i] = playerMark;
m_moves=_T("You marked space ");
m_moves+=REPitoa(i + 1,2);
m_msg2=_T( "Marked ");
m_msg2+=REPitoa(i + 1,2);
playerDONE = 1;
show_boards();
opening();
return;
}
}
/////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
void setRandom()
{
// Seed the random-number generator with current time so that
// the numbers will be different every time we run.
if(randseed == 0){
randseed= (unsigned int) timeGetTime();
srand( randseed );
}
}
/////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
int Random(int num)
{
int r;
DWORD r1;
return r;
}
/////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
void show_boards()
{
showSmallBoard();
showBigBoard();
}
/////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
void showBigBoard()
{
int i, x, y;
HDC hMemDCO= ::CreateCompatibleDC(NULL);
HDC hMemDCX= ::CreateCompatibleDC(NULL);
HDC hMemDC = ::CreateCompatibleDC(NULL);
SelectObject(hMemDCO, markO);
SelectObject(hMemDCX, markX);
SelectObject(hMemDC, BigBoard);
Chapter 11
if(num == 0) num=1;
r1= rand();
r= (int)r1 % num;
164
Chapter 11
Chapter 12
3D Game Engines
The current trend in gaming is 3D games from a first-person or thirdperson POV.
Designing and programming a state-of-the-art 3D game engine could
take a team of programmers a year or more to develop, and during this
game development process, some tweaking and bug fixes would occur. A
successful game experience validates and makes other developers and
publishers interested in licensing that games 3D engine. Some development teams dont have the time and talent necessary to create their own
3D game engine, so finding one that suits their needs and budget is more
desirable.
The current 3D game engines fall into three categories, which I call
economy, midsize, and luxury. The less expensive the engine, the
older the technology and less features there are available. Likewise, the
more expensive the 3D game engine, the newer the technology and more
powerful and plentiful its features.
New Definitions
BSP (Binary Space Partition): In drawing 3D scenes, a tree structure is
created and accessed where the objects are stationary and the
players view direction changes.
LOD (Level of Detail): The number of needed polygons based on that
objects distance from the camera. The closer the object is to the
camera, the more polygons it needs to look real. As it moves away
from the camera, its details are less desired (removing the extra
polygons speeds up the rendering process).
Texture: A 2D image that can be mapped onto a 3D image or polygon
MipMap: Miltum in Parvo or many things in a small place is Direct3Ds
method of aliasing by limiting the ratio of pixel size to texel size
(texture coordinate).
Bump Map: The process of using white and black to make a surface look
bumpy. White or light will make a surface look tall or raised, while
black or dark will make the surface look flat (no bumps).
165
166
Chapter 12
Economy 3D Engines
Genesis3D from Eclipse (www.Genesis3d.com)
The Genesis3D game engine (1997) is free to use for commercial and noncommercial games and is an Open Source 3D game development engine,
which means that any code modifications to the Genesis3D engine that
your game makes will be freely distributed to the world. Also, the
Genesis3D logo must be the first logo displayed in your game without
modification.
If you want to keep your engine modification code a secret (private)
and/or not display the Genesis3D logo, this engine becomes a midsize
engine costing you $10,000 for a special Eclipse license.
The Genesis3D engine requires programmers and artists to create an
entire game using the Genesis3D engine; a Windows programming language like Visual C++ 6 (or higher), Borland C++, Delphi, or Visual
Basic; a 3D modeling art package like Animation: Master v8 (or higher),
Milkshape3D, 3D Studio Max 3 (or higher), or Truespace; and a BSP
(binary space partition) level editor like the included GEdit. DirectX 6 (or
higher) is needed to run Genesis3D on Windows 95, 98, Me, and XP.
Please note that your game design and code will not be distributed
just the modifications that you make to the Genesis3D code (the engines
DLL, LIB, or tools).
3D Game Engines
167
For more information, please check out their web site (www.Genesis3d.com), as well as Wild Tangents web site (www.wildtangent.com) and
Destiny3Ds web site (www.destiny3d.com).
In 1999 id Software released the original Quake source code under the
GNU general public license. If your development team has skillful talent
but little cash or a small budget and can abide by the GPL terms, then this
engine should be looked at. There are no restrictions on distributing a
game using the GPL Quake engine, the engine that released such games
as Half-Life, Hexen, Gunman Chronicles, Laser Arena, and Quake.
If you wish to avoid the GPL terms, the non-GPL Quake license can
be purchased for a flat fee of $10,000 per title with no royalty.
This version includes networking code (some of the best mid- to highlatency network code ever designed) and the fast code and rendering you
found in Valves Half-Life. An especially great 3D game engine for budget titles (under $20 retail software).
The Torque Engine (sometimes referred to as the Tribes 2 engine) supports reflections, environment mapping, detail texturing, static or dynamic
LOD (Level of Detail), skeletal animation, and animation blending. Soon it
will have bump mapping and vertex and pixel shading. Facial animation
and lip-synching are being discussed, but since this engine is built for
action and strategy games, these features are relatively low priority.
The Torque 3D game engine from GarageGames is ideal for independent game developers with huge dreams but less cash. The Torque game
engine sells for $100 per programmer (an incredibly low price considering
this is the Tribes 2 engine developed by Dynamix), which includes the
source code and has some of the best networking in the industry, including
that of the Unreal and Quake 3 engines.
Chapter 12
168
Chapter 12
TGE has been used by several triple A titles and includes the latest in
scripting, geometry, particle effects, animation, texturing, and awardwinning multiplayer networking code.
The documents and a nice demo are provided to run in Win32 (OpenGL
and DirectX) and Macintosh OS 9/X server and client with OpenGL and
Linux.
The Torque Engine comes with a scripting engine, a GUI engine, a mission engine, a 3D engine, a mesh engine, a particle engine, a terrain
engine, an interior building engine, a water engine, and networking, sound
(3D sound support with panning, volume, Doppler, and cones), spatial
database, collision testing, vehicle physics, and tools (3DS Max plug-ins,
exporter, WorldCraft converter, and lighting).
Torque technology games include Starsiege, Tribes, Front Page Sports:
Skiing, and Trophy Hunting IV.
Whats the reason for such an inexpensive and extremely powerful 3D
engine? In 1998 Dynamix employees started GarageGames, and Sierra
(Dynamixs parent company) partnered with them for the development
and licensing of the Torque Engine. After paying the minimal $100 per
programmer upfront fee, the source code to the Torque Engine, a demo
application, and access to the CVS server is provided. Simple games are
put on the server as free games. Higher quality games are put in a pay
bin where revenue is split 50-50 between GarageGames and the developer. Extremely good games are published and distributed down the retail
box chain through one of GarageGames publisher affiliates where they
receive 20 percent and the developer gets 80 percent of the royalties
received. Developers can look for their own publishing deal, but
GarageGames must be involved in the negotiations once theyre
underway.
Unlimited products can be developed using one Torque license. Products that are placed in the pay bin are priced by the developer and bought
by the educated public. Developers who contribute to the official source
code and technology base can trade off back-end royalty points for the
code.
The Torque Engine in its stock state supports up to 128 players in a
single game.
As of September 2002, the licensing agreement for the Torque Game
Engine (TGE) will no longer require TGE licensees to publish on the
GarageGames site. GarageGames will absolutely stand by their guarantee
to publish games under their current license agreement and offers current
licensees the option to move to the new agreement. The new license
agreement requires indies (independents) to qualify based on having current annual revenues that do not exceed $500,000 in order to license the
software for the $100-per-programmer price. Specifically, the EULA will
state under Grant of License: GarageGames grants you the right to use
the Software in accordance with the terms of this Agreement. If the
annual revenue of your company is less than $500,000 U.S. annually, you
may publicly sell, distribute, release, publish, and/or transmit any games
3D Game Engines
169
created with the Software. You may distribute free demos of the Games
through third-party distribution channels. Free games may be distributed
from your own web site.
You can get the engine for $100 per programmer, create a demo or a
game, and know that you only have to pay $10,000, no royalties, for the
technology once you sign your deal. Or, the other scenario is that you use
the low-price engine to create your game and start your own company.
The engine is nearly free as you are getting started and money is tight.
Then, if you succeed, you kick the $10,000 back to GarageGames (i.e., if
you are successful, they are successful).
Chapter 12
170
Chapter 12
Coding can be done using Code Warrior 7, Delphi, Visual Basic, and
Visual C++.
Landscape Studio Editor builds worlds entirely from scratch using any
polygon mesh. Sliding (player movement) and bouncing (projectile movement) is supported. Entity generation quickly generates a random forest
and other objects defined by parameters that the designer sets that
include vegetation maps, random rotation and scale (for trees of varying
sizes), height, range, and more.
Power Render supports three main types of animation: keyframing
(rigid bodies), morphing (vertex interpolation), and skinning (skinned
mesh over keyframed bones). A terrain can have a maximum height field
of 512x512a little higher if texture quality is sacrificed.
Power Render has three types of licenses where a license can be
upgraded for the difference between the two prices. The shareware or
freeware Power Render version is free to download (with a recommended
$289 shareware price). This version includes a single-user unlimited
shareware and freeware product (not for commercial products but great to
demo to a publisher and upgrade after the product gets a signed contract
or green flag to go retail). The tools and libraries can be used in their
binary form, 12-month technical support and library updates (pay the
shareware fee), and access to the FTP site for downloads and beta versions. The product must display the Power Render logo and copyright
somewhere in the product.
Power Renders commercial single-user product license (a $1,500 price
tag) allows one person to develop and commercially sell his game (one
game per license). The tools and library are in binary form with 12 months
of technical support and library updates, access to the FTP site for downloads and beta versions. This license allows for commercial distribution
royalty free for unlimited products for one person. The products must display the Power Render logo and copyright somewhere in the product.
Power Render commercial site license with source (a $5,500 price tag)
allows for multiple users at multiple locations for developing a single title
(per license). The tools and libraries are included as binary with full
source code, technical support, and library updates available for 18
months, access to FTP site for downloading updates and beta versions.
This is a royalty-free commercial distribution version for one game with
modification to and distribution of tools and editor to end users for creating custom mods.
3D Game Engines
171
In December 2001 id released Quake 2 source code under the GNU general public license. If you have a development team that has skillful talent
but little cash or a small budget and can abide by the GPL terms, then this
engine should be considered. There are no restrictions on distributing a
game using the GPL Quake engine, the engine that released such games
as Hexen 2, Daikatana, Heretic 2, Kingpin: Life of Crime, Sin, Soldier of
Fortune, and Quake 2. The Quake 2 engine has more advanced hardware
and software rendering and updated network code that launched successful titles such as Soldier of Fortune and Anachronox. The tools can be
licensed separately for $5,000 per project with numerous third-party tools
available.
If you wish to avoid the GPL terms, the non-GPL Quake 2 license can
be purchased for a flat fee of $10,000 per title with no royalty.
The Web Driver is a platform for the development of high quality, high
performance, compact 2D and 3D content for the Internet. It consists of a
high-level API for Java, JavaScript, and other COM-enabled languages,
such as C, C++, and Visual Basic, and has a powerful graphical engine
underneath. The API provides both 2D and 3D support, allowing the creation of everything from simple 2D or 3D content, such as product
visualizations for e-commerce, to full-fledged 3D games. All of these can
run within a web page simply by visiting a web site.
Triple A console companies such as Activision and EA (Electronic Arts)
are using Web Driver to allow players to play via the Internet.
Chapter 12
172
Chapter 12
173
Chapter 12
3D Game Engines
174
Chapter 12
3D Game Engines
175
Chapter 12
n Personal Use: Use of the Web Driver is always free and can start
immediately upon downloading the SDK without any other contact with
WildTangent. However, when posting or publishing the developed content, securing a technology license is required regardless of the
intended use. If the ultimate plan is to post or publish your Web
Driver-developed content on a personal (noncommercial) web site, the
license will be free of charge.
n Commercial Use: Use of the Web Driver is always free, however we
require a technology license and adherence to the appropriate terms
prior to posting or publishing. If the ultimate plan is to post or publish
your Web Driver-developed content on a commercial web site, you
must secure a commercial technology license.
n Affiliate Program: If youre interested in learning about participating
in WildTangents Affiliate Program, eliminating tech licensing fees,
and having WildTangent distribute your content through the Broadcast
Games Network, please e-mail your name, your companys name (if
any), the URL where your Web Driver game is currently located, and a
game design document to [email protected].
176
Chapter 12
Games utilizing the LithTech Engine include Aliens vs. Predator 2, Blood
2: The Chosen, Kiss Psycho Circus: The Nightmare Child, Legends of
Might & Magic, No One Lives Forever, Shogo: Mobile Armor Division,
Atlantis, Die Hard: Nakatomi Plaza, and Global Operations. Future games
to be released are TRON 2.0, No One Lives Forever 2: A Spy in
H.A.R.M.s Way, and the Matrix MMP.
3D Game Engines
177
Chapter 12
178
Chapter 12
The Serious Engine supports bump mapping, true reflection and environment mapping, detail texturing, and dynamic level of architectural
detail to create a rich and eye-pleasing game. The engine supports large
open-space terrain, and through a custom visibility algorithm combined
with an extensive LOD for model and the world, enables games to have
both indoor and outdoor aspects on the same level. A fast LOD algorithm,
an advanced Serious Engine feature, allows for a high number of models to
be visible on the screen at one time.
Level editors have tools that can create realistic open-space environments utilizing both directional and subtle ambient lighting with flexible
and detailed backgrounds. To prevent texture repetition (or tiling), multilayered texturing is used.
The CroTeam has utilized their engine on
Serious Sam: First Encounter and Serious Sam:
Second Encounter.
The Serious Engine by CroTeam is a 3D game
engine and has a graphics editor for creating
models called Serious Editor, which includes full
engine and tools source code, Serious Demo and
Serious full-game source code, direct technical
support via e-mail with the engines creators,
and online manuals for the Serious Editor and
Serious Modeler.
The Serious Engine includes intuitive tools, rendering and 6DOF
(degrees of freedom) physics, and exceptional technical support from the
CroTeam.
The Unreal Engine is a complete, evolving game framework that has powered such games as Epics Unreal Tournament, Ion Storm Austins Deus
Ex, Electronic Arts Harry Potter, and the U.S. Armys Americas Army
game. It features a suite of authoring tools, physics, AI, collision detection,
multiplayer networking, high-polygon object rendering, a surface shader
3D Game Engines
179
system, skeletal animation, and terrain rendering. It interfaces to 3D Studio Max and Maya through provided data-export plug-ins.
Chapter 12
The authoring tools include UnrealEd, a real-time level design tool based
on constructive solid geometry that is optimized for building real-time 3D
environments and fully integrates with the Unreal Engine, providing
actual camera views, all lighting, placement of textures, and geometry
operations that immediately work, giving the level designers extremely
fast feedback.
The Unreal Engine is fully supported on Windows, Xbox, PlayStation 2,
and GameCube, and ports are available for Macintosh and Linux.
Unreals AI has intelligent bots that know how to move using all
player movement options, weapons and inventory, and switches and navigate on platforms and open doors.
The path AI navigation system has complex evaluation,
alarm points, and static states
algorithms.
The Unreal development system provides licensors with the
complete source code, the editing tools including UnrealEd and
the 3D Studio Max and Maya
plug-ins, and access to the support web site and mailing lists.
The complete source to Epics
latest game, currently Unreal Tournament 2003, is included for reference.
Updates with new features are provided every two to four months.
180
Chapter 12
About RenderWare
Criterion has two RenderWare products, RenderWare Platform and
RenderWare Studio.
RenderWare Platform is a suite of truly multiplatform game production
technologies. Platform provides a tailored set of open and extensible tools,
allowing developers to focus on content and gameplay rather than reinventing the wheel. The API offers an open framework that aligns all the
essential components of game production (graphics, audio, physics, and
AI) into one single, powerful toolkit.
RenderWare Studio is the only complete game production system. It
streamlines the entire development process by integrating all the essential tools and technologies (graphics, physics, audio, asset management,
exporters, viewers) into a single unified production environment. By parsing the source code and generating an intuitive UI that controls all game
attributes immediately, the entire development team is provided with a
real-time link to all target platforms, ensuring that a live build of the game
is immediately available. Geographically dispersed teams are able to share
assets and collaborate on gameplay, engineering, and production in real
time.
RenderWare is used extensively by the majority of developers and publishers within the game development community, such as Activision,
Acclaim, Capcom, Rockstar, EA, Empire Interactive, Infogrames, Interplay, Konami, Lucas Learning, Midway, Sierra-Online, Eidos, Namco, Sony
Computer Entertainment America, Sony Online, THQ, Titus, and Ubisoft.
RenderWare is used in more that 250 titles and over 400 SKUs
(multiplatforms) with released titles having generated over $1 billion in
revenue for the publisher community to date.
More About RenderWare Platform
RenderWare Platform provides developers with the following modules for
PlayStation 2, Xbox, Nintendo GameCube, and PC and is behind chart
toppers including Grand Theft Auto III, Tony Hawks Pro Skater 3, Burnout, Mortal Kombat 5: Deadly Alliance, and Pro Evolution Soccer.
3D Game Engines
181
Chapter 12
RenderWare Graphics
182
Chapter 12
Configurable pixel format descriptor allows the user to define the type
of rendering environment to meet the needs of each application (e.g., the
resolution of the Z-buffer depth).
New GUI-driven build manager simplifies SDK and application building
on all platforms.
RenderWare Graphics architecture uses a component-based approach
based around a thin-layer, core library supplemented by a number of
plug-ins and toolkits. Plug-ins are the key to RenderWare Graphics
power; they can extend existing objects and add new objects of their own
that can also be further extended.
Support for all the native geometry formats reduces upload time and
the memory needed for rendering.
RenderWare Graphics features and benefits:
n Rigid body dynamics provides dynamic interactions between in-game
objects, realistically resolved with appropriate Karma behaviors. You
can achieve all the accurate and spectacular physics events you need
for your development.
n Flexible primitive and terrain collisions allows robust interactions
between smooth or rugged landscapes and irregular objects within the
game world to attain the best physics accuracy and immersion levels.
n Rag-doll provides amazingly realistic character physics and is available
for reactionary in-game behaviors. Impressive human impact responses
to being hit by projectiles, and uniquely complex events like falling
down stairs are now available to developers of all genre of game.
n Comprehensive Joint and Constraint Library provides for natural
laws that can be applied to limbed entities for believable movement
of human and exotic characters alike. Restriction for hard and soft joints
can be set to dampen and cap movements across all degrees of freedom
in the simulation of muscle-driven movement. The possibility of animation-driven physics is also opened up with customizable joint attributes,
such as velocity and position being exposed.
n Time-slicing provides complex physics calculations that are broken
down across several frames of processing to ensure that they dont hit
the frame rate.
n Flexible architecture allows RenderWare Physics to either be quickly
integrated or comprehensively extended, depending on the developers
needs, thanks to the flexibility of its architecture.
n Multiplatform solvers provides fast and stable physics solvers that
are optimized to each platforms processing capabilities. The user is
given the ability to find the balance accuracy and fidelity of the simulation. In addition, we offer a small memory footprint and non-spiking
performance. Solvers can also be switched between each other on a
frame-by-frame basis.
3D Game Engines
183
RenderWare Physics
RenderWare Physics is a portfolio of game/genre-specific physics effects
built on a common underlying math library. It provides fast and stable
physics modeling suitable for use in every genre of game and other interactive 3D applications. It provides the ability to add real-time dynamic
behavior to your game objects. Now characters can roll down a set of
stairs, vehicles smash into each other and into pieces, and structures collapse. RenderWare Physics adds realism to environments and introduces a
new dimension of exciting gameplay opportunities. Everyday objects can
move, fall, and even break in reaction to the player; furniture can be
pushed over, and doors can be blown off their hinges!
RenderWare AI
Chapter 12
184
Chapter 12
n Player cloning tool allows a developer or a game designer to develop
a behavioral agent without coding it. The developer or the game
designer simulates the behavior that he wants, and the tool generates a
clone reproducing his behavior.
RenderWare Audio
RenderWare Audio is an extensible, data-driven, multiplatform, interactive
audio engine with a light external API used to control the data-driven
architecture.
RenderWare Audio 2.0 has a completely new streaming system with
greatly increased performance, such as (1) support for interleaved
substreams to enable instant switching between streams, (2) regions
allowing a single file to be segmented into many separate streams, (3)
quick stream (stream caching) allowing instantaneous seeking and playback, and (4) command queuing allowing beat matched switching between
streams or interactive music applications.
Enhanced Wave Dictionary Editor with extended compatibility, functionality, and increased performance includes (1) the ability to edit
parameters (bit-rate, frequency, target format, etc.) for each wave, (2)
reduced wave import time, saving file links to waves and only building the
wave dictionary on export, (3) wave data conversions to optimize audio
data for your target platform, (4) wave conversions that can be implemented within the run-time RenderWare Audio API, (5) wave conversion
that supports PCM and VAG (Sony ADPCM) for PlayStation 2, and (6)
data contained within wave dictionaries that can now be converted to any
supported format when a wave dictionary is either loaded or saved.
RenderWare Audio 2.0 also has analog and digital Dolby Surround
Sound support dependent on the hardware, memory management
extended enabling multiple management strategies, significantly reduced
memory requirements, and platform-specific enhancements. RenderWare
Audio for PlayStation 2s new streaming system makes better use of the
IOP processor, avoiding SIF DMA transfers between EE and IOP; the new
DMA manager greatly increases the IOP <-> SPU2 transfer throughput,
support for Dolby Pro Logic II and Dolby Digital 5.1 Playback, and Analogues and digital output (for Dolby and Stereo).
More About RenderWare Studio
RenderWare Studio enables the faster development of new concepts and
full working levels, validating game designs at a much earlier stage in the
games life cycle. There is no need to invest man-years developing
tailored tools and technology for each game or platform, as RenderWare
Studio provides the full data-driven framework, so developers can hit the
ground running and get straight on to developing critical gameplay and
features from the outset.
RenderWare Studio is a major risk reducer for a number of reasons. Not
only is it a proven, integrated AAA game delivery system, but the greater
3D Game Engines
185
visibility that the team has across the entire games production cycle
means that should new team members be added or replaced, it can be
done so without causing disruption to the workflow. More importantly, this
visibility enables both developer and publisher to manage the games production at a more commercial level, being able to share and forecast
progress and creative direction earlier in the cycle.
Unlike conventional games development methods, RenderWare Studio
empowers all team members to import and modify their own work independently, without relying on the activity and progress of the other
elements of game production, resulting in faster progress and ensuring
heightened development efficiency. The final phase of the development
life cycle is also less problematic, with tuning and testing being dispersed
throughout the entire development cycle. Bandwidth and productivity
therefore become easier to control, resulting in more efficient resource
management across the entire studio.
As a result of the faster development capabilities of RenderWare Studio, developers can improve the quality and reduce the cost of their
playable game concept. With a game demonstrator immediately available
on all game platforms, developers are able to maximize the product pitching, reviewing, and focus testing processes.
By improving the overall efficiency of the team and catalyzing significantly reduced development times, RenderWare Studio gives the team
greater confidence and more valuable time to focus on delivering truly
innovative and unique gameplay ideas to make the game stand out from
the crowd.
RenderWare Studio has a real-time communications link to PlayStation
2, Xbox, GameCube, and PC, with regular updates for immediate, continuous play testing.
Developers can look forward to fast, easy integration of RenderWare
Studio into their current working environment, and the high scalability of
the RenderWare architecture means that developers can effect a seamless
integration of their existing tool chains and assets. Asset importer plugins link RenderWare Studio with your preferred art package, and developers can extend the coverage of any import path, as all are open and well
documented.
With the latest build of the game available to both developer and publisher, concepts and ideas can be easily shared throughout the duration of
the project. Progress updates can be facilitated quickly and easily, and
mutually agreeable and realistic milestones can be set.
Chapter 12
RenderWare Support
186
Chapter 12
The NetImmerse toolkit includes plug-ins for all of the popular content
creation packages. These plug-ins allow the user to easily view content in
real-time and export content to the NetImmerse Engine. Plug-ins are
available for Discreet 3D Studio Max and Alias-Wavefront Maya.
Licensees receive full source code for all plugins as well.
NetImmerse is a cross-platform 3D game engine for the PC,
PlayStation 2, Xbox, and GameCube that allows developers to begin creating content immediately, saving more than six months of development
time and years of engineering costs. NetImmerse provides plug-ins that
integrate seamlessly with Discreet 3D Studio Max and Alias-Wavefront
Maya, the most popular modeling packages for game developers. The
plug-ins directly export whatever geometry, textures, texture effects, animations, particles, and skin/bones information that the specific modeling
package can create to the NetImmerse native file format (known as NIF
files).
NetImmerse Core Technologies includes components such as scene
graph, culling and sorting, portals, rendering, lighting, textures and transparency, level of detail, animation, particle systems, skinned character,
dynamic collision detection, 3D sound, physics using the Havok physics
engine and special effects like fog (modes include range-based, Z-based,
and texture-based volumetric), lens flare, and dynamic shadows.
The NetImmerse hierarchical scene graph is optimized for high performance real-time applications, particularly 3D games. Multiple types of
geometric primitives are supported, including lines, particles, indexed triangle sets, and indexed triangle strips.
NetImmerse automatically culls any geometry that will not appear on
the screen using standard view frustum culling, leaving more CPU cycles
for drawing visible objects.
The NetImmerse Portals module or room-to-room visibility system
is designed to enable applications to render and manage large interior
datasets.
A fully general camera model is supported so that the view frustum
need not be symmetric (this is useful for oblique cameras, mirrors, and
other effects). Multiple, simultaneous, independent cameras are supported, which may be used for split-screen rendering, inset windows, or
offscreen texture rendering.
NetImmerse supports dynamic RGB lighting. These dynamic lights can
be any color and may be point, infinite, or spotlights. Specular highlights
and prelit vertices are also supported.
NetImmerse supports a wide range of texture effects, including (1)
multitextures, such as light maps, dark maps, gloss maps, decals; (2) projected textures, including projected lights and shadows (for interesting
lighting effects); (3) animated textures, for effects such as fog, fire, smoke,
and explosions; (4) environment maps (spherical environment maps are
supported on all platforms, with cubic environment maps supported on
DX8 and Xbox); (5) rendered textures, which may be used for television
187
Chapter 12
3D Game Engines
188
Chapter 12
Single Use
$50,000
$75,000
$100,000
$125,000
Unlimited Use
$150,000
$200,000
$250,000
$300,000
All licenses include complete source code to all NetImmerse libraries, modules,
and plug-ins for the platform licensed.
3D Game Engines
Annual Support
Description
One platform
Two platforms
Three platforms
Four platforms
Single Use
$25,000
$30,000
$40,000
$50,000
189
Unlimited Use
$40,000
$50,000
$60,000
$70,000
Support includes e-mail access to NDL technical staff and two enhancements/
updates per year. Unlimited use support fees assume support for no more than
three simultaneous projects per year; support for additional projects in the same
year incur an additional support fee.
More than 30 titles have shipped using the NetImmerse 3D Game Engine,
such as MMRPG Dark Age of Camelot, Freedom Force, The Elder Scrolls
III: Morrowind, Project Entropia, and Star Trek: Bridge Commander.
Chapter 12
The Quake 3 Arena Engine is the current top engine from id Software
available for the PC (Windows), the Macintosh, and Linux operating systems. The Dreamcast port of Quake 3 Arena is also available.
The Quake 3 Arena license includes a one-time, full-day question and
answer session with John Carmack on the engine and level design and
shader construction issues with ids artists and level designers. Additional
time can be arranged with ids expert programming staff to address particular needs.
The world editor, Q3Radiant, and shader guide are also included with
the Quake 3 Arena license. Current best-selling games using the Quake 3
Arena Engine are Star Trek: Elite Force, Return to Castle Wolfenstein,
and Quake 3 Arena.
For a single title license, id Software charges a $250,000 guarantee
against a 5 percent royalty of the wholesale price.
Chapter 13
Artificial Intelligence
(AI)
Artificial intelligence is a scientific term that gives nonhuman entities
algorithmic and mathematical solutions for problem solving and simulating
human thought and decision making. In films, this is often depicted as a
mechanical robot trying to act human. In computer or videogames, it is the
heart and soul of the nonplayer characters (NPCs) controlling our enemies
and allies.
Typically, we think of games such as chess, checkers, and backgammon
as intellectual and sophisticated games, therefore a machine that can simulate being an adversary (especially a masterful one) has been a way for
researchers to validate their AI techniques. Since computers can process
mathematical instructions and perform iterations (repetitive processes)
very fast, researchers in AI use these skills to simulate human thought.
As game designers, we must not only plan our vision but try to conceptualize each idea and how it can be expressed through a mathematical
expression or logically arrived at through a database search or script. You
will discover that simple, everyday activities are in fact very complicated
and complex concepts.
In a baseball game, the pitcher throws the ball at the catcher as the batter from the opposing team tries to hit the ball and safely get to a base.
Most of us have seen this scenario many times on television or at the ballpark. There are many complex issues being processed in this simple
example of a sports game. The batters box is empty so the team at bat
sends out their next batter (based on the roster and batting order) to the
plate. The pitcher holding the ball may first check the runner on first base
based on the following conditions: (1) There is a runner at first base, and
(2) the first base runner is leading or positioned off the base by a few feet
or more. The pitcher, who still has the ball even after the ball has been
thrown to the first baseman, knows that a batter is in the batters box
ready to receive a pitch. The ball is thrown based on a preset speed, type
of pitch (curve ball, fast ball, slider, and so on), target position in the
strike zone, and factors based on real-world factors like typical pitches
and number of strikes, balls, and wild pitches this pitcher throws. The batter responds by swinging at the ball or not.
191
192
Chapter 13
A pitch will be judged as a strike or a ball (if the batter doesnt swing)
based on the pitchers real-world factors previously mentioned. A
swung-at pitch will use the batters real-world factors like number of
strikeouts, singles, doubles, triples, home runs, type of preset hit (bunt,
grounder, short hit in the air in the outfield just outside the infield), power
hit (deep outfield or a possible over the wall home run), and point of
contact with the ball (late swing, early swing, or perfectly timed swing).
The batters real-world factors and player factors, such as options
selected and timing triggers, are combined, and a logical result should be
determined. For example, a selected option to bunt would not result in an
over the wall home run nor would a batting pitcher typically hit a home
run or even a triple. The algorithm should include for a batting pitcher an
extremely small (one in 10,000) chance of hitting a home run, a little
better chance (one in 5,000) of hitting a triple even if the real-world factors indicate this is unlikely to occur. As the batter hits the ball into fair
territory, the players in the field must follow the hit ball and respond if
they are currently the closest field player to the ball. A ball hit to left field
may have the shortstop initially moving, but as it passes by or over his
head, he stops moving and the already moving left fielder continues moving until he acquires the ball. There are certain logical (predetermined)
movements, such as the pitcher backing up the catcher on certain plays or
the shortstop backing up the third baseman or second baseman, especially
if they are the players moving after the ball.
Lets look at a situation where the center fielder has just acquired the
ball after it has hit the ground (so a caught fly out is not possible). There
are runners at second base and first base, and the batter who just hit the
ball is advancing to first base. The center fielder can throw the ball to the
third basemanouting the runner from second base, throw the ball to the
second basemanouting the runner from first base, or throw the ball to
the first basemanouting the batter advancing to first base.
What decisions does the experienced center fielder make in the real
world? If the situation occurred when the team at bat had two outs, it
would be vastly different than if the team at bat had no outs. (Remember,
three outs retires the side, and the inning is over.)
I handled this situation in my baseball endeavor by remembering that
each base is 90 feet from the other. The database had a factor for each
players 100-yard dash speed (300 feet) and a factor for each players
throwing speed and accuracy. Before acquiring the ball, the computer calculated the distance from the point of acquisition of the ball to each base
(first base, second base, and third base) and factored in the center fielders
throwing speed and accuracy to each of these bases against the runners
speed and his distance to the next base or his current position (remember
the runner could be leading off the base when the ball was hit) to the next
base. The action that would result in a guaranteed out would be selected
first. If no out situation was possible, then throwing the ball to the most
advanced base or third base to stop further advancement would be the
default selected.
Lets assume that this scenario would have the center fielder throwing
the ball to the second baseman. The second baseman would out the runner from first base. If this would be the third out, the action would
terminate and the at-bat team would be finished; possibly the sides would
exchange places (batting side taking the field and vice versa). If the outing
at second base was not the third out, the second baseman would have to
evaluate the current situation, just like the center fielder had done (second
base runner is running to third base, is on third base, or is running home;
batter is running to first base, is on first base, or is running to second
base). These factors would result in another throw by the second baseman
to the first baseman, to the third baseman, to the catcher, or possibly held
until all action is halted and the runners are safe (stationary, not advancing) on first and third base. Then the second baseman would throw the ball
to the pitcher. The batters box would again be empty and the cycle
continues.
This seems like a lot of calculating and planning, but as designers, we
must express our vision to the other team members, like the programmers who must translate our vision into concrete instructions, the artists
who must provide models and artwork needed for each of these scenarios
and actions, and the sound engineers who provide realistic sound effects
to add life into this realistic and intelligent creation.
In our design, we must be consistent and fair. If a pitcher has no batting
statistics (this is possible nowadays), then have some planned criteria
such as minor league or college statistics followed by an average division,
league, or professional statistics for pitchers.
When designing a game like chess or poker, design the best or championship skill level first and then lessen its strength. Lower strength levels
can have threshold criteria placed on the player, shorter search path
depths, or time limits to determine the best move found. In chess, you
may exhaust all paths of analysis for the expert, set a limit to the depth of
each path or a threshold value (such as situation is valued at half a pawn
or better end analysis) for a club player, and select one of several random
non-losing moves for a novice player.
Pathfinding
Pathfinding is probably the single most popular and frustrating game AI
problem in the industry. Games like role-playing games (RPGs) and
real-time strategy games (RTS) often have characters sent on missions
from their current location to a predetermined, player determined, or
menu-selected waypoint (destination). The perfect situation of a movement would be a no-collision or obstacle path.
193
Chapter 13
194
Chapter 13
The first solution in avoiding these obstacles is to ride the rail or walk
around the objects surface until youre free to continue toward the
destination.
Although the riding the rail algorithm solves the problem of avoiding
obstacles, it looks silly and unrealistic, sort of a blind persons path
solution.
The next solution is to make the path less blocky by connecting points
of the hypotenuse of the triangles.
The last issue to make the path to our waypoint truly realistic is to curve
the path.
If we were to flood fill the white area with black, it would continue filling
until it hit a non-white spot.
Each space or node would check its neighbors in the four directions, and
if the neighbor is white, it would be changed to black. This recursive
(repeating) process would repeat until all four directions starting with
node A return a false or no non-white connecting nodes are left.
The A* algorithm is similar. A node is placed on an open list, and if a
shorter node path is found, the new path replaces the current path (which
gets placed on a closed list). The shortest path from a start node to a
destination node is the final path left when all paths have been searched.
The objects that are on the map as collision areas should include the
static objects like buildings, water, fences, and so on, as well as dynamic,
195
Chapter 13
196
Chapter 13
moveable objects like vehicles, people, and floating bridges. The game
design may include the ability to destroy objects like buildings and
bridges, thereby modifying the original list of static objects. Another game
design might require that characters avoid areas due to hazardous conditions that may be in effect under certain conditions or for a certain time
period or avoid specific tribes and clans. These avoidance issues greatly
change the terrain path created. One solution would be to dynamically (on
the fly) set these areas when needed as an obstacle block or zone and let
the path-finding function handle this as though it were a large building to
walk around.
The solutions discussed thus far dont take into account various terrain
elevations. Nature has rivers running downhill, and our characters would
probably prefer a downhill path to town rather than a Mount Everest
climbing shortcut. The distance over Everest may be the shortest, but its
elevation and treachery makes it less desirable. If each node had an elevation factor, the path created would be the shortest path within reason.
Otherwise, the characters morale and fatigue factors would be greatly
increased, causing negative results later. The elevation factor could also
be used in the characters line of sight functionality. If a character were
standing in a ditch, that character probably wouldnt see the massive
horde of enemy troops heading toward him in the distance. On the other
hand, a fort on top of a mountain would have its residents line of sight
able to see quite a distance and its cannons able to fire a long distance. If a
character is standing on one side of a building, the enemy approaching
from the other side would be unnoticed since the characters line of
sight would be blocked by the building. These factors add to the realism
of the game, and thats what players demand. Thats what your game
design should include.
Other pathfinding issues would include formations (groups of moving
objects) and the turn radius and ramping up or down speed to initialize a
movement and terminate a movement. A formation is a group of characters all moving independently but as a group. Soldiers in two columns
march behind their leader. As the leader turns, so does the entire troop.
They all must maintain their relative distance from the row in front of
them, march at the same speed (pace), and turn their bodies relative to
their path line. The leader may be marching north as the last soldier in the
line is still marching east 50 feet behind the leader. Formations also must
not collide and bounce off each other like billiard balls. These are complex
structures that must be in your game design and algorithmically understood by the team developing your vision.
Humans are bipeds and, if they are moving the wrong direction, can
turn on a dime and reverse their movement toward the goal. Vehicles and
horses need more space to create a turn radius. Your car needs to circle or
turn around when reversing from the road south to the road north. We
have fancy terms like the U-turn and the K-turn when a car is reversing its direction. People can perform this maneuver with an about face
motion. These factors must be incorporated into the game design for a
realistic look and feel in your game. People, horses, and vehicles dont
jump into a quick speed and just stop on a dime at will. Moving objects
need to increase their speed (velocity) and decrease it before coming to a
complete stop. These factors are not easy to implement but should be
addressed in the design document and discussed as the game is being
developed. Often, ideas, concepts, and features that are in the design document hit the cutting room floor (do not make it to the final product).
These design document items should be frequently discussed and
addressed to determine their status as to whether they are in, out, or
on hold for the final product. Most items, given enough development
time and money, can be implemented. In reality, developers dont have this
luxury of unlimited time and available finances.
AI is an important consideration in the success of your game. Often, I
read on Internet gaming sites that the development team planned to do AI
last and within a week or two. This inexperienced and ignorant decision
severely delayed the project, and the AI was quickly finished without a
real solid solution. The teams have often said in the aftermath of a major
project that they wished they had started the AI earlier and had longer to
work on the best AI possible (not the best AI as soon as possible).
197
Chapter 13
Chapter 14
The Basics of
Scriptwriting
In 1995 I decided to learn all about the movie-making business. The film
industry is a well-established medium similar to game design and production with its own rules and theories. I have said for some time that if a
movie were made like a video game, the audience would walk out after
five minutes.
In game design and implementation, we often lack solid and interesting
storylines. (Thats why I recommend borrowing masterpieces from
other disciplines like classic stories, movies, and history in Chapter 6 and
on the companion CD.)
The gaming business blames technology for our shortcomings like
slow computer speed, not enough memory or RAM, terrible storage
space available on CD or DVD, and lag time or slow Internet transmission rates. We pay little attention to important visual issues like lighting,
camera POVs, actor position and the verbal impact on their delivery, and
sound effects. Ive heard this said and agree that technology is a tool and
not the basis for designing a great game. Stories, character development,
interesting puzzles, and interaction make great games.
The film business is just thata businessand many game publishers
and developers fail to understand and operate like a profitable business. I
have seen and been paid by companies that ran their business haphazardly
and without plans, documentation, or any goals except to finish the current game at some point.
The film business has several phases like preproduction, where the
script is written, the shooting schedule is prepared and documented, the
entire films budget is documented, the in-front and behind the camera
crews are hired, and the filming locations are scouted out and selected.
After six to eighteen months of extensive planning that has been
researched, documented, and communicated to all personnel involved, two
to eight weeks of expensive filming begins. Then postproduction begins
with first dailies (each days or previous days shooting reviewed) to
ensure that the filming is useable. If were satisfied with the currently
shot footage, we are ready to continue. Otherwise, we must reshoot
scenes or make cutting room floor decisions. Postproduction also includes
199
200
Chapter 14
editing (which takes to use, which POV or shooting angle looks best) and
voice audio (the shooting dialogue is only a place holder as actors and
actresses rerecord all of their lines in a soundproof room for the final
merging with the film).
When the film is shot, the film itself contains no audio, which is
recorded on another medium like audio or digital tape and later merged
together with the film in the editing room. Obviously, video contains both
audio and video, but almost always the audio is redone in postproduction.
Also in the postproduction phase is ADR (Automated Dialogue Replacement, also known as looping) and Foley, which is where sound effects
and clean, audio dialogue are added to the film.
It is in post that a film may go through several staff and audience viewing tests to see how people react to various versions of the film.
As a film producer, you would be expected to understand the filming
process like lights, camera angles, and filming techniques as well as dealing with your crew, actors, writers, and studios. Similarly, as a game
producer you should be equally skilled.
This book is about game design and not filmmaking. These skills,
although they may be interesting to learn, fall more into the realm of the
game producer. The skills that the designer needs to understand are the
preproduction skills mentioned earlier, which include script writing,
scheduling, budgeting, characters needed, and stage direction (how you
envision the screen to depict a scene like CLOSE-UP on George as he
enters the room seeing his wife dead for the first time).
A brief introduction to these skills is discussed in this chapter, and
through your research in the library or a favorite bookstore you can learn
additional insights about the film business, preproduction, and
postproduction.
Film is a linear (one beginning, one middle, and one ending) type of
medium where the audience is passive (only watches the presentation).
Later, we look at a suggested nonlinear, game-oriented standard that has
worked in my endeavors.
In writing a script for actors to follow, there are certain standards in formatting your masterpiece. Standard items in your script would be a slag
line or scene identification, the action in this scene (a description of any
action), the character who is speaking, the dialogue or line spoken by this
character, any action being performed as the character is speaking (he
lights a candle as he walks toward the hallway), the camera and stage
directions (information to the cameraperson like CLOSE-UP, CUT TO,
FADE-IN), and scene notes that the writer wants to briefly convey. Typical
information in a slag line are location (the courthouse steps, in the evil
doctors laboratory, outside in front of Johns house), the time of day and
weather conditions (nighttime, around 10 P.M. as the rain is pouring down),
stage instructions (dark room lit by a flickering candle, blindingly shiny
room with an open window), cues and special effects (lightning, explosions, ringing telephone), and background music.
201
Slag lines include INT. for interior shot and EXT. for exterior shot,
along with the time of day.
Chapter 14
202
Chapter 14
10
11
12
13
14
FADE IN:
SCENE 1:
The script has several important items that are used, such as the name of
the character, the characters dialogue, the dialogue directions, and the
page number.
The CHARACTER NAME is always in all capitals and starts on the
40th space or pica. The dialogue starts on the 30th space or pica and ends
on the 60th space or pica. The dialogue directions begin on the 35th space
or pica. The page number begins on the 75th space or pica and is two lines
from the top. All SOUND EFFECTS are in all capitals.
000000000111111111122222222223333333333444444444455555555556
123456789012345678901234567890123456789012345678901234567890
(Roger walks in the room tired.)
ROGER
What a busy and tiring day!
Let's see what I received in
the mail today.
203
entirely. The first time you open the box, you might be greeted by a simple Hello, whereas the second time you open the box you may be
greeted by Im glad to see you again.
Alice in Wonderland
statue in Central Park,
NY. Pictured are
Alice, the Mad Hatter,
the March Hare, the
Dormouse, and the
Cheshire Cat
Lets look at one of my favorite stories by Lewis Carroll, Alice in Wonderland. For those who have not read or seen on film this exciting adventure
story, Ill briefly explain it in linear mode (there are many Internet sites
where you can download the entire book, including the original drawings).
A worthy game about Alice in Wonderland is Electronic Arts American
McGees Alice where upon Alices return to Wonderland she learns of its
chaotic and demented state and must return the world to its proper happy
state. This theme is similar to the film Journey Back to Oz, which was
based on Baums Ozma of Oz and a few characters and situations from The
Marvelous Land of Oz.
Chapter 14
Alice in Wonderland
204
Chapter 14
Chapter 1, C: Alice falls down the hole slowly. She sees cupboards, bookshelves, maps, and pictures upon pegs as she falls.
Chapter 1, D: Alice touches down and follows the White Rabbit down a
long corridor lit by a row of hanging lamps.
Chapter 1, E: Alice ends up alone in a hall filled with locked doors. A
three-legged glass table appears with a tiny golden key on top
of the table. Alice finds a small 15-inch door behind a curtain
that the little golden key fits. A liquid in a Drink Me bottle is
swallowed by Alice who begins to shrink to ten inches. Alice
leaves the golden key on top of the glass table. An Eat Me
cake is eaten and Alice grows nine feet high.
Chapter 2: White Rabbit appears, dropping his white kid gloves and a large
fan after seeing large, giant Alice. Giant Alice cries, creating a
pool of tears. Using the White Rabbits fan, Alice begins to
shrink.
Chapter 3: Alice is swimming with several animals and birds that assemble on a bank. To dry off, the group, consisting of Alice, a lory, a
dodo, an eaglet, a duck, a magpie, a canary, and two crabs (a
mother and her daughter), run in a circle or caucus-race.
Alice gives everyone candy and presents herself with a
thimble.
Chapter 4, A: The White Rabbit commands Alice to go to his house and
return with a pair of gloves and a fan. Alice travels to the
White Rabbits house and collects a pair of gloves and a fan.
Alice finds and drinks from an unlabeled bottle and begins to
grow, filling up the entire house. The White Rabbit, a lizard
named Bill, and two guinea pigs begin to throw pebbles that
turn into little cakes when they hit the floor near Alice. Alice
eats one of the cakes and begins to shrink.
Chapter 4, B: Alice runs into the woods. She sees an enormous puppy
who playfully wants to fetch after a stick. Alice escapes into a
flowered, grassy area where on top of a large, growing mushroom sits a hookah-smoking large caterpillar.
Chapter 5: The Caterpillar tells Alice that eating one side of the mushroom will make her grow and the other side will make her
shrink. Alice eats the right side and begins to shrink. Alice
manages to eat the left side and grows enormously. A pigeon
flying overhead sees Alices head and long neck and assumes
that Alice is a serpent. Alice tries pieces of the mushroom:
left-hand pieces to grow, right-hand pieces to shrink, until she
is back to a normal size.
Chapter 6: A Fish Footman and a Frog Footman are chatting as the door
shuts. The door opens and Alice enters a large kitchen filled
with smoke where a Duchess sits nursing her baby on a three
legged-stool with her cook stirring a cauldron of peppered
soup. Sitting on the hearth is a wide grinning Cheshire Cat.
The cook begins to throw pans, plates, and dishes at the
205
Chapter 14
206
Chapter 14
Box 2:
207
Box 3:
(multi entry)
The Rabbit Form, a dark nightclub with pulsating music
dimly lit by a row of hanging lamps owned by the White Rabbit.
Cards, dominoes, and chess pieces are dancing to the music. In
the back there are stairs leading to a basement.
Box 4:
(multi entry)
An empty basement with several locked doors, a sofa, two
comfortable chairs, a coffee table filled with cakes and glasses
of purple, green, and yellow juices, and a three-legged glass
bookcase with a golden key lying on the top shelf. Each door
leads to a different box.
If Alice partakes of the Eat Me cakes on the coffee table, she
will turn 18 years old. Then with another bite, shell become
23 years old. After another mouthful, shell turn 28 years old
and lastly become 33 years old again.
If Alice drinks from any of the glasses, shell lose five years
from her life, so if shes 18 years old, shell turn 13 again. She
can never get older than 33 or younger than 13. She needs to
be at least 23 to acquire the key and 13 to unlock and open any
door.
The first door enters the Alice Tear Lake Island.
The second door enters the entrance to the White Rabbits
House.
The third door enters the white rose garden leading to the
Kings Castle.
Box 5:
(multi entry)
Alice Tear Lake Island is the island where the caucus race
happens and was created by the first of Alices tears. This is
where Alice interacts with other virtual 3D characters, such as
a lory, a dodo, an eaglet, a duck, a magpie, a canary, and two
crabs (a mother and her daughter).
On the first time here (or if Message One flag is not On)
Alice learns that, after the original Alices first visit, the Queen
of Hearts has been placed in the dungeon for beheading half
Chapter 14
208
Chapter 14
(multi entry)
The White Rabbits House where the White Rabbit, the messenger and herald for the King, lives. The White Rabbit has
many employees who have cottages on his estate, such as the
housemaid, Mary Ann, the butler, Pat, and the gardener and
handy creature, Lizard Bill.
Box 7:
(multi entry)
The Rose Garden in front of the Kings Castle where the gardenersthe Two of Hearts, the Five of Hearts, and the Seven
of Heartspaint the white roses red and prune the luxurious
gardens. Often in older days croquet was played here with flamingo mallets, hedgehog balls, and playing card arches.
Box 8:
(multi entry)
The woods where an enormous puppy playfully wants to fetch
after a stick. The woods are located just north of the Caterpillars Mushroom.
Box 9:
(multi entry)
The Caterpillars Mushroom. A flowered, grassy area where on
top of a large, growing mushroom sits a hookah-smoking large
caterpillar. The caterpillar explains that eating the left side of
the mushroom will make one grow older and the other side
will make one grow younger. A pigeon flying overhead attacks
grown-ups (over 23 years old). This is located just south of the
woods (beware of the giant puppy).
(multi entry)
The Duchess House where a Fish Footman guards the
entrance and inside the large kitchen filled with smoke a Duchess sits nursing her baby on a three-legged stool with her cook
stirring a cauldron of peppered soup. Occasionally, sitting on
the hearth is a wide grinning Cheshire Cat who can disappear
and often gives great advice. Quite often the cook throws pans,
plates, and dishes at the sneezing Duchess and her baby whom
the Duchess violently tosses in the air. From the Duchess
house, traveling to the right leads to the Mad Hatters House
and traveling to the left goes to the March Hares Hutch.
Box 11:
(multi entry)
Mad Hatters Property. Located on the front lawn of the Mad
Hatters domicile is a large table under a tree reserved for
drinking tea. Currently, the Mad Hatter and his mad as a
March Hare companion reside at the Castle where its always
tea time.
Box 12:
(multi entry)
The March Hares Hutch. In the shape of a large rabbit, the
March Hares house is cluttered with piles of carrots and bags
of tea.
Box 13:
(multi entry)
The Castle where the Mad Hatter rules in riddles and drinks
tea with his companions, the March Hare and the forever
sleepy Dormouse. The Hatter gets very few things done but at
least hes not running around chopping everyones head off
like the imprisoned Queen of Hearts did. In a nice room inside
the castle resides the King of Hearts. The Frog Footman runs
errands for the Hatter and the Hare but not very often. The
Mad Hatter enjoys watching the Knave of Hearts carry the
royal crown, especially in the Castles dungeon where the raving and angry Queen of Hearts sits. (Remember, she accused
the Knave of stealing her tarts at one time.)
Box 14:
(multi entry)
The Castles Dungeon is a large room where one side has a
metal-barred prison (room) with a bed, and on the adjacent
side is a foyer for visitors and guards to sit at the table or move
the chairs toward the prisoner. Currently, the Queen of Hearts
resides here and is visited daily by the Knave of Hearts, who
delivers a fresh tart each morning and leaves it on a chair in
front of the barred prison just out of reach of the Queen. The
King, who lives in his lofty room upstairs in the castle, has
Chapter 14
Box 10:
209
210
Chapter 14
(multi entry)
Gryphon. The mountain cave of the Gryphon (half lion and half
eagle). Just a short trip from here to visit the Mock Turtle.
Box 16:
(multi entry)
Mock Turtle. The sandy beach area by the sea where the Mock
Turtle lays on a rock sobbing and tells marvelous stories and
puns.
Possible endings:
Alice stays in Wonderland forever.
Alice returns home in time for her 33rd birthday.
Alice returns home as a 13-year-old and her mother lives past
33.
Alice returns home as an 18-year-old and goes to college.
Alice returns home as a 23-year-old and meets a handsome
doctor.
Alice joins the Queen of Hearts in the dungeon.
Alice becomes the new Queen of Wonderland.
Alice goes mad and becomes a wicked witch who gets visited
by a girl named Dorothy and her dog Toto (but thats another
story).
211
ALICE
Hello. Nice to see you again, Duchess.
My has the pig, eh. . .baby grown.
ALICE
Hello, again.
Boy, I sure come here often.
May I hold the baby?
The dialog does not follow a linear story; therefore the scripting should
follow the game flow and the actors dialogue should look exactly like their
standard script format. This technique assures us that the game will have
all of the script conditions and voice-over parts to shoot, and the talent
(which we will be working with from outside the gaming industry) will
view us as professional and understand the work we need them to perform. By providing our needs in this format, we can get the talent to read
their lines based on our games conditions, price out the costs for their
efforts, and have many verbal variations so our gameplayers wont be
bored or frazzled by hearing the same repeated dialog every time they
enter the Duchess kitchen.
Scene
Name
Mary
John
Michele
Roger
Brooke
Megan
Now the shoot scheduler must analyze this table of actors or characters
versus their scenes. In the analysis phase of the scheduling using the
example, lets examine the scenario where the actor Roger is a famous,
Chapter 14
Label:
ALICE-06-005 (Chapter 6, after first time)
Condition: Alice enters the Duchess kitchen (after first time)
212
Chapter 14
award-winning thespian who will enhance the sales and marketing of our
game. Rogers time is both valuable and expensive compared to the other
actors in our shoot.
Ideally, wed want to shoot his (Rogers) scenes first and work around
his schedule. In the example, Roger appears in scenes 1, 4, and 5. Lets
look at a shooting schedule that begins on a Monday, and Rogers agent
tells us that he is only available for one scene a day and free on Tuesday,
Wednesday, and Friday.
In this scenario, wed shoot the scenes in the following order:
Monday is for shooting Scene 3 (Roger is not available).
Tuesday is for shooting Scene 4 (Roger is available).
Wednesday is for shooting Scene 5 (Roger is available).
Thursday is for shooting Scene 2 (Roger is not available).
Friday is for shooting Scene 1 (Roger is available and finished).
Saturday (last shooting day) is for shooting Scene 6.
This analysis for the schedule would have the following effect:
Mary works on days 1, 2, 3, and 5.
John works on days 1, 2, 4, and 6.
Michele works on days 1, 2, and 4.
Brooke works on days 1, 2, 3, and 6.
Megan works on days 1, 2, 3, and 4.
This schedule accommodates the specific schedule of superstar Roger and
tries to minimize the other actors schedules that may require costly overnight lodging, meals, and transportation. Try to maximize the act and
leave process and minimize the nonworking (off) days.
Another criterion to examine is location-dependent situations, such as
renting an authentic World War II fighter airplane. Renting such a vehicle
might be less expensive in the off season or midweek (Tuesday through
Thursday), since air shows occur on weekends and transporting to and
from the air shows probably occurs on Friday to travel to the show and
Monday to return back to the home base.
If a scene needs to be shot with an authentic World War II fighter airplane, this scene with all of the actors involved would have priority for a
scheduled midweek shoot. The earlier the better (like on Tuesday rather
than Thursday), since the shoot scene might have to be reshot (a botched
Tuesday shoot could be reshot on Wednesday when a Thursday bad shoot
would have to be reshot the following Tuesday, costing time and money).
If a venue or location is rented for the day, all scenes and acts that take
place in that venue must be scheduled for that days shoot. The venues
shoot day is more important than the actors schedule, and the production
scheduler must weigh all of the scenarios and costs involved to properly
construct the entire production schedule that may include costly actors
time, venues, and prop rental.
During a location shoot, the costly actors scenes are shot first, followed by the scenes that would dismiss the most actors, so as the day
progresses fewer actors remain (act and leave).
When developing a script for cut scenes, in-game character voices, or
cinematics, scheduling included in the design document not only helps the
producer and development team but is needed for budgetary considerations, such as the number of shoot days, number of actors and crew,
location setups (needed actors, crew, and props and equipment), a fallback
or contingency plan due to bad weather (such as rain or snow), and absent
personnel (such as sick or accidentally detained).
The schedule helps in set building (when needed, transporting the
sets), props needed, scheduling rehearsals, and actor stand-ins for camera
adjusting and lighting the scene.
213
Chapter 14
Chapter 15
215
216
Chapter 15
Encoded or Stereo
8-bit
5,292 K
2,646 K
1,323 K
960 K
217
Cakewalk (www.Cakewalk.com)
Cakewalk offers a variety of award-winning multitrack recording products
both for the professional and the beginner, such as SONAR, SONAR XL,
Home Studio, Home Studio XL, and Metro 5 (Mac).
Chapter 15
SONAR
218
Chapter 15
Cakewalk is developing support for OMFI (Open Media Framework Interchange) technology into its flagship SONAR 2.0 digital multitrack recording system. OMFI support for SONAR 2.0 is now in the alpha-testing
phase at the company.
OMFI is the film, video, and audio industrys standard for saving and
transferring digital postproduction projects between different production
studios and workstation platforms. SONAR 2.0 will both import and export
OMFI format files and should be available by fall 2002 at no charge to all
registered SONAR 2.0 owners.
The company also recently joined the Advanced Authoring Format
(AAF) Associationthe organization responsible for the continuing development of OMFI-based technology. Cakewalk is the first Windows audio
software company to join this influential trade association.
The AAF is a broadly based trade association created to promote the
development and adoption of AAF technology. AAF technology allows content creators, editors, and rich media authors to exchange video, audio,
images, text, and metadata between applications and builds on existing
OMFI technology.
In addition, Cakewalk plans to support Broadcast Wave files in SONAR
2.0 at the same time that it releases support for OMFI files. The Broadcast Wave Format (EBU Standard N22) allows audio material to be
interchanged between different computer platforms and broadcast environments. It extends conventional RIFF WAV files by adding metadata,
such as creation date and time, material identifier, and time position
(SMPTE).
219
SONAR Software
Price
SONAR 2.1
$479
SONAR 2.1 XL
$599
$199
$249
SONAR XL
SONAR XL provides all of the capabilities of SONAR, plus
two additional 64-bit, fully automatable DirectX 8 mastering effects, an advanced DXi soft synth drum sampler,
audio loop libraries, and a SoundFont library (available for
Windows 98/Me/2000).
Chapter 15
220
Chapter 15
SONAR 2.0 XLs 64-bit, fully automatable audio effect features hard- or
soft-knee compression, no-clip brick wall limiting, and ultra-fast
attack/release times, as well as analog-style metering.
221
Metro 5
Metro 5 is the complete digital audio and MIDI studio for
the Mac. You can record tracks using any musical instrument or sound source, arrange your music with flexible
pattern-based sequencing, explore new ideas with creative
songwriting tools, mix in real time using automated audio
effects, edit and print notation, and even produce scores
for film, video, games, and QuickTime movies.
Chapter 15
Home Studio XL
222
Chapter 15
Cakewalks Metro 5 has an improved user interface for increased musical productivity, supports ASIO-compatible audio cards, and has automated
real-time effects processing, up to eight stereo auxiliary buses for routing
real-time effects, improved drag-and-drop editing of audio, audio file compression for improved disk storage, VU meters for accurate level monitoring of audio and MIDI, audio scrubbing for quick auditioning of tracks,
crossfades with linear and exponential curves, and context-sensitive,
searchable online help and online tutorials.
With Cakewalks Metro 5 you can record up to 64 tracks of digital audio
at variable sampling rates from 11.025 kHz to 48 kHz and edit and process
with sample accuracy and off-line edits. Cakewalks Metro 5 multitrack
MIDI allows up to 99 tracks of MIDI per section with up to 32 sections per
song file where you can edit notes, controllers, tempo, pitch bend, and
drum patterns within a single window. Composers can pitch, bend, and
transpose notes and edit the drum grid, perform criteria-based editing,
velocity editing, and print notation. You can turn MIDI tracks into notation
or transcribe a MIDI performance or enter notes with a mouse. Scores can
be printed with titles, expression text, dynamic markings, and scalable
staves.
223
Metro 5s audio hardware support has, in addition to Apple Sound Manager, support for ASIO-compatible audio devices, including MOTU 2408,
AudioMedia III, Event Layla, Yamaha SW1000 XG, Korg 1212 I/0, Sonorus
Stud/O, Alesis PRC, and Lucid PCI 24.
As of January 2003 the prices of Metro software were:
Metro Software
Price
Cakewalk Metro 5
$249
$ 49
$ 49
Cakewalk Metro 5upgrade from 1.X, 2.X, SE, DECK II, beyond
$ 49
$ 49
Chapter 15
224
Chapter 15
225
Chapter 15
226
Chapter 15
perfectly to any tempo and can be rendered with effects just like audio
tracks.
ACID PRO includes features such as the Beatmapper remixing tool, Video
scoring track, and Chopper editing tool. It has a powerful new effects
model, 32 effects per track, 32 effect chains/26 buses, sample rates up to
192 kHz, 12 new DirectX audio plug-ins from XFX2 and XFX3, MIDI
record and playback, MIDI file support, DLS sound file support, CD ripping/CD extraction, master, track, and assignable audio effects, attack,
sustain, and release (ASR) envelopes, track envelopes to lock to events,
Vegas Audio LE multitrack editing software, and user interface
enhancements.
Platform: Windows 98SE, Me, 2000, or XP
List price: $499.95, packaged: $399.96, download: $349.97
227
Chapter 15
228
Chapter 15
229
Awave Studio is shareware; it is not free. This means that if you like the
program and decide to use it past the 30-day trial period, you must register (i.e., buy itthe price is $99.95). There are also a number of
incentives for registering it such as:
n Removes nag screens and other annoying reminders
n Removes save limit
n Enables some locked features (copy/paste, saving bank files, and batch
convert)
When you purchase Awave Studio, you get a one person-one computer
licensevalid for the current program version. You are sent a personal
registration code that unlocks the shareware version, turning it into the
full registered version.
Sound Ideas is an online resource for sound effects and production music.
Its collection includes:
General Sound Effects Collection
The General Series 6000 Extension I
The General Series 6000 Extension III
Series 2000 General Sound Effects Library
BBC Sound Effects Library 1-40
The International Sound Effects Library
De Wolfe Classic Sound Effects Library
Chapter 15
230
Chapter 15
PowerSurge 1
Larger Than Life
Power Pack from Digiffects
Specialty Sound Effects Collections
The Art of Foley
Series 9,000 Open & Close
Series 4,000 Hollywood
Click Shop from Digiffects
The Works
Audience Reactions I
Audience Reactions II
Ambience Collections
231
Chapter 15
Futuritys Metropolis
Hi Tech & Top Secret
Effects
Historical Series
HPX Digital Effects
Laughs, Cheers, and
Applause
Lon Benders Wacky
World of Widgets
Martial Arts & Human
Impacts
Metropolis II
Paradise
232
Chapter 15
Premiere Edition 4
(Volumes 41 to 50)
Sci-Fi Set
Sound Designer Tool Kit
Sounds of a Different
Realm
Sounds of Speed
Sports With Balls
Chapter 16
Testing
Through the entire development phase, testing is performed by a variety
of skilled team members. Programmers are constantly checking and testing their code for accuracy, for speed, for efficiency, and against the
designers specifications. QA (quality assurance) testers perform various
tests throughout the development process that varies as the game development cycle progresses.
In the beginning of a games development, the testing should check
basic design issues such as: Are the graphic images displayed correctly?
Are they in the correct location on the screen? Do the buttons work in
various modes like mouse-over, clicked-on, and normal mode? Are the
correct sounds and sound effects being played? Are the sounds audible?
Does the volume need adjusting?
The next phase should test the user interface, the input and user decision paths (the numerous possible actions a player may take), and the
basic gameplay.
As the game becomes more playable and stable (fewer glitches and
bugs), various hardware configurations should be tested, such as numerous PC brands, CPU speeds, operating systems (Windows 3.1, 98, 2000,
Me, and XP are examples), 3D cards, graphic cards (various supported
graphic modes), and printers. Actual gameplay from an experts POV
(knowledgeable, genre fanatic) to a complete idiots POV (beginner or
novice player) should be tested, and problems that were previously
reported and now labeled as fixed (problem was resolved) should also be
verified. If the game supports multiplayer or Internet options, these components should be tested throughout the day and night for the throughput
test play speed (latency) and to verify the aspects in the game that
should work in multiplayer mode.
A good practice is to have the programmers include in the game an
audit trail that writes the algorithms that determine all gameplay (a list
of each algorithms variables and conditions set). This way, when a tester
finds an unexpected response or action, the programmer can check the
equations and conditions that caused this event. Also, many gaming companies have the QA testers videotape their sessions. Since most developers can never find the problems that QA has uncovered, the tape is a good
233
234
Chapter 16
source for proof and a record of current bugs and problems that need to be
addressed. This is especially needed if the testers and developers do not
work in the same area.
Testers need to create a common database (records) of a products
ongoing testing problems and bugs. This bug report can be as simple as
a text document or a spreadsheet. Better still are databases like Microsofts Works, Microsofts Access, and Oracle. The report should be in a
common area that all testers have access to and provide the producer (the
person who is responsible for the project) a uniform report in which to
communicate with the developers.
Here is an example of a bug report that a tester could use (feel free to
expand upon this):
Product: ___________________ Bug ID#: _________ Date: ___/___/______ Time: ___:___ A/P
Tester: _____________________ Product Version: ______ Video SMPTE*:
Bug Severity:
Hardware:
Critical
Major
Minor
Enhancement
___ Printer
___ Internet
Description of Problem:
Status: 1st Submission, 2nd Submission, Need more Info, Undecided, Open Bug
Date: ___/___/_____ Tester: ____________________ Fix ID #: ______________________________
Reason:
Problem Fixed on _____/____/______
Producer Fix ID #: _______________
Tester:
Sr. Tester:
*Video SMPTE is the Society of Motion Picture and Television Engineers. There is an SMPTE time code standard
(hr:min:sec:frame) used to identify video frames.
In the bug report, we want to know everything about the problem (what
the tester saw and thinks is a problem). There can be multiple pages
based on the same problem if the developers have not resolved it to the
testers satisfaction. The producers report should be listed in severity
order and status, flagging the number of times this problem has been submitted to the developers.
Upon the bug being fixed, the tester and the senior tester must sign off
on the report, and the producer must give the testers a Producer ID number to validate that everyone is in agreement that the bug has been fixed
(the testers, the producer, and the development team).
Why does testing matter to the game designer?
Testing
235
Chapter 16
Chapter 17
The Executive
Summary
(The Five Pager)
The Executive Summary (aka Five Pager or Design Treatment) is a basic
summary of the games concept and a description of the game, including
the basic plot, the gameplay, the demographics (players or target audiences gender, age), the flow of the game from the starting scenario to
several typical endings (successful and unsuccessful), and the games features (like graphics, audio presentation, hardware controls, licensed
properties). The Executive Summary is a short, concise information and
promotion document, ideally five pages, for the executives to grasp your
games concept, gameplay, and features.
237
238
Chapter 17
necessary to earn valuables and range from street venues to galley ships
to elaborate casinos a la Las Vegas.
The target audience is vast, from teenagers to adults, and includes both
sexes. The battles can be played as twitch games where quickness and
timing win or as strategy versions where the player acts as the general of
the space armada.
The first platform will be the IBM PC and Windows 98, 2000, Me, XP
using a 3D engine that supports vast planet-size outdoor terrains, as well
as the indoor venues such as palaces, casinos, castles, small inns, and single-unit dwellings. Then the Internet version would be next, allowing
players on a PC, PlayStation 2, GameCube, or Xbox to play each other in
the various battles or adventure independently from planet to planet.
play the Bulgarian or Abares King and command the battle, or skip the
battle as Candide did.)
After witnessing a horrific battle, Candide manages to escape and travels to Planet Holland. On Planet Holland, a kindly merchant named James
takes Candide in. One day Candide runs into a deformed beggar who is
covered with scabs, his eyes sunk in his head, the end of his nose eaten
off, his mouth drawn on one side, his teeth as black as a cloak, snuffling
and coughing most violently, and every time he attempted to spit out
dropped a tooth. This deformed beggar turns out to be Master Pangloss.
Pangloss explains that Cungonde and her family have all been brutally
murdered by the Bulgar army after they battled the Abares. Cungondes
body was ripped open by Bulgarian soldiers after raping her. They
knocked the Baron, her father, on the head for attempting to defend her,
and the Baroness was cut in pieces. Their son was killed in the same manner as his sister. As for the castle, they have not left a single stone.
Pacquette, the pretty wench who waited on the noble Baroness, was
exiled earlier after laying with Pangloss. Pacquette was infected and
became a carrier of a sex disease that violently killed off 20 billion people.
Pangloss explains that he has contracted the deadly sex disease known as
the Phallic Plague. Nonetheless, he maintains his optimistic outlook.
James takes Pangloss in as well.
The merchant makes Pangloss his bookkeeper. After two months,
James has some mercantile affairs on Planet Lisbon and takes the two
philosophers with him on the transportation ship.
The three travel to Planet Lisbon together, but before they arrive their
ship runs into a meteor storm and James is cast into space by a brutish
flight attendant. Candide, trying to help his benefactor, is prevented by the
philosopher Pangloss, who demonstrates to him that the flight to Planet
Lisbon has been made on purpose for the merchants death.
The meteor damage to the ship forces a crash landing where the whole
crew perishes, except Pangloss, Candide, and the brutish flight attendant.
As they walk toward the capital city of Planet Lisbon, the earth trembles
under their feet, and the purple sea swallows up the land, causing 30 million inhabitants of all three sexes, young and old, to die beneath the ruins
and waters. Candide and Pangloss wander the city in search of food and
supplies since theirs were destroyed in the crash and explosion of their
meteor-damaged ship.
The masses of survivors begin to follow the Grand Reverend, who
believes that burning a few people alive over a slow fire with a great ceremony is an infallible prevention of earthquakes and floods. Pangloss is
soon hanged as a heretic, and Candide is flogged for listening with
approval to Panglosss philosophy. Others are burned. The same day there
is another earthquake and flood.
After his beating, an old woman accosts and dresses Candides wounds.
After a nights rest, breakfast, and another days recuperation, the old
woman escorts feeble Candide into the country about a mile from her
room. Candide sits on a magnificent sofa as the old woman leaves. The old
239
Chapter 17
240
Chapter 17
woman soon returns supporting, with great difficulty, a young lady, who
appears scarcely able to stand. Cungonde faints upon the sofa.
Cungonde explains that though the Bulgars killed the rest of her family, she was merely raped and captured by a captain. In three months,
having gambled away all his money and having grown tired of her, the captain sold her to a Jew named Don Issachar. After the Grand Reverend saw
her in church, he forced the Jew to share her with him as a jointly owned
sex slave.
To intimidate Don Issachar, the Grand Reverend invited Cungonde to
the ceremony, giving her a very good seat where she saw Master Pangloss
hanged and Candide flogged. Cungonde ordered the old woman to acquire
and restore Candide to health.
The two childhood lovers, Cungonde and Candide, embrace each
other passionately just as Senor Don Issachar unexpectedly enters the
dwelling. The Senor draws a sword as Candide, finding a knife, lunges at
him and kills the Israelite dead on the floor.
As Candide begins to move the dead body, knife in hand, the Grand
Reverend suddenly enters the dwelling and sees the evidence before him.
Candide lunges forward and puts another dead on the floor.
Candide, Cungonde, and the old woman ride three Andalusian horses
to the little town of Avacena, in the midst of the mountains of Sierra
Morena, and enter an inn. The sell their fine horses to a Benedictine friar
for transport fares to Planet Buenos Ayres.
On board the ship bound for Planet Buenos Ayres, the old woman
relates her own story. She was born the daughter of Pope Urban X and the
Princess of Palestrina but has suffered numerous misfortunes that include
rape, enslavement, and cannibalism.
Candide and Cungonde plan to marry and he gives her a promissory
locket to seal the engagement.
As they arrive on Planet Buenos Ayres, the governor, Don Fernando
dIbaraa y Figueora y Mascarenes y Lampourdos y Souza, the greatest
noblemen on the planet with an exceedingly fine mustache, proposes to
Cungonde.
In their flight from Planet Lisbon to Buenos Ayres, Cungondes money
and jewels are stolen, including some well-known items known to be the
property of the Grand Reverend. The Franciscan who stole them is captured and immediately hanged. Word soon spreads throughout the galaxy
that the stolen jewels of the Grand Reverend were discovered on Planet
Buenos Ayres. The dozens of intergalactic bounty hunters searching for
the Grand Reverends murderer head toward the planet.
The old woman convinces Cungonde to marry Don Fernando for her
own financial welfare and safety.
Candide and his newly acquired valet named Cacambo flee to a neighboring planet colonized by people who rebelled against Planet Lisbon and
relocated to their own planet. After landing, Candide and Cacambo are
captured by soldiers. After Candide claims to be from the planet of Westphalia and not Planet Lisbon, he is brought before the High Commander.
Candide and Cacambo are escorted by horses through acres of a vast garden and animal habitat over plush, orange hills and bridges that cross
green rivers to finally arrive at a beautiful pavilion adorned with a colonnade of green marble.
The High Commander turns out to be the reportedly dead brother of
the beautiful Cungonde and the true son of the Baron. After discussing
that the Barons son had survived the inflicted wounds and rose up in
ranks to rule this planet, he learns of Candides promise to marry his sister. As Candide is far beneath her status, this makes the High Commander
angry. The High Commander strikes him across the face with the flat side
of his sword. Candide in an instant draws his rapier and plunges it up to
the hilt in the High Commanders body.
After laying the High Commander behind the shrubs, Cacambo
removes the Barons clothes and puts them on Candide, gives him the
dead mans three-cornered cap, and makes him mount on horseback. Once
back where they landed their ship earlier, they escape to a neighboring
planet.
Upon landing, they see two large, green monsters attacking voluptuous
blonde-haired women. Candide figures that saving two beautiful women
from this vicious attack would make up in some small way for all of his
recent killings. Candide strikes down the monsters, who happen to be the
mates of the two women. This act was a ritual, an erotic lovemaking session that Candide mistook for violence. Fifty naked Oreillons (cannibals)
capture Candide and Cacambo and invite them to be dinner. Somehow
Cacambo convinces them to let them go.
They leave, heading for Planet Cayenne, but a meteor shower forces
them to land on an uncharted planet with steep terrain and active volcanoes. After carefully piloting the ship through the erupting volcanoes, they
safely land. Upon finding a canoe on this desolate planet, they paddle up
the yellow river until they see purple children playing catch with round
yellow, red, and green things, which upon careful examination are large
pieces of gold, rubies, and emeralds.
After collecting several fine gems, Candide and Cacambo, hungry, enter
a restaurant where the waitstaff are dressed in clothes made of gold. Upon
finishing their fine meal of soup, they offer to pay with the gems. The
owner of the establishment, laughing with his staff, exclaims that they are
not accustomed to charging and the joke is that they offered to pay with
the common pebbles found scattered throughout the town and roadways.
An old local townsman tells them that the inaccessible rocks and precipices and volcanoes had secured them from the rapacious fury of the
people of other planets who have an unaccountable fondness for the pebbles and dirt of their land.
Candide and Cacambo get into the coach, the six swift pack sheep fly,
and in less than a quarter of an hour, they arrive at the Kings palace. At
the entrance is a portal 220 feet high and 100 wide where 20 beautiful
young virgins in waiting receive Candide and Cacambo on their alighting
241
Chapter 17
242
Chapter 17
from the coach, conduct them to the bath, and clothe them in robes woven
of the down of hummingbirds.
They spend a whole month in this hospitable place until they plan to
return to their own world with only a dozen of the El Dorado sheep loaded
with the pebbles of this country to be as rich as any monarch on their
planet.
The mountains of El Dorado on all sides are over 10,000 feet high and
perfectly perpendicular. The king gives orders to his engineers to make a
lifting machine to hoist these two extraordinary men out of the kingdom.
In 15 days the 3,000 good machinists finish it and Candide and Cacambo
are high above El Dorado and ready to journey back to their ship.
After traveling about 100 days, they have only two sheep left of the
original 202 they brought with them from El Dorado. They finally reach
their ship and pack the gems and remaining food and water supply.
Candide decides to travel to Planet Surinam where he plans to send
Cacambo to Planet Buenos Ayres with instructions to use part of the fortune to purchase Cungonde from Don Fernando and then meet him on
Planet Venice.
As they land on Planet Surinam, the ship transporting them is in need
of major repairs. Being so rich with gems of El Dorado, Candide abandons
the ship for someone else to claim and repair. Cacambo leaves on a
freighter headed for Buenos Ayres.
Candide continues some days longer at Surinam, waiting for any captain
to carry him and his two remaining sheep to Planet Venice. A space pirate
named Mynheer Vanderdendur, who pilots a large vessel, comes and offers
his service first for a decent sum of money and then repeatedly for double
the previous sum. Nave and newly rich Candide pays the sum each time
and upon departure finds his valuable sheep, prepaid moneys, and
Vanderdendurs ship already launched.
Upon lodging an official complaint with the Planets magistrate,
Candide gets fined 10,000 credits for his petulance and ordered to pay
10,000 more credits for the fees of the court. Frustrated, Candide sails in
the opposite direction from Planet Venice to Planet Bordeaux. An old philosopher, Martin, is specially chosen to be Candides traveling companion
to Planet Bordeaux since he is a scholara pessimistic scholar at least.
On the trip to Bordeaux, a military patrol ship wanting to perform a
routine boarding is ignored, and the patrol ship fires upon and destroys the
ship piloted by Vanderdendur. Candide takes this as proof that there is justice in the world, but Martin staunchly disagrees.
Candide stays no longer on Planet Bordeaux than is necessary to dispose of a few of the pebbles he brought from El Dorado. Candides
disorder becomes very serious, and during his rest a little spruce Abbey of
Perigord comes to visit him.
When Candide feels better, the Abbey takes Candide to the planets
gigantic and elaborate casino where Candide falls in love with the actress
and entertainer Miss Clarion. Throughout each night he gambles and
afterwards waits for her to come by and chat with him. (Here is where the
243
Chapter 17
244
Chapter 17
of the rest, and their features, though greatly disfigured, appear to him to
bear a strong resemblance to those of Pangloss and the unhappy Baron
High Commander, Miss Cungondes brother. He is correct and buys their
freedom immediately.
The Baron of Thunder-ten-tronckh says that after Candides attack, he
was attacked and carried off by a party of Spanish troops, who clapped him
in prison on Planet Buenos Ayres. Master Pangloss claims that it rained
extremely hard when they were to burn him. Since it became impossible
to light the fire, they hung him because they could do no better. The executioner knew how to burn people very well, but as for hanging, he was a
novice at it. A surgeon purchased his body, carried it home, and prepared
to dissect it when he awoke.
Candide, the Baron, Pangloss, Martin, and Cacambo arrive on Planet
Constantinople at the house of the Transylvanian prince on the shores of
the Propontis. There they see Miss Cungonde and the old woman, who
are hanging some tablecloths on a line to dry. The fair Cungonde is all
sunburned, with bleary eyes, a withered neck, wrinkled face and arms, all
covered with a red scarf. Candide advances toward her out of good manners. She embraces Candide and her brother. They embrace the old
woman, and Candide ransoms them both.
Cungonde, not knowing that she has grown ugly, as no one has
informed her of it, reminds Candide of his promise and that she still wears
his locket in so peremptory a manner that the simple lad dares not refuse
her; he then informs the Baron that he is going to marry his sister.
The Baron becomes furious again so Martin decides to throw the Baron
into the sea. Cacambo concludes that the Baron must be delivered in
chains back to the Turkish captain and sent to the galleys.
Candide and the six dethroned kings raise an armada and travel to the
planet of Westphalia to reclaim the throne and castle rightfully belonging
to Cungonde and her heirs. (Another huge battle between the Bulgarians
and Candides forces. All of the Bulgarians on Planet Westphalia must be
destroyed.)
Upon winning the battle and establishing territories for the six
dethroned kings, Candide marries his mistress Cungonde. Their children
are taught the philosophies of Master Panglossthat this world is the
best of all possible worlds.
Living in the rebuilt palace with their own wing is the philosopher Martin, the prudent Cacambo, and the old woman.
One day two old acquaintances, Pacquette and Brother Giroflee, arrive
and are in the utmost distress. The couple had parted, been reconciled,
quarreled again, been thrown into prison, had made their escape, and at
last Brother Giroflee had turned atheist. Candide hires them as servants,
and Pacquette continues to follow her trade; but she gets little or nothing
for it.
Candide spends his days with Cacambo and finds the pleasures of cultivating his gardens.
245
Chapter 17
Candide 2517 contains the essential elements that players enjoy and
desire in a game. Candide 2517 has adventure, lost treasures and planets,
intergalactic fighting in twitch and strategy modes, and numerous paths
to journey to get to the final victory. Thanks to Voltaire, Candide 2517 has
a rich and colorful storyline with exciting and interesting characters. The
psuedo-license of Candide and the Land of El Dorado as seen in the hit
Disney film The Road to El Dorado will attract the mass market.
On September 11, 2001, America was shocked out of its blind optimism
by the attacks. Voltaire and Candide is more in the public eye because of
these terror attacks. Voltaires Candide asks audiences to question why
the world is like it is and makes people think how we can make it a better
place for everyone.
Chapter 18
Background
In late May 2001 I met with Phantom EFX in Iowa to discuss a follow-up
game to Reel Deal Slots. My previous casino games included products
from Villa Crespo Software, such as video poker (Stanford Wong Video
Poker and Dr. Wongs Jacks+), black jack (Dr. Thorps Black Jack), craps,
roulette, and poker (Amarillo Slims Dealers Choice, 7 Card Stud, and
Ruckus Poker). The meeting determined that the product was to be a
poker game, and some basic game design issues were discussed and written down.
In June 2001 the project was underway as design, programming, and
artwork progressed concurrently. The distributors wanted a Christmas
product, and that meant a mid- to late-August deadline (a gold master
reproduced and boxed by the end of August). That was a 12-week project
247
248
Chapter 18
life cycle. My friends in the industry laughed when I chatted with them
about the project, claiming that the time needed to complete a game of
this size was six to twelve months.
This case is not (I repeat not) the usual project life cycle. Several
important issues had to be done to meet these critical deadlines, such as
numerous daily meetings in the beginning to flesh out the game design,
total control of the project by the programmer (me), and working six to
seven days a week, ten to sixteen hours a day. Needless to say, the official
design document was never written. The design discussed daily was written down, and artwork submitted to programming had to be documented
(filename, screen positions, file format).
The project shipped on time with a few items dropped from the design
document and the Internet component placed in the first patch (downloadable update). In the design document of Reel Deal Poker Challenge in this
chapter, I note the design originally planned, and in brackets ([this was
dropped from the game because]) I discuss issues and reasons for
changes, later implementations, or dropping the issue from the game.
I have often read articles and books on game design that discuss game
design documents in theory. In this chapter I show you in detail what goes
into a game design document. This document is provided as a tutorial so
you can start with this template and create your own, much better design
documents for your visionsthe games of the future.
PHANTOM EFX
CASUAL GAME WITH ADVENTURE
ELEMENTS
WINDOWS 98/2K/Me/XP WITH DIRECT X 8.0
(Alphabetic order)
Roger E. Pedersen
Aaron Schurman
Danny Stokes
Marty VanZee
249
Overview
Rules of Poker
Hand Rankings
Poker Variations
Start of the Game (or After the Game Icon Is Clicked on)
The Cashiers Cage
VIP Register
The Lobbies
Prize Vault
Audio
Artwork
Lobbies
General
Poker Rooms for Four and Eight Players
First and Second Floor Card Icons
Third Floor Card Icons
Tournament
Tournament Information
Tournament Place Finished
First Floor
Lobby
Poker Room
Four Player
Eight Player
Tournament Room
Four Player
Second Floor
Lobby
Poker Room
Four Player
Eight Player
Tournament Room
Four Player
Third Floor
Lobby
Poker Room
Four Player
Eight Player
Tournament Room
Four Player
Special Floor
Poker Four Player
First Floor: Roman Motif
Yvette
Chapter 18
Table of Contents
250
Chapter 18
Profile
Poses
Mouth Animations
Animated Eyes
Sven
Profile
Poses
Mouth Animations
Animated Eyes
Hoyt
Profile
Poses
Mouth Animations
Animated Eyes
Second Floor: Oriental Motif
Melvis
Profile
Poses
Mouth Animations
Animated Eyes
Jacqueline
Profile
Poses
Mouth Animations
Animated Eyes
Mortimer
Profile
Poses
Mouth Animations
Animated Eyes
Third Floor: Egyptian Motif
Lizzie
Profile
Poses
Mouth Animations
Animated Eyes
Qiangsheng (aka Q)
Profile
Poses
Mouth Animations
Animated Eyes
Lou
Profile
Poses
Mouth Animations
Animated Eyes
Special Floor: World Championship Poker Room
Trevor
Profile
Poses
Mouth Animations
Animated Eyes
Trevor has been beaten (Red Dress Dance)
Eight Player Characters
Cards
Whole Cards
Discarded Cards
No Alpha Round Cards
Fake Drop Round Cards
Fake Drop Shadow Cards
Cashiers Cage
VIP Casino Card
VIP Clipboard
Cashiers Cage
Credit Screen
Statistics Screen
The Prize Vault
Chips
Tournament First Prizes
Floor 1 $5,000 Tournament Prizes
Floor 1 $25,000 Tournament Prizes
Floor 2 $25,000 Tournament Prizes
Floor 2 $100,000 Tournament Prizes
Floor 3 $100,000 Tournament Prizes
Floor 3 $500,000 Tournament Prizes
Special Floor $2,500,000 World Championship
Exit Game
Betting/Raising
Scriptwriting
Yvette
Sven
Hoyt
Melvis
Jacqueline
Mortimer
Lou
Q
Lizzie
Trevor
Cashier, Bouncer, and Manager
Programming
Basic Poker AI
The AI to Determine the Best Poker Hand Using Five to Seven Cards
Draw Poker (No Openers and Jacks or Better to Open)
251
Chapter 18
252
Chapter 18
Overview
Reel Deal Poker Challenge takes place in the Poker Palace where players
from each levels lobby enter the cashier cage, the slot room, the poker
room, or the poker tournament room.
The goal of Reel Deal Poker Challenge is to advance through each of
the three levels by winning tournaments and finally beating the World
Champion in a winner-takes-all showdown.
Poker game variations available are Draw Poker, Draw Poker with Jacks
or Better, Five Card Stud, Seven Card Stud, Chicago High, Chicago Lo,
Omaha, and Hold Em. (Omaha, a variation of Texas Hold Em, was added
due to its Internet and casino popularity.)
Based on the successful features from Reel Deal Slots and Video Poker,
Reel Deal Poker Challenge will incorporate two addictive features, such as
the Prize Vault and VIP player areas.
Players enjoy guessing what prizes they can win and gaining prizes in
their prize vault, as well as earning the right to have access to upper
levels where there are better players and higher stakes. The Internet play
through the Game Spy site will allow players (up to eight) to play a
selected poker variation and increase their chip inventory against other
human players.
Each room and lobby will have its own unique theme from Oriental to
Roman to Egyptian accompanied by ambient (background) music in
the lobby and in each room.
The slot room will be an extension to the Poker Palace to show off (and
gain sales for the slot game) and increase the players chip inventory.
(Although the players could enter the slot room and play several slot
games, the money lost or won in the slot room is not added to the players
chip inventory. The prior product written in Linux and Windows under a
different compiler using a special library for graphics and sound combined
with the extremely short development cycle made this feature a low priority. Finally, it was implemented as a separate room with an order this
great product screen before returning to the Poker Palace lobby. These
are the realities that separate a design document and your vision versus
getting the product on the shelf in the time requiredusually beyond
most of the teams control.)
253
Rules of Poker
Poker is played by using a single deck of 52 cards. The deck has four suits:
clubs , diamonds , hearts , and spades . Each suit has 13 cards
ranked two through ten, jack, queen, king, and ace (the ace can be the
highest or lowest card).
Poker games always begin with a shuffle to randomly sort the deck. A
brand new deck always has the 52 cards in suit and rank order.
Hand Rankings
The following examples are in ranking order, meaning the best hand has a
ranking of one and the worst hand is of rank ten.
Rank Hand Name
1
Royal Flush
2
Straight Flush
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
Four of a Kind
Full House
Flush
Straight
Three of a Kind
Two Pair
One Pair
High Card
Description of Hand
A, K, Q, J, 10 of same suit
Five same-suit consecutive
cards
Four cards of the same rank
Three of a kind plus a pair
Five cards of the same suit
Five cards in sequence
Three cards of the same rank
Two pairs of different rank
Two cards of the same rank
None of the other rankings
Example
10 , J , Q , K , A
4 , 5 , 6 , 7 , 8
7
3
3
5
J
5
A
K
, 7 , 7 , 7 , 6
, 3 , 3 , K , K
, 7 , 10 , Q , A
, 6 , 7 , 8 , 9
, J , J , 8 , 9
, 5 , 9 , 9 , 8
, A , 2 , 4 , 8
, 2 , 4 , 6 , 8
Poker has many variations with each variation having its own rules. The
more popular poker variations are Draw Poker, Five Card Stud, Seven
Card Stud, Chicago Hi, Chicago Lo, Texas Hold Em, and Omaha. Most
poker variations can be played with two to eight players. The cards are
shuffled and distributed by a player called the dealer. In all variations, the
first card is given to the player to the left of the dealer. A round of betting
consists of each player deciding whether he should bet (or raise after the
first bet was made) an amount from the groups agreed-to minimum to
maximum, fold (quit this round of play), or check (agree to cover the current amount due to the pot). When three raises to the original bet have
been made or all players have checked, the betting round is completed.
In Draw Poker, all players make a small blind bet or ante before receiving any cards. Then the players, starting with the player left of the dealer,
receive cards until each player has five cards. Players carefully look at
their cards and determine which cards to keep and which cards to discard.
Players can discard up to three cards (or four cards if they are keeping an
ace). Before discarding, each player may bet or raise, fold (quit this round
of play), or accept the current bet amount (check). Then the remaining
players discard their cards. Another round of betting occurs where each
Chapter 18
Poker Variations
254
Chapter 18
player can bet, fold, or check. After all players have checked or three
raises have occurred, the players must show their cards; the player with
the highest hand wins the pot (all bets made). If only one player remains
(no showdown), he wins and his cards can remain unexposed.
One variation of Draw Poker that is commonly played is Draw Poker
Jacks or Better, where to open the first round of betting the player needs a
pair of jacks or better (a better ranking like three of a kind) to bet. This
lets the other players know the player has a hand with a pair of jacks or
better. If no player can bet (no hand has at least a pair of jacks), the cards
are reshuffled and a new round begins (ante and all). This variation can
make the pot quite large with antes and the bets of players with bad hands
who fold earlier.
Five Card Stud is a variation where each player receives their first card
face down (called the hole), the next three cards are dealt face up, and
the last card is dealt face down. The player to the left of the dealer
receives the first card. The player with the lowest first card must bet the
minimum. Some variations have all players at the start ante up (a small
bet). After all players have received their up cards (cards three and four), a
round of betting occurs. Then after the fifth card (a down card) has been
received by all players, the last round of betting occurs. In each betting
round after the first, the player with the highest-ranking hand showing
(only the up cards) starts the betting process. If only one player remains,
he wins the pot and his cards can remain unexposed. Otherwise, the
remaining players show all five cards and the player with the highest ranking hand wins the pot.
Seven Card Stud is a variation where the first two cards are dealt face
down (the hole) and the third card is dealt face up. On the first card up,
the player with the lowest up card must make the minimum bet. Each
player must either bet (raise), fold, or check. After the first round of betting, the player with the highest ranking hand of shown cards opens the
betting round. The cards four through six are dealt face up, and after all
players have received that rounds card, betting occurs. The last card (the
seventh card) is dealt face down unless in an eight-player game all eight
players remain, and then the last card is dealt as a community card (shared
by all players). If only one player remains, he wins (no showdown) and his
cards may be left unexposed. Otherwise, all remaining players must show
their cards, and the player with the highest-ranking hand wins the pot. If
more than one player has the highest-ranking hand, they split the pot or
the player with the highest suit wins. The suit order is usually spades (the
highest), hearts, diamonds, and clubs (the lowest).
Chicago Hi plays exactly like Seven Card Stud, except the player with
the highest spade in the hole splits the pot. The ace of spades is the
highest card. If the last card (seventh card) is a community card, it cannot
be used as a hole card.
Chicago Lo plays exactly like Seven Card Stud, except the player with
the lowest spade in the hole splits the pot. Players must decide whether
the ace of spaces is the lowest card or the two (deuce) of spades is the
lowest. If the last card (seventh card) is a community card, it cannot be
used as the hole card.
Over the last few years, Texas Hold Em and Omaha have become popular variations.
Many of the top poker players consider Texas Hold Em to be the most
challenging and sublime of all the poker games. Texas Hold Em is the
game played to determine the undisputed champion at the World Series of
Poker at Binions Horseshoe in downtown Las Vegas.
Texas Hold Em is a seven-card poker game where each player receives
two down cards and the remaining five cards are called community
cards, which are shared by all of the players. Each player must make his
best five-card poker hand using five out of the seven cards (his two cards
plus the five community cards). After the two down cards have been dealt
to all of the players, the player to the left of the dealer must make a small
blind bet. Then a round of betting occurs where each player must bet
(raise), fold, or check. Then five cards are placed face down in the center
as community cards. The middle three community cards (the flop) are
turned over (face up) and another round of betting occurs. Then the first
community card (the turn card) is flipped over (face up) and another betting round occurs. Finally, the fifth community card (the river) is turned
over (face up) and the final round of betting occurs.
If more than one player remains, the player with the highest ranking
hand wins the pot. Any combination of the players own two down cards
and the five community cards can be used to make the best five-card poker
hand. The pot is split if a tie occurs.
Omaha is a form of Texas Hold Em that is very popular in casinos and
on poker night. Omaha is a nine-card poker variation where each player
is dealt four down cards and the remaining five cards are dealt face down
as community cards (for all players to use). Each player must create the
best ranking poker hand by using two of his four cards plus three of the
five community cards (Omaha players often say Two from the hand, three
from the board). Just like in Texas Hold Em, after the first four cards are
dealt, the player to the left of the dealer must make a small blind bet.
Then the players must bet (raise), fold, or check. The middle three community cards are turned face up, and another round of betting occurs. The
first community card is flipped, and another round of betting occurs. The
last, fifth, community card is turned over, and the last round of betting
occurs. The players remaining show their cards, and the player with the
best ranking poker hand wins the pot.
255
Chapter 18
256
Chapter 18
VIP registration
VIP Register
The VIP registration screen has several required fields that must be
entered before proceeding to play the game, such as the players title (Mr.,
Mrs., or Ms.), the players first and last name (two separate entered
fields), and the players birthday (month and day as two digits). Optional
fields are the players address, city, state, and zip code (allow up to ten digits). CANCEL will clear all fields, and DONE will check the required
fields for completeness and validity (the birth date check will validate the
day based on the monthi.e., making 04/31 an invalid date). This screen
matches the previous products screen where there is a method for customers to register their product, sending the publisher their mailing
information contained on this screen. [This feature of downloading the
registration was not implemented by the publisher.]
The entry of Mr. and Mrs. or Ms. flags the return Welcome
verbal greeting of Nice to have you back, (Sir or Miss) and Play well,
(Sir or Miss), which adds a nice touch to the game (How did it know?).
The last player to play the game is the player that the game assumes is
playing. If not, the new or returning player must indicate so.
257
In the cashiers cage players can request additional funds when they are
below the highest floor allowed or minimum tournament entry fee.
If the player is only allowed on the first floor and his current chip
inventory is below $250, he can receive an additional credit of $2,500. The
credit is added to his current chip inventory and the credit is noted in his
casino record (see the Statistics Screen section).
If the player is only allowed on the first or second floors and his current
chip inventory is below $1,250, he can receive an additional credit of
$5,000. The credit is added to his current chip inventory and noted in his
casino record (see Statistics Screen).
If the player is allowed on all three floors and his current chip inventory
is below $5,000, he can receive an additional credit of $25,000. The credit
is added to his current chip inventory and the credit is noted in his casino
record (see Statistics Screen). Otherwise, the player is given a sound
bite of Your account balance is not low enough to receive additional
funds.
The cash area displays the players current chip inventory in dollars
and reputation points earned by participating in poker tournaments.
The birthday in this game will be utilized on the Prize Vault by giving
the birthday player a present (a birthday cake plus a $100 chip).
Chapter 18
258
Chapter 18
The Lobbies
There are three lobbies and a special level to play the World Champion in
a winner-takes-all poker battle.
The first floors motif is based on the Roman era with Roman Doric columns, wooden carved doors, and a mirrored ceiling reflecting the plush
Corinthian rug.
The second floor sends the player into the Orient where Ming vases shoot
out spirals of flames, lighting up the walls of famous works of art from the
Han dynasty. The floor is cushioned by a rare Oriental rug under a simplistic wooden ceiling.
The third floor transports the player to the edge of the Nile, where pharaohs once ruled and the players enjoy visions of authentic Egyptian
hieroglyphics, rare Egyptian doors from the throne of King Tutankamen,
and an exotic rug from the temple of Cleopatra. The symbol of Ra, god of
259
the sun appears as the wall torches flicker, adding to the illumination of
the magnificent array of constellations that shine through the high glass
ceiling.
If a player hasnt earned enough reputation points to enter the elevator
to the next floor, a security guard blocks the entrance to the elevator.
Chapter 18
Audio
260
Chapter 18
n Player input sound effects for actions such as a button press or a mouse
click
n Ambience (Background Music) for the other rooms on each floor such
as the Cashiers Cage, the Elevator (arriving and exiting sounds), the
Poker Room, the Tournament Room, the Prize Vault, and entering the
Slot Room
n In-game sounds for card flipping, chip click when thrown on the table,
chip rake when gathering your winnings, and a shuffle sound
n Music for winning a tournament and credits screen
Artwork
As a designer, your job (to the best of your knowledge) is to list all the
needed artwork and the vision you have of your game to the artists. But
they have to see the same vision you do. Since this is an internal design
document and not a product for sale, provide detailed photographs and pictures of your world from any source. Borrow from the Internet, scan
photos from books and magazines, and get on paper the closest visual to
what you are envisioning as possible.
Lobbies
General
Multiplayer button and Multiplayer Mouse Over
Next Level Congratulations
IconBChicagoHi
IconBChicagoLow
IconBOmaha
IconBTexasholdEm
261
Tournament
Floor
Level
Ante Min
Ante Max
Entry Fee
1
2
3
1
2
3
Next Floor
Points
100
100
100
1100
1100
1100
$20
$50
$250
$50
$250
$1,000
$50
$200
$1,000
$200
$1,000
$5,000
$1,000
$5,000
$25,000
$5,000
$25,000
$100,000
1100
$250
$1,000
$25,000
1100
$1,000
$5,000
$100,000
1100
$5,000
$20,000
$500,000
$20,000
$50,000
$2,500,000
VIP Points
(1st-4th)
15, 10, 5, 3
25, 20, 10, 5
35, 25, 15, 10
150, 100, 50, 30
250, 200, 100, 50
350, 250, 150,
100
1500,1000, 500,
300
2500, 2000,
1000, 500
3500, 2500,
1500, 1000
Chapter 18
Tournament Information
262
Chapter 18
First Floor
Lobby
RomanLobby
RomanBouncer
RomanBouncerText
RomanPrizeMO
RomanSlotsMO
RomanTournMO
263
Poker Room
Four Player
Roman Table
Roman Deal normal, mouse over, on click buttons
Roman Lobby normal, mouse over, on click buttons
Roman Stats Screen normal, mouse over, on click buttons
Profiles Turn On and Turn Off buttons
Profile Exit normal and mouse over button
Eight Player
Roman Table
Roman Deal normal, mouse over, on click buttons
Roman Lobby normal, mouse over, on click buttons
Roman Stats Screen normal, mouse over, on click buttons
Tournament Room
Four Player
Roman Table
Roman Deal normal, mouse over, on click buttons
Roman Lobby normal, mouse over, on click buttons
Roman Stats Screen normal, mouse over, on click buttons
Profiles Turn On and Turn Off buttons
Profile Exit normal and mouse over button
Lobby
OrientalLobby
OrientalBouncer
OrientalBouncerText
OrientalCashMO
Chapter 18
Second Floor
264
Chapter 18
OrientalElevUpMO
OrientalElevDownMO
OrientalExitMO
OrientalGrandMaster
OrientalGrandMasterMO
OrientalPokMO
OrientalPrizeMO
OrientalSlotsMO
OrientalTournMO
LeftPot
RightPot
(Programming note: Offset the two pots spiraling fire so they look more
natural.)
Poker Room
Four Player
Oriental Table
Oriental Deal normal, mouse over, on click buttons
Oriental Lobby normal, mouse over, on click buttons
Oriental Stats Screen normal, mouse over, on click buttons
Profiles Turn On and Turn Off buttons
Profile Exit normal and mouse over button
Eight Player
Oriental Table
Oriental Deal normal, mouse over, on click buttons
Oriental Lobby normal, mouse over, on click buttons
Oriental Stats Screen normal, mouse over, on click buttons
Tournament Room
Four Player
Oriental Table
Oriental Deal normal, mouse over, on click buttons
Oriental Lobby normal, mouse over, on click buttons
Oriental Stats Screen normal, mouse over, on click buttons
265
(Programming note: Offset the two torches flickering fire so they look
more natural.)
Four Player
Egyptian Table
Egyptian Deal normal, mouse over, on click buttons
Egyptian Lobby normal, mouse over, on click buttons
Egyptian Stats Screen normal, mouse over, on click buttons
Chapter 18
Poker Room
266
Chapter 18
267
Poses
Mouth Animations
Phonemes for each of Yvettes poses (ah, ee, eh, fv, mm,
oh, oo, pb, uh, and a smile)
Animated Eyes
For each of Yvettes poses, the eyes should blink, look mad, smile, and
open wide.
Sven
Profile
Mouth Animations
Chapter 18
Poses
268
Chapter 18
Phonemes for each of Svens poses (ah, ee, eh, fv, mm, oh,
oo, pb, and uh)
Animated Eyes
For each of Svens poses, the eyes should blink, look mad, and open
wide.
Hoyt
Profile
Poses
Mouth Animations
Phonemes for each of Hoyts poses (ah, ee, eh, fv, mm, oh,
oo, pb, uh, and a smile)
Animated Eyes
For each of Hoyts poses, the eyes should blink, look mad, half-open,
and open wide.
269
Poses
Mouth Animations
Phonemes for each of Melvis poses (ah, ee, eh, fv, mm,
oh, oo, pb, uh, a smile, and a sneerof course!)
Animated Eyes
Chapter 18
For each of Melvis poses, the eyes should blink, look mad, brow up,
left brow up, and right brow up.
270
Chapter 18
Jacqueline
Profile
Poses
Mouth Animations
Phonemes for each of Jacquelines poses (ah, ee, eh, fv, mm,
oh, oo, pb, uh, and a smile)
Animated Eyes
For each of Jacquelines poses, the eyes should blink, look mad, smile,
and open wide.
Mortimer
Profile
271
Poses
Mouth Animations
Phonemes for each of Mortimers poses (ah, ee, eh, mm, oh,
oo, sah, seh, smm, soh, and a smile)
Animated Eyes
For each of Mortimers poses, the eyes should blink, look mad, smile,
and open wide.
Third Floor: Egyptian Motif
Lizzie
Profile
Chapter 18
Poses
272
Chapter 18
Mouth Animations
Phonemes for each of Lizzies poses (ah, ee, eh, fv, mm,
oh, oo, pb, uh, and a smile)
Animated Eyes
For each of Lizzies poses, the eyes should blink, look mad, and open
wide.
Qiangsheng (aka Q)
Profile
Poses
Mouth Animations
For each of Qiangshengs poses, the eyes should blink, look mad, and
open wide.
273
Lou
Profile
Poses
Mouth Animations
Phonemes for each of Lous poses (ah, ee, eh, fv, mm, oh,
oo, pb, and uh)
Animated Eyes
For each of Lous poses, the eyes should blink and look mad.
Special Floor: World Championship Poker Room
Trevor
Chapter 18
Profile
274
Chapter 18
Poses
Mouth Animations
Phonemes for each of Trevors poses (ah, ee, eh, fv, mm,
oh, oo, and uh)the Worlds Best Poker Player doesnt smile!
Animated Eyes
For each of Trevors poses, the eyes should blink, look mad, and look
up.
Trevor has been beaten (Red Dress Dance)
TrevorEnd
Ending Background
275
Mouth Open/Closed
BethMO
CarolMO
CarverMO
CathyMO
CurlyMO
GeraldMC
HarryMO
Extra Animation
CarolWink
CurlyTiltHead
Chapter 18
Normal
Beth
Carol
Carver
Cathy
Curly
Gerald
Harry
276
Chapter 18
Normal
Hazel
Lakisha
Mark
Meredith
Mitch
Thomas
Eye Open/Closed
HazelEC
LakishaEC
MarkEC
MeredithEC
MitchEC
ThomasEC
Mouth Open/Closed
HazelMO
LakishaMO
MarkMO
MeredithMO
MitchMC
ThomasMO
Extra Animation
Cards
There are 52 cards (or one deck) in poker. There are four suits named
clubs, diamonds, hearts, and spades (alpha order) with rankings from a
two or deuce (low) to the ace (high). In a low game like Chicago Lo, the
ace can be the lowest card or the highest card or both.
All cards are placed in racks for the four- and eight-player poker games.
Most casinos use the reverse alpha order to break ties, meaning that
the best suit is a spade, followed by the hearts, diamonds, and clubs.
Whole Cards
The 52 card faces and the decorated back of the card are used as the community cards, cards shown in the middle of the table and used by all of
the players such as center cards in Texas Hold Em, Omaha, and other
variations if there are not enough cards left to play (Seven Card Stud with
eight players needs 56 cards so the last card must be a community card).
Discarded Cards
In Draw Poker, the player may discard his unwanted cards in order to
receive new replacement cards. The player clicks on the card (as a toggle
On/Off) to turn the clicked-on card gray, meaning to discard. Since the
game places the cards in a rack, the cards (all 52) need to be only half
drawn.
277
All 52 cards plus the back of the card, drawn half size since the cards are
placed in a rack, are mainly used as the top-right card without a shadow.
Fake Drop Round Cards
All 52 cards plus the back of the card, drawn half size since the cards are
placed in a rack, are mainly used as the discarded cards beneath another
card.
Fake Drop Shadow Cards
All 52 cards plus the back of the card, drawn half size since the cards are
placed in a rack, are mainly used as the cards beneath another card (not a
discarded card).
Cashier Cage
VIP Clipboard
VIP Clipboard (see Registration screen)
Numbers 0 through 9
Letters capital A through Z and lowercase a through z
Symbols dash and slash
Chapter 18
278
Chapter 18
Back of first name, Back of last name, Back of address, Back of city,
Back of state, Back of zip code, Back of birthday, Back of birth month
Cancel and Done on click buttons
Cashier Cage
Cashier Screen
Player Name Area
Cash Prestige Font
Lobby
Credits
Register
Additional Funds
Statistics
Ambient Sound
Character Comments
Credit Screen
Credits
Statistics Screen
279
Note: On chart, the Straight Flush (including a Royal Flush) and Flush will
mark the high card in the winning hand. The flush winning hands will be
indicated in the columns marked spades, hearts, diamonds, and clubs
(reverse alpha order). The chart numbers reflect the winning hands
from the currently registered players games (not just their winning
hands) from all play in either the Poker Room or the Tournament Room.
n Bookman Demi10 font numbers 0 through 9 (for chart)
n Bookman Demi14 font numbers 0 through 9 plus the $ and , (for
upper section)
n Bookman Demi24 font letters capital A through Z and lowercase a
through z (for players name)
The statistics are saved and can be cycled through for each of the poker
variations, such as Chicago Hi, Chicago Lo, Five Card Draw, Five Card
Draw Jacks or Better, Five Card Stud, Texas Hold Em, Omaha, and
Seven Card Stud.
n Close normal, mouse over, and on click buttons
n Left arrow normal and mouse over to scroll back through the poker
variations
n Right arrow normal and mouse over to scroll forward through the poker
variations.
Lobby on click and Lobby mouse over to exit back to the Lobby.
Stat Screen on click and Stat Screen mouse to view the Statistics
screen.
Chapter 18
280
Chapter 18
Chips
Chips are to be displayed for betting (click on a chip to bet that amount)
and placed on the table in three varying positions to look randomly
thrown.
Betting chips are to be valued from $1 to $5 million.
Table chips are to be valued from $1 to $5 million in three varying positions (one or two positions for the $50K to $5M chips).
281
Chapter 18
282
Chapter 18
283
Chapter 18
284
Chapter 18
Exit Game
n Yes mouse over and on click buttons (save players game settings)
n No mouse over and on click buttons
Betting/Raising
Clicking the left box for Open or Raise brings up the right box to enter the
amount.
Check
On click and mouse over buttons
Fold
On click and mouse over buttons
Open
On click and mouse over buttons
Call
On click and mouse over buttons
Raise
On click and mouse over buttons
Cancel
On click and mouse over buttons
LED Font
Numbers 0 through 9
Right Arrow On click and mouse over buttons
Left Arrow
On click and mouse over buttons
Chips
See Artwork: Chips to set Amount of Open or Raise Chips
values displayed are determined by the Min and Max
betting amount set by the poker game amounts selected
before entering the poker room.
285
Scriptwriting
For standard scripting format rules, see Chapter 14, The Basics of
Scriptwriting.
SVEN
(German stuff)
SVEN
Ill be back.
SVEN
I cant believe you dont play now.
SVEN
Better luck next time.
Chapter 18
[
3
4
6
]
[1234567890123456789012345678901234567890123456789012345678901234567890]
YVETTE
Wow! Good hand.
YVETTE
Oh, I like that.
YVETTE
Nice try.
YVETTE
Call.
YVETTE
I cant lose.
YVETTE
Check.
YVETTE
Now, thats a cute little card.
YVETTE
Did that feel good?
YVETTE
Fold.
YVETTE
Im in, way in.
YVETTE
Thats the card Im looking for.
YVETTE
Not good for me.
YVETTE
Oh, baby.
YVETTE
Pass.
YVETTE
Where did you pull that out of?
YVETTE
Show me yours and huh Ill show you mine.
YVETTE
I suppose.
YVETTE
Sweet!
YVETTE
That was too close for comfort.
YVETTE
I wouldnt pass this up for anything.
286
Chapter 18
SVEN
Call.
SVEN
I cant believe its not better.
SVEN
Check.
SVEN
My day will come.
SVEN
Fold!
SVEN
I fold now.
SVEN
(German stuff) Im in.
SVEN
Look at you, little girlie cards.
SVEN
Ha! Ha! Ha! (German stuff)
SVEN
I am triumphant!
SVEN
Im in.
SVEN
Im out.
SVEN
Im liking these cards.
SVEN
Your money will be mine now.
SVEN
I must raise now.
SVEN
Nice cards there.
SVEN
Pass.
SVEN
Raise.
SVEN
Oh, (German stuff Menee Guta)
SVEN
(German stuff)
SVEN
Sure, why not.
HOYT
Bah.
HOYT
Call.
HOYT
Check.
HOYT
Doh!
HOYT
Fold.
HOYT
You gotta know when to fold em.
HOYT
Good job, buddy!
287
HOYT
Hmmm!
HOYT
Im in the money! Im in the money!
HOYT
Im in.
HOYT
Im there.
HOYT
Later tator.
HOYT
Not me.
HOYT
On to you, pal.
HOYT
Shazam!
HOYT
Doh, I knew I should have run.
HOYT
Well, spank my ass and call me Shirley!
HOYT
You stayed in with that?
HOYT
This must be my lucky day.
HOYT
This pots mine!
HOYT
Well, why not.
MELVIS
Ahhh...Yah
MELVIS
MELVIS
Cant love these cards.
MELVIS
Ah... You cant treat the King like that.
MELVIS
Ah...Check baby!
MELVIS
Ah... Thats a hell of a clambake!
MELVIS
Foldin.
MELVIS
Im gonna call.
MELVIS
Aint nothin but a hound dog, baby.
MELVIS
Melvis has left the building!
MELVIS
Baby needs some blue suede shoes.
MELVIS
Ohh... nice hand there.
MELVIS
Oh mama!
MELVIS
Ouch, man!
Chapter 18
Baby!
288
Chapter 18
MELVIS
Uh! huh huh!
MELVIS
Uh thank ya. Thank ya very much!
MELVIS
Oooh, ya baby!
MELVIS
You betcha!
JACQUELINE
Oh, youll do better next time.
JACQUELINE
Check!
JACQUELINE
That pot was only chump change anyway.
JACQUELINE
Can we play yet?
JACQUELINE
My daddy told me I cant lose.
JACQUELINE
Daddy always said I could do it.
JACQUELINE
Hmmmmp!
JACQUELINE
I did it! I did it!
JACQUELINE
Sure, I have plenty.
JACQUELINE
Impressive!
JACQUELINE
Why wont you let me win?
JACQUELINE
Hmm...Pass.
JACQUELINE
Daddy, I need more money.
JACQUELINE
I must fold now.
JACQUELINE
Never too rich for my blood.
JACQUELINE
Oooo!
JACQUELINE
Ill see that and raise you.
JACQUELINE
You know what they say, the rich get richer.
JACQUELINE
Simply divine.
JACQUELINE
Sure, why not.
JACQUELINE
I want to win.
MORTIMER
Hee! Hee! Aint missing this opportunity.
Hee! Hee!
289
MORTIMER
(Chuckle)
LOU
I was actually nervous.
LOU
Call.
LOU
Hey, I cant win your money if we dont play.
LOU
Fold.
LOU
Get out while you still can.
LOU
Oh, give it a shot.
Chapter 18
MORTIMER
Eh...thats what Daddys talking about.
MORTIMER
Dont feel bad, its only money.
MORTIMER
In my day we ran from cards like this.
MORTIMER
But Im feelin frisky.
MORTIMER
Now thats a good return on investment.
MORTIMER
YeahSure. What have I got to lose?
MORTIMER
Horse hockey!
MORTIMER
This isnt worth a hill of beans.
MORTIMER
Im in.
MORTIMER
I shouldve invested less.
MORTIMER
There goes my kids inheritance.
MORTIMER
Im in for the long haul.
MORTIMER
Nice hand.
MORTIMER
In my day, we played with nickels.
And we were thankful for it.
MORTIMER
In my day, we never saw cards like these.
MORTIMER
Whoopee!
MORTIMER
Call.
MORTIMER
Check.
MORTIMER
Fold.
MORTIMER
Raise.
290
Chapter 18
LOU
Good cards, pal-ie.
LOU
Have fun spending my money.
LOU
Hell yeah!
LOU
Im in.
LOU
Bet on.
LOU
No more for me.
LOU
Not me.
LOU
Im out-ie.
LOU
Pass.
LOU
I cant possibly lose.
LOU
Raise.
LOU
Ill raise ya.
LOU
See ya!
LOU
Suckers!
LOU
Lets sweeten the pot.
LOU
You talkin to me?
LOU
What were you thinkin?
LOU
Check.
Q
Ha! Ha! Ha! I always win.
Q
I cannot beat that hand!
I could beat a weaker hand.
Q
Beginners luck.
Q
I do not believe in your bluff.
Q
Call.
Q
Ha ha ha! You cannot defeat me.
Q
Check.
Q
A cherry blossom knows when to fall.
I know when to get out.
Q
I do not want it.
291
LIZZIE
Bingo! Wait, wrong game.
LIZZIE
How do you feel, taking my bus fare?
LIZZIE
Guess Ill take the bus home.
LIZZIE
Check.
LIZZIE
Thats OK, sweetie, you deserve it.
LIZZIE
Fold.
LIZZIE
(Hiccup)
LIZZIE
See if you can keep up, sweetie.
LIZZIE
Im kicking butt and taking names.
LIZZIE
How did you like that?
LIZZIE
Macys, here I come!
LIZZIE
This is sweeter than a Mai Tai.
Chapter 18
Q
I will live to fight another day.
Q
Fold.
Q
Only a fool fights in a burning house.
Q
This pot is only half full.
Q
Im in.
Q
Your cards are like sand, no substance.
Q
Observe the lotus blossom, it needs no
timekeeping.
Q
Our money must experience more togetherness.
Q
Pass.
Q
How long does it take one to learn patience?
Q
Raise.
Q
For everything there is a season.
This is not mine.
Q
I will see what happens.
Q
This hand cannot help but spill gold.
Q
Victory belongs to the honorable.
292
Chapter 18
LIZZIE
Maybe next time.
LIZZIE
Nice win.
LIZZIE
Oh, well.
LIZZIE
Okay.
LIZZIE
Ill stay for one more card.
LIZZIE
Pass.
LIZZIE
Raise.
LIZZIE
Shame on you for pushing an old lady out.
LIZZIE
Wow! Squeaked that one out.
LIZZIE
How do you like that can of whup-ass?
LIZZIE
Too rich for my blood.
LIZZIE
Very nice.
LIZZIE
There goes my Wayne Newton ticket money.
LIZZIE
Yah! Why not?
TREVOR
Ahhh!
TREVOR
Hey, we dont have all day.
TREVOR
Bad luck.
TREVOR
Check.
TREVOR
Count me in.
TREVOR
That didnt turn out for me.
TREVOR
Fold.
TREVOR
Good deal.
TREVOR
You gotta pay to play.
TREVOR
Can you hang with me?
TREVOR
Hmm.
TREVOR
How did I miss that?
TREVOR
Sometimes, you need to know when to hold em.
TREVOR
Lets see what happens.
293
TREVOR
Ah, maybe next time.
TREVOR
Nice job.
TREVOR
Nice play.
TREVOR
Winning this hand is not my destiny.
TREVOR
Pass.
TREVOR
Raise.
TREVOR
Today is a good day.
TREVOR
Nice hand!
But if you actually beat me,
Ill put on a dress.
CASHIER
Your account balance is not low enough
to receive additional funds.
BOUNCER
Uhhhm, excuse me.
MANAGER
Welcome to Reel Deal Poker.
Please click the register button to continue.
MANAGER
Nice to have you back, sir!
MANAGER
Nice to have you back, miss!
MANAGER
Play well, sir!
MANAGER
Play well, miss!
Programming
Chapter 18
294
Chapter 18
For each character map (or associate), there are one to three phrases for
actions such as checking, raising, folding, calling, when they win
a pot, when they lose a pot (randomly select a character), when they
are bluffing (betting on an average hand), and taunting the player when a
minute has gone by without any input.
Basic Poker AI
The hand ranking is defined by a hand rank value, plus the highest card
value. The hand rank values are for a royal flush 180, a straight flush is
160, four of a kind is 140, a full house is 120, a flush is 100, a straight is 80,
three of a kind is 60, two pair is 40, a pair is 20, and a high card is 0.
All players are categorized as conservative or not conservative and
strong, average, and weak.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
On three cards of same rank found, set value to trip or full house and
return.
9. If one rank has a pair (two of the same rank), then we have at least
found the highest pair (set value to a pair).
If another rank has a pair, then we have a two pair hand (set value to
two pair).
On a pair found, value a two pair or pair value and return.
10. We have only a high card, so set the value to the highest card and
return.
295
3.
4.
5.
6.
In a high ante game, position one through three needs a pair of kings,
position four through six needs a pair of queens, and the remaining
positions need a pair of jacks to open betting.
Against strong players, dont call with less than two pair headed by
at least a king. In last positions, seven or dealer, you can call with two
pair.
Against weak to average players, you can raise with a pair of aces
or kings if you are alone with the opener and last in position.
Dont raise with opened straights or four flush cards, and only call
if the pot yields four times your bet.
Raise with trips (three of a kind) that are ten and below. Call with
jacks or better before the draw to force players out or keep them in
for the kill with the higher hands. Against strong players, you need
strong cards to raise when they open. Against weak players (i.e.,
players who open with jacks or queens under the gun), you can raise
aggressively when holding aces or kings.
Any player who checks during the first bet round can only call bets
thereafter in the first round.
In Draw Poker Jacks or Better, the computer will check each hand to see if
the hand passes the Jacks or Better test. If no player has this requirement,
each player must check and the hand is redealt (the ante up will
increase). If the player folds or tries to open and the requirement has
not been met by any player, the computer assumes a check. If the player
(non NPC), has a pair of kings and checks and no other player has met
the requirements, a new hand is dealt (the computer must not force the
player to make an opening bet). In Draw Poker, a minimum starting bet or
ante is made by each player before the first card is dealt. All cards are
dealt face down, starting with the player to the left of the dealer. A player
may discard up to three cards or four cards if they hold an ace (computer
checks this situation) and receive replacement cards. Discarded cards are
immediately reshuffled into the remaining deck after that player has
received cards so that a player will never get his discarded cards back. If a
player opens by betting or raises a bet, he cannot raise again, unless
another player has raised. In all poker games, a maximum of three raises
is allowed per betting session.
Chapter 18
2.
296
Chapter 18
4.
If you have no pair and not the highest hand showing and you are the
first bettor...
Conservative folds.
Nonconservative...
If betting round is three, then fold.
If betting round is one or two, then...
With ace bet maximum.
5.
297
Two pair (remember the first pair may signal this code, so check to
see if theres a two pair hand) then bet maximum.
Another player has bet and you have (a pair or better)...
A pair of aces or a better than a pair hand, then bet maximum.
Otherwise check.
Another player has raised and your pair is...
Less than the highest hand showing and you are a strong
player...
With queens or better then call.
Otherwise, fold.
6.
If you have a full house or better and raises made are less than three,
then raise maximum.
Otherwise, call.
Chapter 18
If the spade you have is within nine ranks of the highest spade not
showing, then check.
Otherwise, follow steps one through six.
298
Chapter 18
2.
3.
299
Chapter 18
4.
300
Chapter 18
6.
The player to the left of the dealer is forced to make a blind bet
(bet minimum).
Determine if you should stay with the first two cards (for Texas Hold
Em) or first four cards (for Omaha) in your hand.
301
You have a pair (remember in Texas Hold Em you can use one, two,
or none of your first two cards and in Omaha you must use two cards
of your first four cards.
If your pair for conservative is aces or for nonconservative is tens
or better, then bet or raise maximum.
If your pair for conservative is queens or kings for
nonconservative is sixes or better, then bet or raise medium.
If you have any pair, then bet minimum.
Otherwise, call or check.
For all remaining betting rounds, get the value of your hand.
Your hand is only a high card...
You are the first to bet so check.
You are not the first to bet...
Conservative players fold.
Nonconservative player call for the second and third betting
rounds and fold after the last community card is turned
over.
Your hand is a pair...
You are the first to bet so check.
You are not the first to bet...
A player has raised then...
If you have won the last two hands, then call.
Conservative players fold.
Nonconservative player call for the second and third betting rounds and fold after the last community card is
turned over.
A player has bet...
For the second and third betting rounds so call.
Fold after the last community card is turned over.
Players so far have checked and then you check.
Your hand is two pair...
You are the first to bet...
Conservative players check.
Nonconservative players bet medium.
You are not the first to bet...
No one has raised so call.
A raise has been made...
You are in the first three players from the dealer so fold.
Otherwise, call.
Chapter 18
3.
302
Chapter 18
303
Chapter 18
304
Chapter 18
305
community card, then it isnt a hole card. The winning hole card
doesnt have to be part of the winning hand.)
Using five of the seven cards, find the winning hand, or hands if tied.
Pay the winner(s) from the pot.
Update statistics.
Texas Hold Em
Deal two cards face down to each player (card one and two, aka the
hole).
Betting session or round...
A blind bet is made by the player left of the dealer.
A player cannot bet and raise himself consecutively.
Only three raises per betting session allowed.
Community cards two, three, and four (the flop) are dealt center table
face up.
Betting session or round...
Player to the left of the dealer bets first.
A player cannot bet and raise himself consecutively.
Only three raises per betting session allowed.
Community card one (the turn card) is dealt center table face up.
Betting session or round...
Player to the left of the dealer bets first.
A player cannot bet and raise himself consecutively.
Only three raises per betting session allowed.
Community card five (the river) is dealt center table face up.
Betting session or round...
Player to the left of the dealer bets first.
A player cannot bet and raise himself consecutively.
Omaha
Deal four cards face down to each player (the first four cards, aka the
hole).
Betting session or round.
A blind bet is made by the player left of the dealer.
A player cannot bet and raise himself consecutively.
Chapter 18
306
Chapter 18
Appendix A
Contact Information
Gaming News and Jobs
www.Gamasutra.com
www.GameDev.net
www.GigNews.com
www.Next-Generation.com
www.GDMag.com
www.FGOnline.com
www.Avault.com
www.ZDNet.com/Gamespot
www.Pcign.com
www.BluesNews.com
Gaming Conferences
Game Developers Conference
Extreme Game Developers Conference
E3 a.k.a. Electronic Entertainment Expo
www.GDConf.com
www.Xgames3D.com
www.e3expo.com
www.Interact.com
www.Smackjobs.com
www.Vsearch.com
(800) 571-0832
www.np-usa.com
www.iTracrecruiting.com
www.GameQuest.org
(831) 462-9800
www.mary-margaret.com
www.TACentertainment.com
307
308
Appendix A
www.TSCsearch.com
www.aardvarkswift.com
Gaming Schools
www.DigiPen.edu
www.FullSail.com
www.GameInstitute.com
3D Engines
Genesis 3D from Eclipse
Destiny3D
Quake Engines id Software
Torque Engine
Power Render 4 Engine
Wild Tangent Web Driver
LithTech Game Engine
Nocturne Engine
Serious Engine
NetImmerse 3D Game Engine
Unreal Engine
www.Genesis3d.com
www.destiny3d.com/pages/
engine.html
www.idSoftware.com/Business/
Home/Technology/
www.GarageGames.com
www.PowerRender.com
www.WildTangent.com
www.LithTech.com
www.TerminalReality.com
www.CroTeam.com
www.NDL.com
http://unreal.epicgames.com/
Art Packages
Adobe PhotoShop
JASC Paint Shop Pro
Equilibrium De Babelizer
Alias|Wavefront Maya
Softimage XSI
NewTek Lightwave 7.5
Discreet 3D Studio Max 5.0
Poser 4.0 by Curious Labs
www.adobe.com/products/
photoshop/main.html
www.JASC.com
www.Equilibrium.com
www.AliasWavefront.com
www.Softimage.com/products/
xsi/v2/default.asp
www.Newtek.com
www.Discreet.com/products/
3dsmax5/
www.CuriousLabs.com
www.Alienbrain.com
www.Merant.com/pvcs
www.Rational.com/Products/
Clearcase/
www.Starbase.com
www.Telelogic.com
Audio Tools
Cakewalk
Sonic Foundry
Awave Audio
Sound Ideas
Hollywood Edge
www.Cakewalk.com
www.sonicfoundry.com
www.fmjsoft.com
www.Sound-ideas.com
www.HollywoodEdge.com
309
Appendix A
Contact Information
Appendix B
An Interview with
Roger E. Pedersen
How did you get interested in computers and gaming?
In the 6th grade we played Avalon Hill games and Diplomacy for history. I
became addicted to war games and started subscribing to Strategy and Tactics and military magazines. I designed several war games (Global
Conquest, LunarCity, and The PentaLegions), and I correspondeded with
other game designers like Gary Gygax (who developed D&D) and a fellow
who had me game test Conquest, a chess-like 2-4 player game played on a
board or through the mail. I also started to become an avid chess player
(now ranked a USCF Chess Master).
The high school hooked up to a Texas Instruments mini-computer and
started a computer class. I was too young to take the classes (you had to
be in 10th grade), so I hung out in the computer room and taught myself
BASIC. A man (David Ahl, editor of Creative Computing, the nations #1
PC magazine in the 1970s) in Westchester County (one county over)
started having computer lectures and fairs once a month, which I attended
and prepared simulations and easy single-player games for that ran via a
yellow paper terminal (no monitors back then).
The interest in computers led me to teach the high school computer
course. The computer teacher was also a math teacher and taught computers through math solving so the principal asked me to teach real-world
computing (searching, sorting, simulations, games like Tic-Tac-Toe).
Throughout college I studied AI, game theory, database theory, and
worked for a mini (Nova Computers) company and was given a TI Silent
700 (terminal paper terminal connected to the Novas) in my dorm room.
Other students had 1-4K PCs that they assembled from Heathkit.
What made you decide to work in the game industry, especially
from its beginning?
In 1981 I bought myself an Apple 2 and Pascal and wrote a few simple
graphic games in 48K with eight colors. In 1983 I moved back to the New
York City area looking for a job. A headhunter (job recruiter or agent)
called me and asked if I wanted to work at home (part-time) programming
311
312
Appendix B
games for book publishers who wanted adventure games for the Apple as
a selling device (buy 40 books and get a game that relates to the subject
matter.) I did several games for Laidlaw, a division of Doubleday, where
the student could travel throughout the U.S. visiting state capitals,
throughout the world visiting famous cities and capitals, and visiting
Indian reservations and learning their customs.
Then I got a contract with CBS to rewrite the series Success with
Math which included Addition, Subtraction, Multiplication, Division, and Long Division on a Commodore Vic-20 and 64. CBS bought
me a Vic-20 and a Commodore 64 and gave me the Apple disks (no code).
In 1985 I met with a Florida game/toy company, Gametek, who wanted
to get into the computer game business. They had several hot TV show
and board game licenses. I formed Pedersen Systems Inc. and designed,
produced, co-programmed, and did the artwork, sound (music), and database for two games (three SKUs such as Apple 2, Commodore 64/128, and
IBM PC) a month. Candyland took four days to design and program a finished version for the three computers.
My co-partner Michael Hausman developed a toolbox (code routines
and a graphics converter for each machine), allowing us to make games in
IBM PC DOS, and upon finishing the code in Manx/Aztec C, the Commodore 64 and Apple versions only required a new compile into their
assembler code and running the graphics from the IBM PC through
Michaels converter. Go To the Head of the Class took us five days for
three versions (I had to type and update the 1,000 questions used in the
game). From there we put on the store shelves Press Your Luck, a TV
show, Chutes and Ladders, another Milton Bradley board game, from
Parker Brothers board game to the computer Sorry. Fisher Price games
Perfect Fit, I Can Remember, and Fun Flyer, which never shipped. Also
developed and never shipped were board games Trouble and Big Boggle.
In 1988 Michael and I ported Swimwear, a swimsuit calendar program
where you could customize calendars and select swimsuit-clad women to
represent each month for Hi-Tech Expressions from the IBM PC to the
Apple. The port and redesign of the printer graphics were done in four
weeks.
In 1989 we designed, programmed, did the sound and artwork for
PolarWare (Steve Green), and then bought out by Merit Software on the
Don Bluth film All Dogs Go To Heaven. The original (unfinished, part color
and part black and white) film was provided, and we created a storybook
with ten games that related to the film and its characters. The soundtrack
was digitized and played back through the PC speaker and the Sound
Blaster (this was the first game digital sound was used through these
devices). Both Michael and I programmed this title, and the magnificent
artwork was done by an upcoming computer graphics artist, Juan Sanchez
(his first title). The design, artwork, and programming took ten weeks for
the IBM version. The IBM PC code and graphics were easily ported to the
Amiga.
313
In 1992 at the CES show (pre-E3 days), I contracted with Dan Sejzer of
Villa Crespo Software to do design, programming, artwork, and sound for a
video poker game. Within four weeks, a prototype was finished and Dan
showed it to several distributors who wanted it ASAP. I moved to Chicago
to become director of development of Villa Crespo Software, initially a
three-person company. Within a year VCS had over 30 titles on the store
shelves and over a dozen employees. Developers in Europe and throughout the U.S. were working with us to sell their titles. My job was to work
with these developers, create internal projects, head up the QA group, and
work with marketing and manual writers. Titles that I developed and programmed were Stanford Wongs Video Poker and Flicks! Film Review
Library (both CES Innovations award winners), Dr. Wong Jacks+ (IBM
DOS, Windows), Combination Lock (IBM DOS), Casino Girls Video Poker
(IBM DOS), and Real Mother Goose (IBM DOS).
Titles that I managed were Amarillo Slims Dealers Choice, Rosemary
Wests House of Fortunes, Gold Sheet Pro Football Analyst, Games Magazine: Word Games, and the Coffee Break Series.
Titles that I managed and produced were The Coffee Break CD, Amarillo Slim 7 Card Stud (IBM DOS), Flicks! (IBM DOS), Hearts (IBM DOS),
and Casino Craps (IBM DOS).
I designed the gameplay for Rosemary Wests House of Fortunes and
Games Magazine: Word Games and created the concept of The Coffee
Break Series (all titles), which had great software (abridged versions of
VCS premium software and upgraded shareware titles) at budget prices
($13). VCS was the first publisher to enter this budget market with
brand-new titles.
I designed the packaging for Failsafe (a police officer) and Flicks! (a
large in-home TV).
From 1994 to 1995 I joined Merit Industries as manager of product
development for their videogame/arcade machine MegaTouch. I designed
and programmed numerous touch screen games on the IBM PC for the
Atari Jaguar (to be the brains and engine inside the arcade box). I redesigned the previous MegaTouch system and games written in a 16-color
mode to a 16-24-bit color system with stereo sound. I developed new
touch screen games and tested the games with nontechnical players for
addictiveness, ease of play, and understanding. At Merit Industries, I
Appendix B
314
Appendix B
learned that in the arcade market if the product isnt fun or addictive, the
player has only invested a quarter.
From August 1996 to May 1997, I became senior producer for Acclaim
Entertainment, later earning the role of executive producer and game
designer developing numerous titles on the PC and video game platforms.
As executive producer, I worked on titles with Ocean of America, such
as Cheesy (PSX), Break Point, Tennis (Saturn), Tunnel B1 (PSX, Saturn,
IBM DOS, WIN 95), and Project X2 (PSX, Saturn). I worked on the Fox
Interactive title Die Hard Trilogy (IBM DOS, Saturn). I worked on titles
with Taito such as Psychic Force (PSX) and Puzzle Bobble/Bust-A-Move 3
(PSX). I also worked on titles with Acclaim such as JLA (Justice League of
America) licensing liaison with Warner Brothers and DC Comics, Bloodshot (PSX, IBM DOS). I designed an original script based on the Acclaim
Comic character Bloodshot and his many enemies.
As senior producer, I worked on the original Shadowman (PSX, IBM
Win 95, N64). I managed over a dozen producers and associate producers
each with four to six titles (each title had several SKUs, such as
N(intendo)64, Win95, PSX, Sega, etc.) as well as produced numerous titles
as senior producer for the Sony PlayStation (PSX), the Sega Saturn,
Nintendo 64, and Windows 95. (Each title had a budget of $1-5 million.)
For Bloodshot and JLA, I documented and designed products preparing
an executive treatment, a design specification, and technical
specifications.
For Psychic Force, I localized the storyline for the U.S market, directed
voice-over talent and edited the VO DATs from a digital editor to Mac
audio format, directed in the motion capture studio for sample data for JLA
and Shadowman, reviewed potential products for Acclaim distribution from
outside developers and tested numerous products before turnover (Turok,
Forsaken, Space Jam, WWF Wrestling, and Magic: The Gathering),
selected QA staff to head and work on various projects, and met with
licensors Warner Brothers, DC Comics, and Acclaim Comics to discuss
game design and licensing matters such as character descriptions,
storylines, arch-enemies, three view artwork, acceptable design issues
(death or injury to a super hero). I mentored and gave suggestions to producers and game analysts in their design efforts and met as a technical
expert with various hot development teams/groups (like id off-shoots,
makers of Doom and Quake) for title/concept negotiations.
From 1994 to 2000 my pet project has been as PSI Productions (modern version of Pedersen Systems, Inc.) as a director, producer, designer,
and programmer of The Six Stones of Serena, an interactive fantasy
adventure. I wrote an interactive adventure/role-playing game (500 pages
with over 300 parts). Using a SONY BetaCam and Hi-8 Cameras, I shot
script (100 actors) during a four-week period. Using video editors
(Toaster, Grass Valley, AVID) and software, I edited and placed video on
a CD. I used various 3D art packages (Animated World Builder) for virtual
world. I designed and programmed an interactive scripting system
315
Appendix B
316
Appendix B
other data. If the user is shown believable scenarios, then the game and
the experience is more enjoyable.
What in your opinion makes a good game?
I look at games from the users point of view, often asking myself Is this
game worth $60? What features would help the user? My goal is X,
how can I get there easier, faster? For adventure games, the story must
be good. Sports games must be realistic. Puzzle games should be addictive
with the ability to play unlimited variations. As CPUs get faster and memory and storage becomes cheaper and more abundant, the stories can be
more elaborate. There should be more polygons, more actors on the CD,
better sound, and perhaps orchestrated soundtracks.
Why do you enjoy making games?
I enjoy the creation process, making something thats never existed that is
addictive, challenging, and fun to play. I enjoy watching someone play my
games. I enjoy hearing someone say they loved a game I worked on. I
enjoy reading reviews (all of them favorable so far... knock on wood or silicon) of games that I was a part of.
Lastly, with so many titles released each year, do you have any
advice for designers or programmers about distinguishing themselves from others to get a job in the industry? Or will demand be
too low?
Unless I work for a company full-time (and Im always looking) I contract
one to two titles per year (contact me at [email protected]). When
I started, a developer could be a lone wolf. Fortunately, I have been
teamed up with talented programmers, artists, and coworkers. Now a
game needs a dozen people to create it, which is fine as long as one person
has the clear vision. Newbies should join a game company at any salary,
design a game themselves or by using a standard development system to
show potential employers that they can really program or design a game to
completion. The Internet has opened up a venue for virtual gaming companies. You could design a game and get on Gamasutra.com (under
Contractors) to look for programmers and artists to help on a back-end
deal (work for free now and hopefully get a royalty later when the game is
selling). Or if you have programming talent and need artwork, you could
get on 3Dcafe.com and find help.
At a conference in 2000, I heard that in 1998 the film industry had revenues way above the gaming industry. Then in 1999 the two industries
were close in revenues, and in 2000 the gaming industry out-revenued
both the film and music industry combined.
Wow! Thats the place to be, and nows the time to be there!
Like film, books, and art, computer gaming is an art obtainable through
talent and hard work, as well as education.
Appendix C
E-mail: [email protected]
Phone U.S.: (800) 387-3030
Phone Int.: (905) 886-5000
Fax:
(905) 886-6800
Can I use Sound Ideas sound effects in my computer game?
Yes you can, provided that the sounds are embedded in the code of your
game and not available for an end-user to access or download. If your
application allows the end-user to access or download unsynchronized
sounds, you should contact Sound Ideas to arrange supplemental authorization for the use of the sound effects.
I am making a video game for release in retail stores. Can I use
your sound effects in it?
Yes you can. Synchronization of our sound effects in this manner is permitted under the terms and conditions of the Sound Ideas End User
License Agreement.
317
318
Appendix C
319
1001
1002
1003
1004
1005
1006
1007
1008
1009
1010
1011
1012
1013
1014
1015
1016
1017
1018
1019
1020
1021
1022
1023
1024
1025
1026
1027
1028
Airplanes
Animals
Airports, Archery, Applause, Automobiles
Automobiles
Baseball, Bells, Bicycles, Cameras, Clocks
Birds, Boxing, Buzzers
Children, Computers
Construction
Construction, Crashes, Crowds, Doors, Drawbridges
Crowds
Electronics, Earthquakes, Electricity, Elevators, Exercise
Explosions, Fairs, Farms, Football, Fire, Guns
Footsteps, Foreign Sounds, Gambling, Golf
Helicopters, Horns, Hockey, Glass Sounds
Household Sounds
Human Sounds, Jungles, Laboratory, Laughter, Logging
Indians, Industry
Naval Boats, Ships, Motorcycles
Military Battles, Guns, Harps
Musical and Percussion Instruments
Musical and Percussion Instruments
Office, Country Sounds, Parades
Pinball, Post Offices, Projectors, Pumps, Rodeos, Restaurants,
Roller Coasters
Service Stations, Sirens, Snowmobiles, Space Sounds
Stores, Swimming, Subways, Telephones
Rain, Thunder, Tennis, Taxis, Trains, Umbrellas, Vacuum
Cleaners, Vendors
Traffic, Trucks, Buses
Water, Whistles, Wind, Zippers
Appendix C
The Series 1000 SFX ($595) is on 28 CDs that contain over 3,000 sound
effects in a wide variety of categories.
320
Appendix C
2007
2008
2009
2010
2011
2012
2013
2014
2015
2016
2017
2018
2019
2020
2021
2022
XV-09
XV-10
XV-11
XV-12
XV-13
XV-14
XV-15
321
Appendix C
322
Appendix C
BBC 18
BBC 19
BBC 20
BBC 21
BBC 22
BBC 23
BBC 24
BBC 25
BBC 26
BBC 27
BBC 28
BBC 29
BBC 30
BBC 31
BBC 32
BBC 33
BBC 34
BBC 35
BBC 36
BBC 37
BBC 38
BBC 39
BBC 40
Bang!
Electronically Generated Sounds
Weather I
Weather II
Ships and Boats I
Ships and Boats II
America
Aircraft
China
Babies
Hospitals
Africa: The Human World
Africa: The Natural World
Equestrian Events
Greece
Adventure Sports
Livestock I
Livestock II
Farm Machinery
Horses I
Horses II and Dogs
Schools and Crowds
Spain
BBC 54
BBC 55
BBC 56
BBC 57
BBC 58
BBC 59
BBC 60
323
Appendix C
The International Sound Effects Library ($595) has more than 2,500 sound
effects on 28 CDs, more than 35 hours of recorded sound including Animals (three CDs), Business (two CDs), Civic (one CD), Domestic (one
CD), Entertainment (one CD), Gimmicks (one CD), Humans (five CDs),
Machinery (two CDs), Nature (one CD), Ranch (one CD), Sport (three
CDs), Transportation (six CDs), and War (one CD).
324
Appendix C
325
CD #1:
CD #2:
CD #3:
CD #4:
CD #5:
CD #6:
CD #7:
CD #8:
CD #9:
CD #10:
CD #11:
World Ambiences
Sounds From Nature
Special Environments
Impact FX
Voice FX
Emotional Voices
Music Tools
Subwoofer FX. Incredible low frequency effects, specifically
designed by Renaissance Sound Technologies or the LFE
channel in 5.1 production
Rhythmical Tools. Perfectly loopable electronic FX and acoustic rhythmical soundsthe loops include dramatic rhythm textures and are all recorded in a deep moving surround motion.
Dramatic String Textures. A full acoustical productionreal
immersive acoustic string performances, recorded with
Renaissance proprietary miking techniques for a real natural
being there sensation
Strings and Chords. Use this acoustic string and chord set to
create your surround sound tracksall tracks have been
recorded in natural RCE surround technique for maximum
compatibility with drama strings textures.
Appendix C
Renaissance SFX Library ($1,195) has Dolby Surround to deliver all four
channels of sound on 11 CDs that have sound effects of ambiences, isolated sounds, voices, and musical instruments.
326
Appendix C
7
8
9
10
Science Fiction #2
Supernatural
Transportation
Water
327
TCF 1
TCF 2
TCF 3
TCF 4
TCF 5
TCF 6
TCF 7
TCF 8
TCF 9
TCF 10
Appendix C
The 20th Century Fox Corporation SFX Library ($595) has ten CDs with
over 1,350 sound effects.
328
Appendix C
US03
US04
US05
Disney Ideas
The Disney Ideas ($99) single CD contains over 150 sound effects like
ambiences, animals, sports, transportation, machinery, cartoon sounds,
and special effects.
HB02
HB03
HB04
329
The Hanna-Barbera Lost Treasures collection ($99) has more than 350
effects on one CD.
HB05
Basketball, Bites, Cameras, Crashes, Crowds, Explosions,
Flame Throwers, Footsteps, Growls, Hits, Bulb Horns, Laughter, Magic, Pops, Rattles, Sci-Fi Sounds, Splats, Squeaks,
Cockpit Switches, Voices
Appendix C
330
Appendix C
WB04
WB05
8003
8004
331
8005
8006
8007
Air Blasts, Air Locks, Alarms, Ambiences, Animals and Creatures, Battles, Bells, Black Holes, Communications, Computers, Control Rooms, Crowds
Doors, Shields and Hydraulics, Dopplers, Drones, Electricity,
Electronic Pulses, Scrambles and Hits, Energy Bursts and
Transformers, Explosions, Flybys, Force Fields, Laser Guns
and Beams, Stun Guns, Electronic and Metal Hits, Laboratory
Sounds
Photon Bursts, Plasma Capsules, Power Sources, Robotics,
Rockets, Satellites, Scanners, Sensors, Servos, Space Pods,
Ships and Stations, Switches, Telemetry, Time Warps, Transporters, Vortexes, Weapons, Whooshes, Zips
Radioactive
Radioactive ($250) is on two CDs that contain 200 eerie wave forms, pans,
sweeps, phasers, communications, shimmers, bubbles, beeps, static, and
monsters and apparitions like Space Monster Screams, Phaser Morph,
Shimmering Space Bells, Ringing Soundscape, Space Ribbon with Whine,
Time Travel Reverb, Shuttle Craft Engine Room, Steady Bubble Gyro
Delay, Alien Tractor Beam Sequence, Evil Diablo Wave, Vortex Entry, Single Ray Gun Blast, Rumbling Wind Whoosh, Solar Wind and Waves,
Predatory Black Hole, Phaser Wave Boomerang, Electric Tubescape, Distorted Space Guitar, Fading Bubble Chirp, and Galactic Spacescape Hum.
Appendix C
Series 8000 Sci-Fi Warp 2 ($395) continues on three CDs with sound
effects.
332
Appendix C
333
Jurassic Dinosaurs
Jurassic Dinosaurs ($99) is a single CD.
Drone Archeology
Drone Archeology ($129) is on one CD that contains 99 stereo drones,
ranging from 32 to 64 seconds in length and has a 114-page accompanying
booklet.
Appendix C
334
Appendix C
PowerSurge 1
PowerSurge 1 ($250) is on two CDs containing electrical sparks, arcs and
zaps, crashes, smashes, hits and punches, large impacts, guns and helicopters, electronic beeps and buttons, telemetry and computers, a full range
of explosions, weather and natural disasters, and an entire galaxy of potent
sci-fi FX, ambiences, and alternate realities.
PowerSurge 2
PowerSurge 2 ($250) is on two CDs and has more of the sound effects that
PowerSurge 1 started.
Impact Effects
The Impact Effects ($129) CD contains 605 tracks with sound effects like
Arrow Impacts into Bodies and Wood, Auto Crashes and Explosions, Ball
Falls and Hits, Body Falls and Bone Breaks, Building Crashes and Ceiling
Cracks, Bullet Impacts into Bodies, Glass, Metal and Wood, Cabinet,
335
Drawer and Cardboard Crashes, Crashes and Auto Crash Test Dummies,
Debris Falls, Earthquakes, Soft Falls, Garbage Drops and Hits, Gas and
House Explosions, Glass Falls, Hits and Smashes, Dull, Heavy, Low and
Soft Hits, Human Hits, Junk Crashes, Knife Impacts into Bodies and
Wood, Mass Destruction, Metal Crashes, Falls and Hits, Meteor Crashes,
Plastic Crashes, Crumples, Falls, Hits and Spins, Rock Falls, Hits and
Smashes, Sack Drops and Hits, Subway Crashes, Sword Impacts, Wood
Breaks and Crashes, Falls and Hits
Thunder
Thunder ($250) is on two CDs of more than 100 thunder and rain effects.
CD #1 contains single claps, cracks, rumbles, rolling thunder, and lightning strikes. CD #2 offers a sky full of three-minute storm ambience
tracks, ranging from gentle rain showers to exploding thunder and fierce
hurricanes.
Appendix C
Power Pack from Digiffects ($250) is on five CDs with more than 1,000
pre-boosted effects.
336
Appendix C
FS-03:
FS-04:
FS-05:
FS-06:
FS-07:
FS-08:
FS-09:
FS-10:
Foley Footsteps
The Foley Footsteps CD ($99) is a comprehensive all-digital collection of
male and female footsteps, recorded on a variety of different surfaces and
at different walking speeds. Surfaces available include cement, wood,
grass, gravel, metal, and snow. Sounds of individual steps, paced steps,
shuffles, running, jumping, and climbing stairs are also included.
S11-04:
S11-05:
337
Emergency
Emergency ($250) is on two CDs containing more than 500 sound effects
like accident scenes, radio dispatches, alarms, sirens, crowds, and equipment sounds, Accidents and Rescues, Fires and Explosions, Ambulances,
Fire Engines and Life Saving Equipment, Police Chases and Hostage
Scenes, Police Cars, Equipment and Guns, Riot Scenes and Tear Gas,
SWAT Teams, and Forensic Crime Investigations.
Appendix C
338
Appendix C
Dynamic Range
Dynamic Range ($395) is on two CDs containing over 1,000 sound effects
like gun sounds and related effects, including interior and exterior shots,
bullet hits, ricochets, silencers and gun handling sounds. Interior shots
include revolvers, pistols, rifle, automatic weapons, and random fire. Exterior shots include revolvers, pistols, shotgun, assault rifles, automatic
weapons, random fire, and special weapons. Foley/Handling include
revolvers, pistols, rifles, shotguns, auto rifles, assault rifles, by effect
silencers, ricochets, bulletbys, and bullet hits.
The Works
The Works ($495) is on ten CDs containing 2,870 sound effects like pneumatics, buttons, switches, signals, levers, ratchets, gears, friction, stress,
servo motors, small motors, small mechanisms, electrical effects, compartments, doors, machines, motors and engines, a diverse collection of
backgrounds like interior work and manufacturing, packing, shipping, conveyors, exterior work, labor, industry, and constant tone environments.
WORKS 1
WORKS 2
WORKS 3
WORKS 4
WORKS 5
WORKS 6
WORKS 7
WORKS 8
WORKS 9
WORKS 10
Blow Tools
Blow Tools ($565) is on 12 CDs containing over 700 sound effects like
rushing, wailing, blustering, buffeting, groaning, rustling, droning, growling, shrieking and moaning, whistling, rumbling, whispering, sweeping
and swooshing, breezing, blowing, howling, gusting, and whooshing.
5008
5009
5010
5011
5012
5013
5014
5015
5016
5017
5018
5019
5020
5021
5022
5023
5024
Ford Mustang GT
Porsche 930 Turbo
Hot Rod
Alfa Romeo Spider
Jeep 4X4
Ford 3/4 Ton Pickup
Ford Van-Cargo Type
14' Box Truck-Ford
Mack, 18 Wheel (Cab and Wagon)
Greyhound Bus-MCI
1923 Ford Model T
1938 Chevrolet Coupe
1956 Chevy Belair
Jalopy
Various Surfaces and Miscellaneous Effects
Harley Davidson/Yamaha 250 Mini-Bike
Honda 750/Yamaha 80 Mini Bike
339
Appendix C
340
Appendix C
Speed
Speed ($250) is two CDs containing more than 165 sound effects like
idles, engine revs and shifting gears, single car passbys, passbys and races
between two or more cars, straightaways, curves, hairpin turns, dragster
burn outs, race, announcement and crowd ambiences, pit crew ambiences,
tire garage ambiences, and starting and finish line sounds. The vehicles
recorded are CART Indy Cars, Indy Lights Series Cars, Formula Atlantic
Series Cars, Vintage Formula One Cars, Offroad Desert Racers, Go Carts,
Dragsters, Funny Cars, Monster Trucks, NASCAR Stock Cars, World
Sports Car Series, GTS Series Cars, FIA GT Series, and Motorcycles
(several types).
JBA 02:
341
Wild World of Animals ($495) is on ten CDs that contain over 850 sound
effects like aquatic animals (sharks, whales, dolphins, walruses), wild animals (buffalo, alligators, elephants, snakes, tigers, pandas), birds and
insects, and domestic animals (cattle, goats, dogs, cats), plus an entire CD
of horses.
WWA01 Wild Animals
Buffalo, Camel, Elephant, Elk, Giraffe,
Impala, Moose, Panda, Rhino, Wildebeest,
Zebra
WWA02 Wild Animals II
Bear, Bobcat, Cougar, Leopard, Lion,
Ocelot, Panther, Tiger, Wildcat, Jackal,
Wolf
WWA03 Wild Animals III
Chimp, Gorilla, Monkey, Orangutan, Bat,
Rabbit, Agouti, Rat, Frog, Alligator,
Crocodile, Snake, Locust, Bee, Fly,
Mosquito
WWA04 Aquatic Animals I Dolphin, Sea Lion, Seal, Walrus, Shark,
Whale
WWA05 Aquatic Animals II Whales
WWA06 Birds I
Birds in Many Environments: Amazon,
Belize, North America
WWA07 Birds and Insects I Birds in Many Environments: Residential,
Rural, Africa; Crickets, Cicadas
WWA08 Birds and Insects II Marsh and Jungle Ambiences from Around
the World
WWA09 Domestic Animals I Cattle, Donkey, Goat, Pig, Sheep, Dog, Cat
WWA10 Horses I
Horses: Many Gaits on Various Surfaces
Audience Reactions I
Audience Reactions I ($250) is on two CDs containing more than 500 audience reactions in larger arena and sports stadium crowds and childrens
reactions.
AR-01:
Small- and Medium-Sized Studio Audiences, Large Stadium
Crowds, Applause, Standing Ovations, Cheers and Whistles,
Appendix C
342
Appendix C
AR-02:
Audience Reactions II
Audience Reactions II ($250) is on two CDs containing more than 500
sound effects like applause, cheering, anger and booing, laughter, screams,
and a full palette of vocal and emotional reactions from many different sets
of voices.
AR-03:
Medium-Sized Studio Audiences, Applause, Standing Ovation
and Re-Seating, Cheers and Whistles, Male and Female
Applause, Rhythmic Clapping in Unison, Applause and Cheers,
Surges of Applause, Rowdy Cheering, Surprise!, Hip, Hip,
Hooray!, Charge!, Go Team Go!, Sympathetic and
Disappointed Reactions, Excited and Disbelief Reactions,
Frightened, Panic and Horror Screams, Chanting Hell No, We
Wont Go, Laughter and Applause, Booing and Hissing and
Angry Yelling, Disgruntled and Riotous
AR-04:
Small-Sized Studio Audiences, Male Only and Female Only
Reactions, Studio Audience of Children, Booing and Hissing,
Angry Yelling, Cheers, Laughter, Laughter and Applause, Sympathetic Reactions, Male and Female Laughter and Applause,
Surprised Reactions, Shocked Gasps, Relief and Disappointed
Reactions, Disgusted Reactions, Hecklers and Shushes, Positive and Negative Reactions, Shocked and Surprised Reactions,
Happy New Year Countdown, Screams: Fear, Panic, and Adoration, Childrens Reactions, Chant Go Team Go and
De-Fence and Hip Hip Hooray
3003
3004
3005
3006
3007
3008
3009
3010
3011
3012
343
Appendix C
344
Appendix C
S10-05:
S10-06:
S10-07:
S10-08:
S10-09:
S10-10:
S10-11:
S10-12:
S10-13:
S10-14:
Barns
Foreign Ambiences From: Australia, Belgium, Bolivia, Brazil
Cities, Construction, Countrysides
Foreign Ambiences From: Brazil, China
Indoor and Outdoor Crowds, Forests
Foreign Ambiences From: Czech Republic, England
Harbors
Foreign Ambiences From: France, Germany, Guatemala,
Hawaii, Hungary
Industries and Foreign Ambiences From: India
Foreign Ambiences From: Italy, Luxembourg, Mexico,
Netherlands
New York AmbiencesAirport, Bank, Bar, Boat, Bus Terminal, Chinatown, City
New York AmbiencesCity, Construction, Crowds
New York AmbiencesHorse, Hotel, Library, Market, Office,
Park
New York AmbiencesPark, Restaurant, Store, Subway,
Traffic
New York AmbiencesTraffic, Train Station
Post Offices, Rain
Foreign Ambiences From: New Zealand, Pakistan, Philippines,
Poland
Residential, Restaurants, Room Tones, Schools, Traffic
Foreign Ambiences From: Russia, Switzerland, Thailand,
Turkey
Water Ambiences: Falls, Oceans, Rivers, Streams
Foreign Ambiences From: Turkey, Venezuela
345
E-mail:
Phone:
Fax:
[email protected]
(323) 603-3253
(323) 603-3298
3DSFX Series
The 3DSFX Series ($295) is a six-CD set.
CD 1:
Contains modern train sound effects (foreign and domestic),
including train station ambiences, clean and unique.
Appendix C
346
Appendix C
CD 2:
CD 3:
CD 4:
CD 5:
CD 6:
American Zeotrope
American Zeotrope ($495) is on seven CDs that contain hundreds of original vehicle and moving machine sounds, including Mustangs, Buicks,
Lincolns, Pontiacs, Impalas, Corvairs, Falcons, and the limited-production
Tucker car types such as limos, taxis, ambulances, emergency vehicles,
hot-rods, and muscle cars. Vehicle sounds were recorded on road surfaces
ranging from gravel, dirt, city streets, highway, and wet pavement at varying speeds: racing, slow driving, stalled, and steady. Isolated car sounds
are included such as wipers, doors, trunks, horns, tire peel-outs and
blow-outs. Other moving vehicle sounds include motorcycles, trucks,
trains, tugboats, ferries, subway cars, and related ambiences.
Animal Trax
Animal Trax ($495) is on ten CDs containing over 1,200 animal sounds like
lions, tigers, bears, leopard growls, hyena laughs, snake strikes, gorilla
grunts, baboon screams, and whale and dolphin calls. There are also
sounds from birds, snakes (rattlesnakes, vipers, python, boa, cobra), lizards, alligators, a toad, a frog, cats, dogs, a goat, a horse, a pig, a sheep,
primates (monkeys, gorilla, chimpanzee, baboon), an elk, cattle, bobcats, a
lynx, boars, ocelots, pumas, wild cats, pandas, raccoons, camels, coyotes,
wolves, bats, a hippopotamus, rhinos, sea lions, and a walrus.
347
Apocalypse Now ($395) is on five CDs containing sound effects like aircrafts, including Hueys, Loaches, and Phantoms. Vehicles: tanks, APCS,
Amtracs, PBR. Weaponry; M-16, M-60s, Russian SKS, Howitzers, mortars, napalm. Troop activity, backgrounds, walla, and foley.
Background Trax
Background Trax ($295) is on five CDs containing ambience sounds from
areas such as a computer room, a department store, a hallway, a police station, a restaurant, a school, a super market, Africa, a jungle, the wind, an
airport, from exteriors of cars, trains, trucks, on an elevator, at night, in
traffic, listening to the rain, a flowing river, a busy sink, waterfalls, and
waves.
Appendix C
Apocalypse Now
348
Appendix C
Disc 4:
Cartoon Trax
The Cartoon Trax ($395) is on five CDs with an optional (which can be
purchased separately for under $500) fully cross-referenced and indexed
guidebook for sound effects, like bees swarming, flies buzzing, bird caws,
animal sounds (bat, chicken, ducks, pigs, lamb, wolf, elephant, goat, horse,
donkey, dog, cat, frog, gopher, and squirrel), cow bells, fire bells, alarm
clocks, gong, Jews harp (boing), bubbles, twang, crashes and impacts,
explosions, water sounds, musical instruments (timpani drum, cymbal,
trumpet, sax, trombone, oboe, xylophone, guitar, accordion, and cello),
footsteps, nose blowing and sneezing, car horn, laughing, crying, kisses,
raspberries, grunts, knocking, pan hits, and motor sounds.
349
CityTrax
CitiTrax ($495) is on ten CDs containing hundreds of hours of full spectral
stereo recordings made on location, on DAT, that were pared down to the
finest ten hours of environment ever made. From the first disk, the sound
of the city jumps into your face with busy sidewalks. Two tracks later
there is a different version with the added dimension of footsteps. You can
almost tell the pedestrian is wearing a pair of Bass loafers from the clicking heels as he moves into perspective and then passes by on a track
thats almost three minutes long. The traffic roars by as horns honk. The
sound of jackhammers and a passing police car add to the full stereo spectrum, completing the aural illusion. The camera passes into the doorway
of a department store and the sound crossfades from urban noise to a
shopping mall interior.
Dynamic Range ($395) is on two CDs containing over 1,000 gun and
ammo sounds like gun blasts, ricochets, whistling bullets, hits on multiple
surfaces, silencers, interior and exterior shots, handling sounds, and more.
It features 30 different weapons, including pistols, shotguns, rifles, automatic fire, machine gunsthe works.
Eerie Edition 1
The Eerie Edition 1 ($295) is on three CDs containing spooky sounds like
human moans, heavy breathing, laughing, crying, chanting, pig squeals,
animal growls, scratching sounds, heartbeats, footsteps, wind, dry ice,
metal gates and chains, and wood creaking.
European Edition
Pinewood Studios, London, has always been regarded as the MGM of
Europe. European Edition ($595) is a 20-CD set.
Sound effects of rare European vehicles are available, spanning from
the turn of the century to the present day, from a horse-drawn carriage on
a cobblestone street to supersonic jets. The Hollywood Edge European
Appendix C
Dynamic Range
350
Appendix C
File Effects
File Effects ($495) is on ten CDs containing over 250 sounds, most of
which are in the three-minute duration range. Ambience sound effects
range from modern computer offices and train stations to footsteps and
squeaky wooden floors, Hong Kong harbor hooters, traffic, moaning wind,
and as you would expect, wonderful interior ambiences. The collection
categories include Skylines, Interiors and Exteriors, the Elements, Travel,
Transportation, and Industry. An airplane flying over at the wrong time, or
a car passing by when youve captured the perfect quiet spot for recording
bird calls can create a totally unusable end.
Disc 4:
Disc 5:
window breaking, and bulb shattering, this Foley disc will allow
you to sweeten everything from bar fights to huge explosions.
Experience the sounds of a medieval battle in the third of this
five CD set. From knife draws, sword clanks, wooshes, shield
impacts, and axe clashes to arrow whistles and flame sizzles,
shape your conflict with this extensive battle collection.
Fight to the finish with the fourth disc in the Foley collection.
Find the meatiest punch, the best body blow, the heaviest kick,
and the most gruesome cracks, crunches, stabs, breaks, and
falls to sweeten any conflict, from big brawl to minor scuffle.
Round out your Foley effects collection with a catch-all disc
direct from the Soundelux stages. From card games and coin
jingles, soft kisses and hard hugs, soda fizzles and beer gulps,
flag flaps and animal traps to leaves rustling, chains clanking,
jewelry jingling, and hand shaking, this potpourri of sounds
will surely round out your personal Foley library.
Futuritys Metropolis
Futuritys Metropolis ($99.95) is on one CD and contains various sci-fi
sound effects.
Historical Series
The Historical Series ($349) is on six CDs that include many of the
sounds that helped Soundelux (our parent company) win the Academy
Award for sound on the film Braveheart, directed by and starring Mel Gibson. Many of these sounds are directly from Braveheart.
Disc 1:
War: Horses, Armies, and Weapons. This CD includes Infantry,
Cavalry, Armies, and Horses that include up to 150 walking
and charging.
Appendix C
Disc 3:
351
352
Appendix C
Disc 2:
Disc 3:
Disc 4:
Disc 5:
Disc 6:
HPX Digital
HPX Digital ($795) is on ten CDs containing sound effects like ocean, seagulls, crickets, wind, rain, thunder, hurricane, large crowds cheering at
basketball and football games, busy intersection and highway, airplanes,
steamship, sci-fi, fishing, kitchen, bathroom, horror, train, building equipment and tools, shipping, office, war vehicles such as planes and tanks,
and weapons.
353
Metropolis II
Metropolis II ($129) is a single dynamic sound effects CD full of fresh and
original production elements, it features 99 tracks of audio wizardry ranging from the electronic whoosh to the giant cavern ambiance and
everything in between.
Appendix C
354
Appendix C
Sounds Of Speed
Sounds Of Speed ($695) is a 20-CD set that is far and away the most comprehensive collection of racing sound effects ever put together with
constants from the drivers perspective using microphones mounted on
actual boats, bikes, and cars, as well as NASCAR, CART Indy, Indy Lights,
Toyota Atlantic Racing, Formula 1, FIA GT Cars, World Sports GT Cars,
355
Star Trax
Star Trax consists of sound effects like trains, helicopters, ships, airports,
street, pedestrian, country road, motorcycles (Suzuki GS 1100 G and
Honda CX 500), diesel car, a Trabant 601 (an East German car), restaurant, escalator, German chatting, theater, hall, disco club, fish market,
Oktoberfest, German amusement park, road work, steel and wood doors,
steel gate, police car, and telephone rings.
The Works
The Works ($495) is on ten CDs containing 2,870 sound effects which
include the sounds of motion, action, and force like appliances, buttons,
switches, levers, ratchets, gears, pneumatics, friction, stress, servomotors, tiny mechanisms, compartments, doors, tape machines, engines,
and so much more. It also features work environments such as manufacturing plants, industrial machines, conveyors, shipping, packaging, and
construction work (interior and exterior).
Appendix C
356
Appendix C
Appendix D
CD-ROM Contents
Reel Deal Poker Challenge
Poker has never been so much fun on the PC. In Reel Deal Poker Challenge, you will be able to actually sit across the table from your opponents.
For the first time in gaming history, you have the chance to watch for
bluffs, watch highly animated character reactions to how you play, and be
able to better your skill and reputation as a poker player.
When you create a new player in Reel Deal Poker Challenge, you will
have no reputation and very little cash. As you play intense tournaments,
you have the chance to earn prize money and increase your reputation. As
your reputation increases, you will be invited to more prestigious poker
games in the Poker Palace.
As you advance to other floors in the palace, watch your characters
advance in skill and poker ability. As the stakes increase, you can win
incredible virtual prizes and trophies, kept in your own customizable prize
vault.
357
358
Appendix D
Do you have what it takes to make it to the top? Can you hang with the
intense tournament games? Can you win the grandest of prizes? Only
your own skill and intuition can decide.
Slots are also available in Reel Deal Poker Challenge. Order from
www.PhantomEFX.com.
CD-ROM Contents
359
Appendix D
360
Appendix D
Features
This program does so many different things.
n It can do conversions from about 200 audio-related file formats that it
can read (no kiddingyou read that right200 formats) into any of the
100 or so audio file formats that it can write. No other software even
comes close to such a wide format support.
n It can do quality conversion between the instruments formats most
common to PC synthesizer sound cards. Some examples: SB AWE32,
SB Live!, all Vortex II-based cards, TB Pinnacle, TB Maui, AVM Apex,
Gravis UltraSound, and UltraSound PnP.
n It can convert MIDI (and similar) song data between several formats
and package MIDI songs together with custom instruments in a single
file (e.g., you can convert MOD-tracker modules into MIDI-format
accompanied by custom instruments). Or why not convert melodies
between different mobile phone ring signal formats?
n It can read and write instrument formats for many commercial synthesizers and hardware modules, as well as many popular software synths,
including formats from Ensoniq, Akai, Korg, Kurzweil, Roland, Yamaha,
Native Instruments, Creamware, and many more.
n It can send or receive waveforms to professional synthesizers using
standard SDS transfers over MIDI or really fast SMDI transfers over
SCSI.
n A Batch Conversion Wizard makes converting large numbers of audio
files extremely simple (and with optional effects processing).
n The Audio Processing Wizard lets you accomplish many common editing tasks, like resampling, fading, cutting and pasting, merging and
combining waveforms, and more. DirectShow audio effect filters (aka
DirectX plug-ins) are also supported, opening up a whole world of
third-party effect processing modules. It can work on multiple waveforms at once just as easily as on a single.
n A nice example of a use for the Audio Processing Wizard is the
cross-fade loop function. Using this, you no longer have to search in
vain for that elusive optimal loop point. Just select a likely portion of
the waveform and cross-fade it and voilyou have a good-sounding
loop.
n The Instrument Processing Wizard helps you in many ways to avoid
having to manually do repetitive editing tasks on multiple instruments.
The MIDI Processing Wizard gives you tools for doing things like
transposing notes or changing the tick rate.
361
Appendix D
CD-ROM Contents
362
Appendix D
n It usually does a better job by converting more paramaters and translating them more accurately.
n It has a competitive price.
Of course, all other programs are not bad, but the amount of parameters
supported and converted do vary somewhat from file format to file format.
So if you are unsure, download the 30-day free trial version from the web
site and compare for yourself. With this you can try almost all functionality. But there are certain limitations; as an example, you can try out SMDI
transfers by sending from a synth to the program but not the other way
around. You can save to all supported file formats, but you can only save
once before having to restart the program. While you can save individual
instruments, you cant save a whole loaded bank of instruments. Limiting
and frustrating when doing some real work for sure, it should be enough
to try the quality of conversions fully. It is, after all, a trial version and 30
days of free full use.
Import Formats
Awave Studio can Read (R) and/or Write (W) the following file formats:
Ext.
R/W
Format
669
R
669 tracker module
AIFC
R
Compressed audio interchange file format
AIFF
R+W
Audio interchange file format
AIS
AKP
ALAW
AMS
AMS
APEX
ARL
ASE
AU
AVI
AVR
C01
CDR
DCM
DEWF
R
R+W
R+W
R
R
R+W
R+W
R
R+W
R
R
R
R
R
R
DIG
DIG
DLP
DLS
DLS
DMF
DSF
DSM
DSS
DTM
DWD
EDA
EDE
EDK
EDQ
EDS
EDV
EFA
EFE
R
R
R
R+W
R+W
R
R
R
R@
R
R+W
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R+W
EFK
EFQ
EFS
EFV
EMB
EMD
EMY
ESPS
EUI
F2R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R+W
R
R
R
363
Appendix D
CD-ROM Contents
364
Appendix D
F3R
F32
F64
FAR
FFF
FNK
FSM
FZB
FZF
FZV
G721
G723
G726
R
R
R
R
R+W
R
R
R+W
R+W
R+W
R+W
R+W
R+W
GDM
GI!
GIG
GKH
GSM
GSM
GSM
R
R
R+W
R
R+W
R+W
R+W
GSM
R+W
HCOM
IFF
IMY
INI
INI
INRS
INS
INS
INS
INS
IST
IT
ITI
ITS
K25
K26
KIT
KFT
KMP
KMP
KR1
KRZ
R
R+W
R+W
R
R+W
R
W
R
R+W
R+W
R
R
R+W
R+W
R
R
R+W
R
R+W
R+W
R
R+W
KSC
KSC
KSF
KSF
MAP
MAT
MAUD
MDL
MED
MID
MLD
R+W
R+W
R+W
R+W
R+W
R+W
R
R
R
R+W
R
MLS
MMF
R
R
MOD
MOV
MP1
MP2
MP3
MPA
MPEG
MPG
MSS
MTM
MUS
MUS10
MWS
NIST
NVF
O01
OGG
OKT
P
P
PAC
PAF
PAT
PBF
PCG
PCG
PCM
PGM
PGM
PLM
PLS
PRG
R
R
R
R+W %
R+W *
R
R
R
R+W
R
R
R
W
R
R+W
R
R+W !
R
R+W
R+W
R
R+W
R+W
R+W
R+W
R+W
R
R+W
R+W
R
R
R+W
365
Appendix D
CD-ROM Contents
366
Appendix D
PSB
PSION
PSM
PTM
RA
RAW
RIF
RMI
Rockwell
S
S
S3I
S3M
SAM
SB
SBK
SD
SC2
SD2
SD2
SDK
SDS
SDW
SDX
R
R
R
R
W#
R
R
R+W
R+W
R+W
R+W
R+W
R
R
R+W
R+W
R+W
R
R+W
R+W
R
R+W
R
R
SEQ
SF
SF2
SFARK
SFD
SFI
SFR
SMD
SMP
SMP
SMP
SND
SND
SNDR
SNDT
SOU
SPD
SPL
SPPACK
STM
STS
SVX
R+W
R+W
R+W
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R+W
R
R+W
R
R
R
R
R
R+W
R
R+W
R
SW
SYW
TXT
TXT
TXT
TXW
UB
UDW
ULAW
ULT
UNI
UW
UWF
V8
VAB
VAG
VAP
VOC
VOX
VOX
VSB
W??
W??
W64
WAV
WA!
WFB
R+W
R+W
W
R+W
R+W
R+W
R+W
R
R+W
R
R
R+W
R
R
R+W
R+W
R+W
R+W
R+W
R
R+W
R+W
R+W
R+W
R+W
R+W
R+W
WFD
R+W
WFP
R+W
WMA
XI
XM
XMI
R+W =
R+W
R
R+W
*R
367
Appendix D
CD-ROM Contents
368
Appendix D
Features
n The only image viewer you should need for browsing images
n Small, very fast, highly tuned code with MMX support
n Optimized display in all video modesno compromises in image
quality
n A very sparse but powerful and helpful user interface
n Nothing unnecessarily taking up space on your desktop
n Supports all of the more common image file formats
n Rotate, mirror, zoom, pan, and adjust contrast, brightness, sharpness,
hue, saturation, and more
n Full screen display when the window is maximized
n Index feature with fast image thumbnail creation (disk caching optional)
n Does not attempt to be any half-baked semi-editor or file format
converter
n Integrates well with Any Image software for advanced conversion
capabilities
n Smart background preloading and caching of images
n Includes a simple slide show scripting languageroll your own
presentations
n Run maximized, auto shrink, auto size, close all, and other
unique options
n Image Eye can read many image file formats.
Image Eye support can be reached at [email protected].
File Formats
Image Eye can read all of these file formats:
BMP, DIB, RLE
Microsoft Windows/IBM OS/2 (device
independent) bitmap
CAL, CALS, RAS
Computer aided acquisition and logistics support
format
ICO, CUR
Microsoft Windows icon/cursor
CD-ROM Contents
369
Any Image is not an image editor or an image viewer. It is a tool that helps
you quickly and easily do high quality conversions between common
image file formats. Converting a single image is as easy as converting a
huge number of images.
Features
n
n
n
n
n
n
n
n
n
Appendix D
370
Appendix D
File Formats
Any Image can read (R) and/or write (W) the following graphics file
formats:
BMP, DIB, RLE
CAL, CALS, RAS
R+W
R
ICO, CUR
IFF, LBM, BBM
FIF
FIT, FITS
GIF
R
R
R
R+W
R+W
R+W
MAC
NEO
PCX
PIC
PNG
PSD
PXR
RAS, SUN
RAW
PBM, PGM, PPM
R
R
R+W
R
R+W
R+W
R
R+W
R+W
R
TGA
TIF, TIFF
R+W
R+W
Features
Awave Audio is a dedicated audio file format batch converter.
n Do conversions from about 60 audio file formats that it can read into
any of the 30 or so audio file formats that it writes.
n A three-step procedure makes converting large numbers of audio files
both fast and simple.
n Handle very large files without using up your memory. *
n Handle audiophile-quality audio formats and 24-bit 192KHz multichannel audio. Internal sample precision is 32-bit floating point. For
CD-ROM Contents
371
improved sound quality, noise dithering is used when decreasing sample bit-depths (e.g., when going from 24- to 16-bit). *
n You can do optional effects processing using up to four DirectShow
effect filters (aka DirectX plug-ins, also used by many other professional audio software), as well as built-in functions such as resampling
and silence removal.
n Bonus feature: The Audio Recording Wizard easily lets you make new
recordings.
n Bonus feature: Read audio CD tracks (requirements: MMC2-compatible CD/DVD-ROM + ASPI32 drivers). *
* These are features that are not available with big brother Awave Studio, which
does do a great many things (e.g., handling synthesizer instruments, collections, midi,
editing, etc.) that Awave Audio wont do.
File Formats
Ext
AIFC
AIFF
ALAW
AU
AVI
AVR
CDA
CDR
DIG
DIG
DSS
DWD
ESPS
F32
F64
G721
G723
R/W
R
R+W
R+W
RW
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R+W
R
R+W
R+W
R+W
R+W
G726
R+W
GSM
GSM
GSM
R+W
R+W
R+W
GSM
R+W
Type
Compressed audio interchange file format
Audio interchange file format
Raw CCITT/ITU G.711 A-law format audio
Sun/NeXT/DEC audio file
MS audio video interleave file
Audio Visual Research sound file
Audio CD track
Raw audio-CD data
Digilink format
Sound Designer I audio file
Olympus DSS file %
DiamondWare digitized file
ESPS audio files
Raw 32-bit IEEE floating point values
Raw 64-bit IEEE floating point values
Raw CCITT/ITU G.721 4-bit ADPCM format data
Raw CCITT/ITU G.723 3- or 5-bit ADPCM format
data
Raw CCITT/ITU G.726 2-, 3-, 4-, or 5-bit ADPCM
format data
Raw GSM 6.10 audio stream
Raw byte aligned GSM 6.10 audio stream
US Robotics voice modems GSM w.o. header/
VoiceGuide/RapidComm
US Robotics voice modems GSM w. header/
QuickLink
Appendix D
Awave Audio can read (R) and write (W) many formats.
372
Appendix D
IFF
INRS
MAT
MOV
MP1
MP2
MP3
MPA
MPEG
MPG
NIST
NVF
OGG
PAF
PSION
RA
RAW
RIF
SAM
SB
SD
SD2
SD2
SDW
SF
SFR
SMP
SND
SNDR
SNDT
SPD
SPPACK
SVX
SW
TXT
TXT
UB
UDW
ULAW
UW
V8
VAG
VAP
VOC
VOC
VOX
R+W
R
R+W
R
R
R+W
R+W *
R
R
R
R
R+W
R+W
R+W
R
W#
R+W
R+W
R
R+W
R+W
R+W
R+W
R+W
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R+W
R
R+W
R+W
W
R+W
R+W
R+W
R+W
R
R+W
R+W
R+W
R+W
R+W
CD-ROM Contents
WAV
WAV
WMA
R+W
R+W
R+W =
373
Appendix D
Index
20th Century Fox, 215, 230, 327
3DO, 86-87, 91-93
3DS Max, 113-114
A
A * (A-star) pathfinding, 193-197
Acclaim Entertainment, 11, 86-87, 94-96
ACID PRO, 225-226
action game, 19-20, 70
Adobe Photoshop, 103-104, 108, 113, 369
ADR (Automated Dialogue Replacement),
200, 247
adventure game, 5, 16, 19, 20-21, 23-24
Alias|Wavefront Maya, 103, 106-108, 117,
174, 176, 179, 181, 187-188
Alice in Wonderland, 203-205
Alice in Planet Wonderland, 206-211
alienbrain, 116-118
All Dogs Go To Heaven, 9
Amiga, 9
Any Image, 369-370
Apollo 13, 27
AppleScript, 104
arcade game, 7
artificial intelligence (AI), 22, 29, 70, 110,
133, 154-157, 183, 191-197, 235, 247,
251, 294-302, 311
artist, 2, 4, 6
Atari 520ST, 9
audio engineer, 2, 4, 6
authors, 35
Avid Technology, 107-109
Awave Audio, 371-373
Awave Studio, 227-229, 359-367
B
baseball, 5, 28, 83-96
BASIC, 104, 130-132, 311
Batman Forever, 11
C
Cakewalk, 217-223
Capstone, 13
Carrey, Jim, 11
Carroll, Lewis, 203
casual games, 21-23
chess, 16, 21
Clancy, Tom, 64, 71, 77, 82
ClearCase, 118-119
close quarter battle (CQB), 67, 76, 78, 81
CM Synergy, 119
Code Warrior, 117, 170
Combination Lock, 10
copyright, 51-52
CorelDRAW, 104-105
Crawford, Chris, 13
Criterion Software, 180-186
Cro-Magnon man, 57-59
CroTeam, 178
Curious Labs, 114-116
D
dance, 36
DAT (Digital Audio Tape), 216, 314, 349
Debabelizer, 105-106
Deer Hunter, 56-57
Delphi, 166, 170
design bible, 3, 247
design specification, 3
digital recording, 216, 336, 361
DirectX, 129, 174
Discreet, 113-114
Disney, 215, 328
375
Index
E
Eclipse Entertainment, 166
educational games, 19, 23-24
Egerter Software, 169-171
Eidos Interactive, 12
Electronic Arts (EA) Sports, 86-87, 89-93
Epic Games, 178-179
F
first-person shooter (FPS), 12, 19, 55-56,
69, 97, 122
First Row Software, 12
FIFO, 133
film, 5, 9, 11, 15, 37-49, 100
film script format,
linear, 200-202
non-linear, 210-211
Flicks: Film Review Library, 6, 126, 313
fog effect, 26, 72-73, 108, 169, 174,
187-188
Foley, 200, 230, 247, 335-336, 338, 347,
350-351, 354
football, 28, 32, 83
G
gambling game, 5, 21-22, 33
game engines, 165
GarageGames, 167-169
General Mills, 84-85
Genesis 3D, 166-167
Geomnastics, 24
golf, 26, 28, 32
H
Hanks, Tom, 36
Hanna Barbera, 215, 230
Hawkins, Trip, 86, 91
history, 34
Hollywood Edge, 231-232
Home Studio, 220
Home Studio XL, 221
Homo erectus, 57-59
Honeymooners, The, 12
Hughes, John, 231
hybrids, 19, 20
376
I
id Software, 12, 171, 189
Image Eye, 368-369
instrument, 36
Intercorp, 13
Intergalactic Council, 55
Internet, 25, 53-54, 55, 75, 171-173, 233,
252
Interplay, 87-88
inverse kinetics (IK), 112
J
JavaScript, 104, 171-173, 175, 216
Jetsons, The, 14
Jones, Tommy Lee, 11
K
Keaton, Michael, 11
Kennedy, John F., 64
L
Lapine, James, 35
Level of Detail (LOD), 165, 167, 175,
177-178, 188
licensed property, 8-9, 11-12, 14, 22, 24,
89, 98, 216, 237, 245, 312
LIFO, 133
LightWave, 110-112
Linux, 107, 112, 129, 168, 179, 189, 252
LIPFX Mimic, 116
LIPSinc Mimic, 116
literature, 35
LithTech, 176-177
looping, 200
Lost Kingdoms, 55-56
LucasFilm, 215, 230, 327
M
MacIntosh, 106, 110, 115, 117, 168, 177,
179, 189, 217, 221-223, 314, 320
Marx, Groucho, 12
Mathathon, 24
Maya Complete, 106-107
Maya Personal Learning Edition, 106-107
Maya Unlimited, 106-107
Medical Kombat, 100-101
Merant, 118
mesh, 82, 108, 109, 114, 166
Metro 5, 221-223
Index
N
Navy SEAL
games, 68-83
history and background, 64-68
Neanderthal, 57-59
NetImmerse 3D, 186-189
NewTek, 110-112
Nintendo Gameboy, 86-87, 101
Nintendo GameCube, 52, 86-87, 97, 99,
101, 179, 180, 181, 186, 187, 238
Nocturne Engine, 177
non-player character (NPC), 79, 183, 191,
202, 235, 295, 302
Non-Uniform Rational B-Spline (NURB),
106-108, 114
Numeric Design, 186-189
NXN Software, 116-118
O
OHara, Mark, 166
one pager, 97-98
examples, 98-101
OpenGL, 106, 113, 129, 168
Othello, 15, 21, 33, 133
P
Paint Shop Pro, 104
pathfinding, 193-197
Patton Strikes Back, 13
Pedersen, Megan, 98-99
Pedersen, Roger E., 2, 3-10, 12, 51, 52,
201, 205, 208, 248, 311-316
PC (personal computer), 9, 52, 129
pixel shading, 167, 169, 176, 181
platform games, 19
pointillism, 35
poker, 22-23, 33-34, 60-63, 193, 247-306,
313, 357-358
Poser, 114-116
Potentially Visible Set (PVS), 166, 169,
181, 186
POV (point of view), 19, 28-29, 53, 71, 78,
90, 92, 99-100, 122, 126, 165
Power Render 4, 169-171
producer, 3-8
programmer, 1, 2, 4, 6
Pryor, Richard, 15
puzzle, 1, 5, 16, 19, 20-21, 30, 199, 314,
316
PVCS, 118
Q
Q3Radiant, 189
QA (Quality Assurance) tester, 4, 6, 11,
233, 313-314
Quake, 19, 78, 103, 167, 314
Quake 2 Engine, 12, 171
Quake 3 Engine, 12, 110, 167, 189
queue, 132
R
rail games, 19
Rational Software, 118-119
RenderWare, 180-186
role-playing game (RPG), 5, 16, 19, 23,
25, 36, 55, 56, 121, 189, 193
Romero, John, 12
S
scheduling, 7, 211-213
science, 34
377
Index
378
T
Telelogic, 119
Terminal Reality, 177
texture, 165, 181, 188
Tic-Tac-Toe, 134-164
Todd/Soundelux Studios, 231
Tolkien, 20
Torque Engine, 167-169
twitch games, 19, 238, 245
Two Heads game, 54
U
Universal Studios, 215, 230, 327-328
UnrealEd, 179
Unreal Engine, 82, 103, 110, 167, 178-179
V
Vegas Video, 227
vertex shading, 114, 169, 176, 181
Villa Crespo Software, 6, 10, 247, 313
Voltaire, 237, 238
W
Walker Boy Studio, 122
War Between the States, 122-125
Warner Brothers, 215, 230, 314, 329
WAV files, 218, 220, 229
Web Driver, 171-175
WildTangent, 166-167, 171-175
Windows 2000, 129
Windows 95, 74, 106, 115
Windows 98, 129
Windows CE, 129
Windows NT, 129
Windows XP, 129
World-Wide Reporter, 23
About the CD
The companion CD includes source code for the tic-tac-toe game discussed in the book, several audio and image applications, and a chapter on
game ideas.
These are organized in the following folders:
n FMJSoftThe applications in this folder are Awave Studio v8.5, Image
Eye v6.0, AnyImage v2.5, and Awave Audio v7.6. These audio and
image tools are helpful in converting and viewing files of various types.
For more information about these tools, see Appendix D.
n PhantomEFXThe Reel Deal Poker Demo is located in this folder.
Simply double-click on the setup.exe file to install. For more information about the Reel Deal Poker Demo, see Appendix D.
n WordwareThis folder includes the code and other files needed for the
tic-tac-toe game presented in Chapter 11, along with an expanded version of Chapter 6, Game Ideas, in PDF format. You will need Adobe
Acrobat Reader, which is available for download at
http://www.adobe.com/products/acrobat/readermain.html, to read this
file.
The CD contents can be accessed using Windows Explorer.
8 Caution:
By opening the CD package, you accept the terms and conditions of the CD/Source Code Usage License Agreement.
Additionally, opening the CD package makes this book nonreturnable.
8 Warning:
Game Design
Foundations
Chapter 6
Game Ideas
At this stage, you understand the gaming genres and have an eagerness to
become a game designer. You may now think that you still dont have a
clear vision of a game concept.
Well, you can always creatively borrow ideas from other sources and
tailor them to your liking. Sources that are great to borrow from are
books, movies, history, sports and everyday life itself.
If ideas are truly worth a dime a dozen, then Happy Birthday, heres
over $10 worth of ideas (1,200 plus) for you to use as the basis for a game
design concept.
Sports
1 Archery
Archery is a sport in which the participant uses a bow to shoot arrows at a
target that has ten concentric circles. The score of each arrow depends
upon where it lands on the target. The highest score, a ten, is achieved by
shooting an arrow into the center, or bulls-eye. Scores go down to nine
for the next circle and out to one for the outermost circle. Missing the target results in a score of zero for that arrow.
Target archery is where competitors shoot at a stationery target from
various distances (men shoot from 90 meters, 70 meters, 50 meters, and
30 meters, and women shoot from 70 meters, 60 meters, 50 meters, and
30 meters).
Field archery has two forms: freestyle and barebow, or instinctive. Target archery equipment is allowed in freestyle, while bareback archery
forbids any artificial aiming devices.
Crossbow archery has two forms: match or traditional style and field or
archery style. Match shooting takes place on ranges with mechanical target transport systems. Field shooting takes place on open sport fields, as
in the Olympics.
Chapter 6
2 Arm Wrestling
Two competitors interlock a hand and when signaled to start, try to force
the opponents hand to touch the table (being pinned).
3 Badminton
Badminton is distinguished from other racquet sports by two features: the
use of a shuttlecock and the fact that the shuttlecock cannot touch the
ground during a rally.
Olympic badminton includes mens singles, womens singles, mens
doubles, womens doubles, and mixed doubles.
4 Baseball
Baseball is a game between two teams of nine players each under direction of a manager and played on an enclosed field. The objective of each
team is to score more runs than the opponent using a bat to hit a pitched
ball.
Options: Pro (major league baseball), college, little league, designed
from the player or managers POV
5 Basketball
Basketball is a game played generally indoors by two opposing teams of
five players where each team scores by throwing a round ball into a raised
basket. Each game half lasts 20 minutes (in FIBA there are four
ten-minute quarters) on a court 94 feet long by 50 feet wide (FIBA is 91'
10" long and 49' 2.5" wide).
The Harlem Globetrotters were key in the development of the
fast-break offense, the slam dunk, and the scouting system to recruit players, and they introduced the figure eight weave offense.
Street basketball can be played as 2 on 2 or 3 on 3 in a school or
park basketball blacktop court. The courts small size usually has both
teams playing half court and shooting at the same basket. In 3 on 3
street basketball, teams may have up to four players (three on the court
and one substitute). The basket is ten feet high (for children under 11, the
basket is eight feet high). Free throws are 15 feet (ten feet for ages under
11). The ball must be checked (touched) by an opposing player before it
is put into play. The ball must be passed to begin play. All called fouls
result in one free throw shot, except on successful field goals, in which
case the basket counts and no free throw shot is awarded. In 2 on 2
street basketball, slam dunks are allowed. In 3 on 3 basketball, slam
dunks are prohibited. A ball out-of-bounds is taken out from the back-court
line.
Options: Pro (National Basketball Association, Womens NBA, Continental Basketball Association, international or European, Harlem
Globetrotters), College (NCAA, Canadian Interuniversity Athletic Union),
Olympic (FIBA), street basketball, 2 on 2 competition, 3 on 3
Game Ideas
6 Biathlon
Biathlon is a sport in which cross-country skiers race across hilly terrain,
occasionally stopping to shoot with rifles at fixed targets. Men and women
compete in sprint, pursuit, individual, and relay.
In the Olympic biathlon sprint, women race 7.5 kilometers and men
race 10 kilometers. Competitors stop twice and must hit all five targets
with five bullets. The top 60 placers of this competition qualify for the pursuit. For each target missed, athletes take a lap around the 150-meter
penalty loop.
In the Olympic biathlon pursuit, the competitors start at intervals based
on their place in the sprint competition. Women race 10 kilometers and
men race 12.5 kilometers. Competitors stop four times and must hit all
five targets with five bullets. For each target missed, athletes take a lap
around the 150-meter penalty loop.
In the Olympic biathlon individual event, women race 15 kilometers
and men race 20 kilometers. All competitors stop four times at the firing
range and must hit all five targets with five bullets. For each target
missed, one minute is added to their total time.
In the Olympic biathlon relay, each four-person team must race four
7.5-kilometer legs for a total of 30 kilometers. Each team member has up
to two firing sequences and is allowed three extra bullets (for a total of
eight) to hit five targets and must load the three extra bullets one by one.
For each target left standing, competitors ski a lap around the 150-meter
penalty loop.
7 BMX Biking
Competitors ride a BMX bike through an obstacle course and perform
in-air maneuvers and tricks.
10 Bowling
Bowling is a sport that uses a round ball and a lane (an area to throw the
ball down). Several variations of bowling include the standard ten-pin
Chapter 6
Chapter 6
bowling, candle pin bowling, duck pin bowling, lawn bowling, bocce, skittles, and Canadian five-pin.
Standard ten-pin involves throwing a bowling ball to knock down ten
pins on a lane 60 feet long and 42 inches wide. A game consists of ten
frames where the bowler can throw twice per frame. The goal is to knock
down as many pins as possible. On the first throw, knocking down all ten
pins is called a strike. On the second throw, knocking down all the
remaining pins (so ten pins are knocked down in two throws) is called a
spare.
In Candle pin, scoring is the same as in regulation ten-pin bowling,
except a bowler is allowed three balls per frame. If all ten pins are knocked
down with three balls, the score for the frame is simply a ten. The pins are
15 inches high and 215 16 inches at the middle, tapering to 1 inches at
the ends. The ball is 4 inches in diameter and weighs from two pounds,
five ounces to two pounds, seven ounces.
Duck pin is similar to ten-pin bowling where bowlers play with small
balls, about six inches in diameter. A regulation game consists of ten
frames, or boxes. A bowler is allowed up to three balls per frame to knock
down as many pins as possible. If all ten pins are knocked down by the
first ball in any frame, it is called a strike.
Lawn bowling (or bowling on the green) is distinguished by use of a
biased ball. That is, the ball is deliberately lopsided so that it always
curves toward the flat side as it slows down. The object of the game is to
obtain points by getting ones ball(s) closest to a small white ball, the
jack, which may be anywhere between 75 and 108 feet away.
Bocce is the Italian version of lawn bowling. The bocce court has a
rather hard surface of packed dirt or gravel and its rectangular, 60 to 80
feet long and 12 feet wide. A wooden barrier, 4 inches high, surrounds
the court. An interesting feature of bocce is that shots can be played off
the sideboards and the backstop. There can be one, two, or four players
per side. Each side has four balls. A player, chosen by lot, rolls a small ball,
the pallina, which becomes the target. That player then rolls a second ball,
attempting to get as close to the pallina as possible. When both sides have
bowled all of their balls, the side with the ball closest to the pallina gets a
point. The first side to score 16 points wins.
Skittles is a type of bowling where two- to four-player teams roll or
throw a ball or a thick, flat disk at nine skittles (pins), scoring a point for
each one knocked down. The alley is 3 feet wide and 21 feet long. A turn
consists of up to three throws (or chalk).
In Canadian five-pin bowling, a five-inch ball is rolled at five pins each
with different point values: the head pin or left-most pin is five points, the
next two pins (center) are worth three points, and the remaining two pins
(right-most) are worth two points. Ten frames of up to three throws per
frame make up a game.
Game Ideas
11 Boxing
Two opponents (boxers) wearing gloves punch each other for points or
until one boxer is knocked out or forfeits. The rules are defined by the
Marquis of Queensberry from the 1860s.
Options: Pro (World Boxing Council, International Boxing Federation,
World Boxing Association, World Boxing Organization), Olympic, Golden
Gloves, amateur, designed from the player or managers POV
Cricket is a game played with a bat and a ball. The normal game consists
of two teams, each with 11 players. There are two umpires. Cricket is
played in a big field. In the center of the field is a place called the pitch.
The pitch is about 22 yards in length. At each end there are stumps,
which are long pieces of wood. On top of the stumps rest the bails. The
batsman who is facing stands at one end of the pitch and the batsman who
is not facing stands at the other. The umpire stands behind the stumps at
the non-striking end or bowling end. The wicket keeper stands directly
behind the stumps at the batsmans end. To get a batsman out bowled, the
bowler has to aim at the batting end stump. If the ball hits the stump, the
batsman is out.
Chapter 6
12 Cricket
Chapter 6
13 Croquet
The standard double-diamond rectangular court officially measures 50 feet
wide and 100 feet long with nine wickets and two sets of stakes. The game
is designed for up to six balls and may be played with any number of players from two to six. The game is won when one of the players or teams
has staked out by scoring all the wickets and striking the finishing stake
with all the balls on its side. Players in turn strike a croquet ball with a
mallet-head.
14 Cross-Country Skiing
Skiers race across a course of uphill, downhill, and flatland terrain. In the
Olympics, cross-country skiing includes a 1.5 kilometers sprint (men and
women), womens ten kilometers and 30 kilometers and mens 15 kilometers and 50 kilometers classical, womens and mens combined pursuit
(women race ten kilometers and men race 20 kilometers, where the first
half of the race is in the classical style and the second half is a freestyle
race), womens 15 kilometers freestyle and mens 30 kilometers freestyle,
womens 4x5 kilometers relay and mens 4x10 kilometers relay.
The individual Nordic combined competition is composed of a ski jumping competition from the normal hill and a 15-kilometer cross-country
race.
15 Curling
Curling is an ice game where two four-man teams (called rinks) slide
heavy stones toward a circular target on a surface 146 feet long and 14
feet wide. Each player slides two stones toward the target (called the
house), alternating turns with the opposing team. Each sixteen stones
(two teams of four players sliding two stones each) make an end, and
ten to twelve ends make a curling game.
16 Cycling
Riders on bicycles compete in various events like mountain cycling, road
racing, match sprint, Olympic sprint, individual and team pursuit, points
racing, the keirin, the Madison, sprint race, messenger race, freight bike
race, and unicycling.
Mountain cycling is for men and women. Men race between 40 and 50
kilometers, and women race 30 to 40 kilometers. Exact distances are
decided the night before the race, determined by weather conditions. It is
a cross-country race on forest roads, fields, and earth and gravel paths.
Road racing is for men who race 239 kilometers and women who race
120 kilometers. The Olympic mens road race is 13 laps around an
11.1-mile course (or 144.3 miles). The Olympic womens road race is
seven laps totaling 78.3 miles.
The Olympic cycling track events are the time trial (the mens 1,000
meters time trial and the womens 500 meters time trial), the individual
sprint, individual pursuit and points race, the mens team pursuit, Olympic
mens sprint, keirin (men), and Madison (men). The races take place on
wooden tracks that are 333.33 meters and 250 meters long.
The match sprint is a cycling race in which two riders meet in a
best-of-three competition, and one rider, determined first by drawing and
alternating thereafter, must lead the first lap of each sprint before the two
jockey for position in the final two laps.
The Olympic sprint is a cycling race where three-man teams compete.
Each team member leads for one of the three laps.
The individual pursuit is a cycling race in which two riders are positioned opposite each other on the track, and each attempts to pass the
other, and if not, the fastest time wins.
The team pursuit is similar to individual pursuit, except teams of four
go head-to-head, and the third member of the fastest team either crosses
the finish line or passes the third member of the slower team.
The points race is a cycling race in which the rider who accumulates
the most points or laps around the field wins the race (points are awarded
during lap sprints, which occur every fifth lap, with five points to the winner, three points to second place, two points to third, and one point to
fourth).
The keirin is of Japanese origin and is a 1.25-mile mass-start sprint
where riders draft behind a motorcycle at speeds from 15 to 30 mph,
which pulls off the track two laps before the finish.
The Madison is named after New Yorks Madison Square Garden where
the race originated. It is a two-man points race where riders sprint for
points every five laps and switch off with a teammate in a relay manner.
In a sprint race cyclists race on a track that is 100 meters, making this
a pure acceleration race.
The messenger race is a track of three different circles including eight
checkpoints. These checkpoints serve as client addresses, which means
you have to pick up and deliver the packages there. The racetrack is
formed by one-way streets that are only allowed to be used in one direction. Its even forbidden to deviate from the route or take shortcuts.
In a freight bike race the competitors start singly and transport extra
heavy and bulky cargo around one of the three circles of the racetrack. At
the start, the departure time is stamped on the job sheet. The racer loads
the first cargo at freight station A, rides around circle one, and unloads
again at station A. Then the second load is received at station B, and circle
two has to be rounded. The last cargo of station C has to be ridden around
circle three. After unloading, the time of each competitor is taken at the
finish. At the freight stations, the job sheets are stamped as usual after
unloading.
A unicycling competition has ten levels where competitors must successfully pass the previous level of mounting and performing maneuvers
on a unicycle before competing at the next level.
Chapter 6
Game Ideas
Chapter 6
17 Darts
Darts is a game where players throw darts at a board. A dart is a small,
arrow-shaped object with a feather-shaped guide at one end and a metal or
plastic sharp point at the other end. A player stands behind a shooting line
that is 10 to 20 feet from the target (dartboard) and aims his dart at the
games goal area of the target.
18 Demolition Derby
Demolition derby is a sport where cars roam around a dirt or mud area
crashing into their opponents vehicles and try to be the last car running.
The building of a demolition car and crippling the opponents vehicle is the
excitement of the sport.
19 Diving
Diving is a water sport where the performer plunges from a board into the
water using various maneuvers (diving technique or type of dive). Diving
may begin from a running or standing position. Diving is judged by several
key factors: the approach, the height of the spring, the execution of the
dive, and the entry into the water (the splash). The boards can be a
one-meter board, a three-meter board, and the platform (ten-meter
platform).
Olympic diving has diving events such as mens platform, springboard,
synchronized platform, and synchronized springboard and womens platform, springboard, synchronized platform, and synchronized springboard.
20 Dog Racing
Dog racing is a sport where dogs chase a mechanical rabbit (on an electric
track) around a 550-yard racetrack. Usually eight dogs of class greyhound or whippet race.
21 Dog Sledding
Dog sledding is a race where six to twelve dogs pull a sled (50 to 100
pounds) and a driver. Dog racing events include sprinting (30 to 60 miles),
mid-distance (200 to 300 miles), and marathon (long distance, 500 to 1,000
miles) races.
Options: Race distances
Venues: Maine, Alaska (Iditarod), Minnesota, Australia
22 Equestrian
Equestrian competitions include dressage, show jumping, eventing, combined driving, endurance riding, and reining.
Dressage has the horse and rider performing a series of required movements at specific locations within the arena, a field 20x60 meters with 12
letter markers spaced at specific points along the rails. The required
Game Ideas
movements are the Piaffe, the Passage, the Pirouette, the Half Pass, and
the Flying Change.
Show jumping is where riders and horses must jump a specially
designed course of 15 to 20 obstacles, with faults (penalty points) if the
horse refuses or brings down the highest element of an obstacle (fence) or
if they exceed the time allowed. In a timed run, the rider and horse must
cleanly jump over obstacles like the vertical, the wall, oxers, triple bar,
combination, water jump, and gate.
Eventing is also known as Concours Complet dEquitation or complete equestrian competition. Eventing is designed to show the riders
spirit, boldness, and perfect knowledge of the horses speed and ability, as
well as the condition, handiness, courage, jumping ability, and stamina of
the well-trained horse. Eventing has three phases: dressage competition,
speed and endurance test, and stadium jumping.
Combined driving demands versatility in drivers and their horses as
they compete in the three phases of the competition: dressage test, marathon, and cones course.
Endurance riding requires that an endurance ride be at least 50 miles in
length per day (the most prestigious are the 100 miles per day). Competitive trails can be in the mountains, deserts or forests, city streets, and
public beaches.
Reining is designed to show the athletic ability of a ranch-type horse in
the confines of a show arena. Riders are required to run one of several
approved patterns, which include small slow circles, large fast circles, flying lead changes, roll backs over the hocks, 360 degree spins done in
place, and the exciting sliding stops that are the hallmark of the reining
horse. The competition has several required movements: walk-ins, stops,
spins, rollbacks, circles, hesitations, lead changes, and run downs/runarounds.
Freestyle reining consists of specific reining maneuvers set to music in
a format designed by each competitor.
23 Extreme Fighting
Extreme fighting is a sport where a fighter tries to incapacitate his opponent by punching, kicking, or squeezing them into verbal or physical
submission.
Chapter 6
24 Fencing
10
Chapter 6
25 Field Hockey
Field hockey is a game where two teams compete on a smooth grass field
(90 to 100 yards long, 50 to 60 yards wide). Each team includes 11 players
(five forwards, three halfbacks, two fullbacks, and a goalkeeper). Players
move a ball with curved-end sticks (flat on the left side, rounded on the
right side) during two halves (30 to 60 minutes per half) toward the opponents goal (seven feet high, twelve feet wide). The ball is nine inches
wide and has a cork and twine center inside the leather covering. Goalkeepers may use their stick or kick the ball.
Options: U.S. Field Hockey, International Field Hockey, mens or
womens
26 Fishing
Fishing is a water sport where the goal is to capture a fish. Fishing takes
on many forms, like fly-fishing (casting on top of the water), still fishing
(drop a baited hook into the water), trolling (towing the bait from a moving
boat), and ice fishing (fishing through a hole in the ice). Besides freshwater fishing, there is deep-sea (ocean) fishing.
27 Football
Football is a sport played by two teams of 11 players on a field 100 yards
long by 53 yards wide. The ball (called jokingly a pigskin) is pointed,
oval-shaped, and made out of leather. Two halves or four quarters of 15
minutes each (for pro or college, 12 minutes for high school) make up a
game. A touchdown (crossing the goal line) scores six points. After a
touchdown, a successful kick or punt scores one point. A fourth-down kick
called a field goal scores three points if successful. Every ten-yard
advancement by an offense is another first down. Teams are allowed four
downs to achieve this; otherwise, the opposing team gets possession of
the ball. On the fourth down, an offensive team may elect to kick the ball
down field to reposition the opposing teams possession. On each down,
the ball may be passed (thrown) or run with to gain yardage.
Options: Pro (National Football League, World Football League, Canadian Football League, Extreme Football, International Football, Gaelic
Football), college, high school, touch football, flag football, designed from
the player or managers POV
28 Formula-1 Racing
Formula-1 cars speed around complex racing tracks at speeds exceeding
200 mph for distances of 500 miles. Countries like the United States, Italy,
France, Germany, Australia, Malaysia, Brazil, Canada, and Japan sponsor
Grand Prix and Formula-1 races.
Game Ideas
11
29 Golf
Golf is a sport where players using a club (wood, iron, or putter) hit a ball
on a course (smooth grass, sand, and woods) of nine or eighteen holes. A
hole can be 100 to 600 yards from the tee, a small flat area where the hole
play begins.
Options: Pro (U.S. Open, Masters, Seniors), international matches,
amateur (Americas Cup), mens or womens, designed from the player or
managers POV
30 Gymnastics
Men compete in all-around, horizontal bar, parallel bars, long horse vault,
side horse, rings, floor exercise, team combined exercises, and trampoline. Women compete in all-around, side horse vault, uneven bars, balance
beam, floor exercises, team combined exercises, rhythmic all-around,
rhythmic team, and trampoline.
32 Horse Racing
33 Horseshoe Pitching
Horseshoe pitching is a game where players (two to four) throw (called
pitch) horseshoes at a stake 40 feet away. A ringer is a horseshoe that
circles the stake and is worth three points. A horseshoe within six inches
Chapter 6
12
Chapter 6
of the stake scores one point. A leaner (a horseshoe that is leaning against
the stake) scores one point. Typically, a horseshoe game is won at 50
points or more.
34 Hunting
Hunting is the sport of capturing or killing wild animal and fowl. The sport
is in the outdoor chase and understanding the habits of the pursued wild
animal.
Options: deer, big game (Africa), pheasant
35 Ice Skating
Ice skating is a sport where skaters perform maneuvers on ice. Mens and
womens singles is where skaters display a high level of aesthetic form
and technical skill under a great amount of pressure. Each competition is
comprised of two parts: the short program (worth 33.3 percent of their
final score) and a free skate (66.7 percent).
Pairs skating is performed in unison by partners who execute daring
and difficult overhead lifts, throw jumps, and spins. Each competition is
comprised of two parts: the short program (worth 33.3 percent of their
final score) and a free skate (66.7 percent).
Ice dancing has three segments of competition: two compulsory dances
(each worth 10 percent of a teams final score), an original dance (worth 30
percent), and a free dance (worth 50 percent).
Options: pro, amateur, Olympic, national, international, mens,
womens, and pairs
36 Jai Alai
Jai Alai is a game where players wear a basket (called a cesta) strapped
to their arm for catching and throwing a baseball-size ball (called a
pelota) on a court (called a cancha), which measures 176 feet long, 55
feet wide, and 40 feet high. The game is played in singles, doubles (two
per team), and triples (three per team) where one side serves and the
opponent catches and throws the ball. A missed ball scores the opposing
team one point. Six points wins a singles game while thirty points wins a
doubles or triples game.
37 Jet Skiing
Jet skiing competition has riders skiing around an obstacle water course in
several classes of vehicle like stock, limited, superstock, and modified.
The championships are based on the riders experience in sectionals, such
as Pro, Pro-Am, Expert, Amateur, and Novice.
The Novice classes are where riders learn about racing and improve
their racing skills. The Expert classes are for riders with advanced racing
skills. Expert riders normally have raced for several years and have
advanced skills and equipment.
Game Ideas
13
The Pro-Am class is defined as a combined Expert and Pro class. Professional riders have substantial riding experience and have developed
advanced riding skills. IJSBA preapproval is required to obtain Pro status.
Jet ski boats are classified as ski class, sports class, and runabout class.
Ski class watercrafts are designed for one person to stand on, and the skis
are steered from the front with a moveable handle pole rising above the
tray area that directs a rear jet. Ski class includes several Kawasaki Jet Ski
and Yamaha SuperJet models.
Sport class watercrafts are designed mainly for one passenger and
include a seat and fixed handlebar that directs a rear jet; they weigh more
than 300 pounds with a hull width that ranges from 26 inches to 38 inches.
Sport class includes the Sea-Doo HX, Yamaha WaveBlaster, and Polaris
Hurricane.
Runabout class watercrafts are designed for one or more people and
include a seat and fixed handlebar that directs a rear jet and have a hull
width greater than 38 inches. Runabouts have two separate divisions: the
785 cc and 1200 cc. The runabout class includes many Bombardier
Sea-Doo, Kawasaki Jet Ski, Polaris, and Yamaha WaveRunner models.
Racing classes are separated by engine size and the types of modifications done to the watercraft. The basic classes are stock, limited,
superstock, and modified.
A list of world championships competition include Pro Ski Superstock,
Pro Runabout 1200 Superstock, Pro Freestyle, Pro-Am Ski Stock, Pro-Am
Women Ski Limited, Pro-Am Runabout 1200 Stock, Pro-Am Runabout 800
Superstock, Pro-Am Women Runabout 1200 Limited, Pro-Am Sport
Superstock, Expert Ski Superstock, Expert Ski Limited, Expert Veterans
Ski Superstock, Expert Runabout 1200 Superstock, Expert Runabout 1200
Limited, Expert Runabout 800 Superstock, Expert Runabout 800 Limited,
Amateur Veterans Runabout 1200 Superstock, Amateur Freestyle, Novice
Ski Superstock, Novice Ski Limited, Novice Ski Stock, Novice Veterans
Ski Superstock, Novice Women Ski Limited, Novice Runabout 1200
Superstock, Novice Runabout 1200 Limited, Novice Runabout 1200 Stock,
Novice Runabout 800 Superstock, Novice Runabout 800 Limited, Novice
Runabout 800 Stock, Novice Women Runabout 1200 Limited, Novice
Sport Superstock, and Novice Sport Limited.
Options: world championship, International Jet Sports Boating
Association
Chapter 6
38 Jousting
14
Chapter 6
39 Judo
Judo (or jujitsu) is similar to wrestling where a contestant must throw the
opponent to the ground or use a strangle hold or arm lock, forcing the
opponent into submission. There is no kicking, hitting, or gouging in judo.
Olympic classes are mens and womens extra lightweight, half lightweight, lightweight, half middleweight, middleweight, half heavyweight,
and heavyweight.
Options: tournament, Olympic
40 Karate
Karate (meaning open hand) is a sport originated in the Oriental where
a competitor strikes with his hands, elbows, knees, and feet to stop an
aggressive opponent.
Shotokan karate is a system of karate characterized by its deep-rooted
stances and fast, powerful techniques.
Shito Ryu places an emphasis on power in the execution of techniques,
and the style also uses a large number of kata (about 50).
Tae kwon do is a modern martial art characterized by fast, high, and
spinning kicks.
Wado Ryu means the way of harmony and is a system derived from
Shotokan and juijitsu. The style puts a strong emphasis on softness and
has higher stances than that of Shotokan with quick, short, less powerful
movements.
Aikido is a Japanese self-defense martial art where force is encountered
by a defense based on the attackers loss of balance.
41 Kayaking
Canoe and kayak (Eskimo canoes) are boats that race in water and move
by human powered paddles.
Olympic canoe and kayak has 16 events, 4 from slalom and 12 from
sprint. Women compete only in kayaks, while men use both canoes and
kayaks.
The Olympic canoe/kayak disciplines are divided between flatwater
competition, which features 12 events and 4 whitewater events. The
flatwater includes mens and womens singles, doubles and fours kayaks,
and mens singles and doubles canoes. The whitewater slalom event
includes mens singles kayak, mens singles and pairs canoe, and womens
singles kayak.
42 Kendo
Kendo is a traditional Japanese martial art where two competitors wearing
protective armor and using bamboo swords and quick footwork combat
each other.
Game Ideas
15
43 Kung Fu
Kung fu is a martial art where close combat skills are used to subdue the
enemy with skillful movements and ingenious exertion of strength. The
basic principle in capturing the enemy is to seize, with one or both hands,
a joint in the enemys limbs to have total control of his entire body before
you finally tie him up.
44 Lacrosse
Lacrosse is a game where players (ten players in a mens game and twelve
players in a womens game) use a loose net and hickory stick to throw or
carry the ball toward the opponents goal. Players wear helmets, cleated
shoes, and padded gloves. Body contact is only allowed in the mens game.
The luge has several forms of competition: single luge, double luge, timed
luge races, dual luge races, mass luge races, super mass luge races, street
luge, and classic luge (buttboard).
In single (male and female) the luge sledders take off from a sitting
position on top of a slope from which they push the sled, gripping the two
fixed handles. The race time starts as soon as the sled crosses the bottom
of the starting slope. The race ends as soon as the first luge sledder
crosses the lugecrosses at the end of the track.
In double (male) the sledder at the top of the starting slope pushes the
luge by means of two fixed handles, while the second sledder slips his
hands into belts connected to the sledder behind him. The stopwatch
starts as soon as the electronic eye (a LED), positioned at the end of the
slope, is passed, and each team has 45 seconds to start its race once the
starting signal is given. The race ends when the couple passes the LED
located at the end of the track, and the team must end the race in contact
with the sled.
Top sliders travel at speeds up to 90 mph on an icy, banked track. The
track must be 1,350 meters long with a total difference in altitude of 130
meters. The last 100 meters are called the braking space because besides
being uphill, they have some curves that allow a reduction of speed.
Timed luge races consist of one pilot on the course at a time competing
for the fastest time. This may include many variations, such as combined
times, fastest of a set number of runs, and so on.
Dual luge races consist of two pilots racing each other. First across the
finish line advances or wins.
Mass luge races have a minimum of four racers per heat. The first two
racers to cross the finish line advance or win.
Super mass luge races have a minimum of six racers per heat. The first
three racers to cross the finish line advance or win.
Street luge and classic luge (buttboard) is like a large skateboard on a
course that is one kilometer long with a 10 percent grade, 50 mph plus
speeds, two turns that require braking, and a large finish area. Street luge
Chapter 6
45 Luge
16
Chapter 6
races are held all over the world from Austria, Italy, Great Britain, Australia, Spain, the eastern and western U.S., and Canada.
46 Miniature Golf
Miniature golf is played on putting green obstacle courses. Most courses
have nine or eighteen holes, and the object is to sink the golf ball with a
putter into that greens hole in as few strokes as possible. Some greens
require that the ball pass through a funnel, over a ramp or a bridge, or
through a timed, moving passageway.
A world championship tournament may be comprised of 36-hole single
elimination matches down to two players.
Doubles competition is two rounds of better-ball (lowest score of the
two-person team is used) competition and two rounds of alternate shot
(players alternate turns putting) competition.
Team competition is where the aggregate totals of each four-player
team determine the winners.
Options: world championship, doubles, team, prebuilt or player-created
course
48 Motorcycling
Motorcycle racing includes motocross, supercross, and road racing for various motorcycles (125, 250, 500, 600, 750 cc) and racing experience
(provisional, novice, or expert) on racing tracks, ice or dirt courses,
and indoor tracks.
49 NASCAR Racing
NASCAR (National Association for Stock Car Auto Racing) is a sport
where drivers race cars that people actually drive, also known as stock
cars. The races are on the average 400 to 500 miles. Trucks can now compete in NASCAR truck races.
50 Paintball
Paintball is where players or teams of players shoot paint pellet guns at
their opponent(s) and try to incapacitate them or kill them by painting
the opponent(s) in vital body areas.
Game Ideas
17
51 Pentathlon
The modern pentathlon is comprised of events such as shooting
(air-pistol), fencing (epee), swimming (200 meter freestyle), riding
(showjumping), and cross-country running.
52 Polo (Horse)
Polo is a ball game played on horseback on outdoor grass (300 yards long
by 200 yards wide) or indoor fields (110 yards long by 50 yards wide). A
white painted willow ball (3.25 inches wide) is hit by the players cane or
rattan mallet (48 to 54 inches long). A polo player is equipped with boots,
white breeches, knee guards, a whip, spurs, a mallet, and a jersey. A polo
game lasts six or eight periods (called chukkers) of 7.5 minutes per
period.
Pool is an indoor game played on a felt-covered table (four to six feet wide
and eight to twelve feet long) where a stick (cue stick) hits a pool ball. A
pool game has colored and/or striped balls and a white cue ball.
Straight pool is where a player must indicate which ball will be entering
which pocket (hole). One point is scored per correctly pocketed ball and 75
to 100 points win a game. There are 15 colored and striped balls used.
Rotation pool requires each ball to be pocketed in sequence (next lowest ball must be hit first). A rotation pool game scores one point for each
pocketed ball, and 61 points wins the game. There are 15 colored and
striped balls used.
Snooker is played with a cue ball, and 21 object balls (15 red balls and 6
numbered, non-red balls from two to seven). Pocketing a red ball scores
one point and pocketing a non-red ball scores the balls value (two through
seven).
Billiards is played with three balls: one red ball and two white cue balls
(one cue ball has two small colored dots on it). Scoring occurs as a result
of several types of conditions: (1) the cue ball strikes an object ball A and
hits at least three cushions before hitting a second object ball B; (2) the
first ball A is hit, and at least two cushions are hit before second ball B
is hit; (3) two object balls in a row are hit or at least two cushions are hit,
and then object ball A and at least another cushion are hit before hitting
the second object ball B. The first player to score 50 or 100 points wins.
Bumper pool is played where a cue ball must pocket several balls
through a setup of rubber-padded bumpers in the middle of the table surrounding the two pockets.
Eight ball is also called stripes and colors or odds and evens. After
a player pockets the first ball, determining his side, each player must
pocket all of his remaining balls and then the eight ball must be successfully pocketed into the called hole. There are 15 colored and striped balls
used.
Chapter 6
53 Pool
18
Chapter 6
Nine ball requires that the first nine balls be racketed and pocketed in
order. The winner is the player who successfully pockets the nine ball.
Options: straight pool, rotation pool, snooker, billiards, bumper pool,
eight ball, nine ball
54 Quoits
Quoits is a game of tossing a metal ring (quoit) over a peg. It is similar to
horseshoes. Two pegs 1 inch high and 18 yards apart are thrown at with
rubber, rope, or wooden quoits (two per turn). A player(s) stands behind
one peg and throws at the other peg where a ringer (a quiot encircling a
peg) scores three points, a leaner (quoit leans against the peg) scores two
points, and if no leaners or ringers occur, the nearest quoit to the peg
scores one point. The game is over when one side scores 21 points or
more. Many players can play on one of two sides.
55 Racquetball
Racquetball is a sport derived from handball where a racquet is used.
Players can play singles, pairs, and non-tournament three-player or
cut-throat. On a court 40 feet long, 20 feet wide, and 20 feet high, players
hit a ball with a racket up to 22 inches. Players need to serve to score, and
missing the ball either scores or retires the serve (called a sideout or a
handout in doubles).
Options: singles, doubles, three-player, or cut-throat
56 Rodeo
A rodeo consists of several western-style or cowboy sports like bareback
riding, saddle-bronc riding, bull riding, calf roping, and steer wrestling.
Bareback riding has the rider unsaddled on a bucking, jumping,
untamed horse for ten seconds.
Saddle-bronc riding is like bareback riding, where the rider has a saddle, a halter, and a rein for a ten-second ride.
Bull riding has the rider holding a long rope tied to the untamed bulls
body for an eight-second ride.
Calf roping is done from a horse by a rider who throws a rope around a
running calf and then dismounts to tie the grounded, pinned calfs three
feet within 15 seconds.
Steer wrestling or bulldogging is where a speeding horse rider jumps
onto a running steers neck and by twisting the steers neck, knocks it to
the ground within three to eight seconds.
57 Roller Derby
Roller derby is a speed roller skating sport where teams consisting of five
men and five women compete in separate 12-minute periods against an
opposing team. Scoring occurs when a player passes the opposing teams
players by a lap or more. Players can block their opponents.
Game Ideas
19
58 Roller Skating
Roller skating involves skating on wheeled shoes on a wooden rink. Competition falls into two categories: artistic roller skating and speed roller
skating.
In artistic roller skating, skaters can compete in figure skating, free
skating, or dance skating. Figure roller skating requires 64 different
maneuvers to be completed. In free roller skating, the skater creates her
own routines consisting of various jumps and spins that are judged on
their originality, beauty, and technique. In roller dancing, couples (mixed
pairs) are judged on timing, grace, and skill as they perform to music.
Speed roller skating is a timed event where male skaters can race up to
five miles and females up to one mile.
59 Rowing
Rowing competition boats are classified into two categories and separated
by gender. The first category is sculling, in which athletes compete
using two three-meter-long sculls, holding one in each hand. The second
is rowing, in which athletes use one four-meter oar to power the boat,
holding this longer oar with both hands.
There are three types of sculls: single sculls or 1x (one athlete) with
a boat weight of 14 kg, double sculls or 2x (two athletes) with a boat
weight of 27 kg, and quadruple sculls or 4x (four athletes) with a boat
weight of 52 kg.
The rowing categories include teams of two, four, and eight. The boat
types in this category are coxless pair with a boat weight of 27 kg, pair
with coxswain with a boat weight of 32 kg, four with coxswain with a boat
weight of 51 kg, coxless four with a boat weight of 50 kg, and eight with
coxswain with a boat weight of 96 kg.
The competition distance in rowing is 2,000 meters for all categories,
and all competitions take place on a six-lane track.
Chapter 6
60 Rugby
20
Chapter 6
61 Sailing
Sailing is a water sport where a team navigates their boat around a water
course. Americas Cup Race, handicap races (boats of various sizes and
designs), and one-design races are types of sailing races.
Olympic sailing events include Mens Board Sailing (class Mistral One
Design), Womens Board Sailing (class Mistral One Design), Mens Single-handed Dinghy (class Finn), Womens Single-handed Dinghy (class
Europe), Single-handed Dinghy Open (class Laser), Mens Double-handed
Dinghy (class 470), Womens Double-handed Dinghy (class 470), High
Performance Dinghy Open (class 49er), Multihull Open (class Tornado),
Mens Keelboat (class Star), and Womens Keelboat (class Yngling).
Game Ideas
21
62 Shuffleboard
Shuffleboard is a smooth surface game where players slide wooden or
metal disks into a scoring zone and try to knock their opponents disks out
of the scoring zone by using a cue, a stick with a wide end. Two or four
(two teams) players can play a game up to 50, 75, or 100 points. A match
consists of winning two out of three games.
63 Skateboarding
Skateboarders perform tricks, maneuvers, and aerials through obstacles
inside a skateboarding park.
64 Skeet Shooting
Skeet shooting simulates shooting birds and is similar to trapshooting but
has clay targets that are launched from a metal-sprung trap. The skeet
shooter must shoot single or pair launches from the seven shooting stations located within a 21-yard radius, and an eighth station is located in the
center at the radius.
Chapter 6
65 Skiing
22
Chapter 6
In mens and womens mogul, skiers race down a 27-degree slope over
moguls where the length of the run is between 230 and 270 meters (755
to 885 feet) with bumps up to 1.2 meters (four feet) high.
In both mens and womens competitions, athletes perform various
combinations of flips and twists off snow-packed jumps as high as four
meters (13 feet), with takeoff angles as steep as 70 degrees.
66 Snowboarding
Snowboarding is a winter sport that began as a braced pair of skis with a
rope tied to the front to help steer.
The Olympics has four snowboard events: mens halfpipe, womens
halfpipe, mens parallel giant slalom, and womens parallel giant slalom.
The halfpipe competition takes place in a half-cylinder-shaped course
dug deep into the hill. The pipe is generally 4 to 5 meters deep and 160
meters long with a 165-degree pitch and 4.5-meter-high vertical walls on
each side. Using speed gained on the slope, snowboarders come up over
the rim of the pipe and perform acrobatic aerial tricks. The object of the
halfpipe is to perform difficult tricks with perfect form.
Alpine snowboarding, parallel giant slalom, features head-to-head
match-ups on the mountain until one winner remains.
67 Snowmobiling
Snowmobile races are held on snow, dirt, and grass courses for short and
long distance races or several laps on a difficult obstacle course. NHRA
(National Hot Rod Association) has a snowmobile class in its
bracket-racing program where snowmobilers can tear down the
one-quarter-mile asphalt drag strip against other riders.
Some snowmobile racing classes are Trail Stock 440 Fan, Trail Stock
440 Liquid, Trail Stock 500, Trail Stock 600, Trail Stock 600 Triple, Trail
Stock 700, Trail Stock 700 Triple, Trail Stock 800, Trail Stock 800 Triple,
Trail Stock 1000, Stock 440 Fan, Stock 440 Liquid, Stock 500, Stock 600,
Stock 600 Triple, Stock 700, Stock 700 Triple, Stock 800, Stock 800 Triple,
Improved Stock 1-440 cc, Improved Stock 2-500 cc, Improved Stock 3-600
cc, Improved Stock 4-700 cc, Improved Stock 5-800 cc, Improved Stock
6-1000 cc, Pro Stock 2-500 cc, Pro Stock 3-600 cc, Pro Stock 4-700 cc, Pro
Stock 5-800 cc, Pro Stock 6-1000 cc, Heavy Mod 2-500 cc, Heavy Mod
3-600 cc, Heavy Mod 4-700 cc, Heavy Mod 5-800 cc, Heavy Mod 6-1000
cc, Open Mod 2-500 cc, Open Mod 3-600 cc, Open Mod 4-700 cc, Open
Mod 5-800 cc, and Open Mod 6-1000 cc.
68 Soccer
Soccer is played by two teams, each consisting of not more than 11 players, one of whom is the goalkeeper. The object is to score the most goals.
A goal is scored by having the whole of the ball (a black and white hexed,
leather ball, 27 to 28 inches or 69 to 71 centimeters in diameter) pass over
the goal line, between the goalposts and under the crossbar. The match
Game Ideas
23
lasts two equal periods of 45 minutes each on the field of play, which must
be rectangular (length 100 yards or 90 meters by width 50 yards or 45
meters, and for international matches length 110 yards or 100 meters by
width 70 yards or 64 meters). Only the goalie may freely pick up the ball
with his hands or drop kick it. Other players must not touch the ball with
their hands or arms except to throw in when the ball has exited the playing field.
Options: pro, international, World Cup, Olympic, indoor, or outdoor,
designed from the player or managers POV
69 Softball
Softball is similar to baseball, except the ball is larger (12 to 14 inches in
diameter) and the pitching can be slow pitch or fast pitch. Slow pitch has
the following rules: ten players per side instead of nine, underhand pitching only (the ASA and NSA slow pitch arc is 6 to 12 feet; the USSSA arc is
three to ten feet, and the ISA arc is four to ten feet), seven innings instead
of nine, pitchers mound to home is 50 feet, 65 to 70 feet between the
bases, and a larger ball.
Monster ball, or 16-inch softball, is played like slow pitch, but only a
few of the fielders use gloves.
Options: Olympic softball (played only be women), fast (National
Fastpitch Association Womens Pro Fastpitch) or slow pitch league, monster ball, womens Pro Softball League (Amateur Softball Association),
designed from the player or managers POV
70 Speed Skating
Speed skating races on ice using special speed skater skates. In the Olympics there are ten speed skating events: the mens 500 meter, 1,000 meter,
1,500 meter, 5,000 meter, and 10,000 meter, and the womens 500 meter,
1,000 meter, 1,500 meter, 3,000 meter, and 5,000 meter.
Chapter 6
71 Squash
24
Chapter 6
72 Sumo Wrestling
Sumo wrestling is a national sport in Japan where two men are pitted
against each other in a clay ring. The first to step out of the circular
boundary or touch the ring with any part of his body except his feet has
lost the match. The yokozuna is the highest rank in sumo wrestling.
73 Surfing
Surfing is a water sport where riders perform wave-powered maneuvers
on a surfboard (short boards, funboards, longboards, and mini-mals). The
short board is a very maneuverable board for performing some classy
moves, but it is difficult to control, ride, paddle, and catch waves on. The
funboard is 7.5 feet long and has the stability of a longboard combined with
some of the maneuverability of a short board. The longboard (also called a
Malibu) has a very stable ride and is easy to catch waves on but is harder
to turn due to its length. The mini-mal is a mini version of the Malibu or
longboard, has the stability of a longboard, and due to its shorter length
has good maneuverability.
Wax or a deck grip is used in surfing so the surfers feet stay on the
board instead of sliding off and causing him to wipe out. From a belly
boarding position facing the shore, surfers catch a wave and stand on the
waxed board with their arms extended for balance and use their legs and
feet to ride the wave onto shore. In competition, points are scored on a
trick or maneuvers difficulty and execution.
74 Swimming
Swimming is a water sport where swimmers use their arms and legs to
propel themselves forward in the water as fast as they can go.
The races consist of four basic strokes: freestyle, backstroke, breaststroke, and butterfly.
Men and women compete separately in the 50-meter freestyle,
100-meter freestyle, 200-meter freestyle, 400-meter freestyle, 100-meter
backstroke, 200-meter backstroke, 100-meter breaststroke, 200-meter
breaststroke, 100-meter butterfly, 200-meter butterfly, 200-meter individual medley, 400-meter individual medley, 4x100-meter freestyle relay,
4x200-meter freestyle relay, and 4x100-meter medley relay. The men
compete in the 1,500-meter freestyle, and the women have a freestyle
race of 800 meters.
In synchronized swimming, timing is critical, as the time limits are
fairly rigid. For the duets, the technical routines are two minutes, 20 seconds long, while for the teams, they are two minutes, 50 seconds long.
The free routines are much longer. Duets compete in four-minute routines, while teams perform for five minutes.
Game Ideas
25
75 Table Tennis
Table tennis (or ping-pong) is similar to lawn tennis where players compete on a table nine feet long by five feet wide, 30 inches high off the
ground, with a six-inch-high net crossing the middle of the table. A game
can be singles or doubles matches.
Players switch service every five points. To win, a side must score 21
points and be two points ahead of their opponent(s). Hand-held paddles
are used to serve and volley the ball.
Four table tennis events are competed at the Olympic level: men singles, women singles, men doubles, and women doubles.
Options: professional, international, Olympic table tennis
76 Tennis
Tennis is played on a large court with rackets and a ball. The outdoor court
surface is made of asphalt, clay, concrete, grass, or stone granules. Indoor
court surfaces are made from wood or canvas. Tennis rackets are made of
wood, graphite, aluminum, or steel with gut or nylon strings inside the
rackets frame. Balls are rubber covered with cloth (dacron, nylon, or
wool).
A tennis game is won by scoring four points (where the points are 15,
30, 40, game), and the win must be by two points over the opponent. A set
consists of winning six games (at least two more than the opponent). A
match consists of winning two out of three sets or three out of five sets. In
each game, one player serves for the entire game, and every two games
players can switch sides. Tennis games can be singles, doubles, women or
mens games, or mixed doubles.
Options: pro, Olympic, Grand Prix, Davis Cup
77 Tobogganing
Tobogganing has sleds without runners made of hickory, ash, or maple
coasting on snow or ice. Four sledders sit on a toboggan that is six to eight
feet long and 1.5 feet wide.
Track and field are sporting events that take place on an oval track or
within its boundaries. These events are running, jumping, and throwing
objects for distance. Men complete in the 100 meters, 200 meters, 400
meters, 800 meters, 1,500 meters, 5,000 meters, 10,000 meters,
110-meter hurdles, 400-meter hurdles, 3,000-meter steeplechase,
20-kilometer walk, 50-kilometer walk, 4x100-meter relay, 4x400-meter
relay, marathon, high jump, long jump, triple jump, pole vault, shot put,
discus, javelin, hammer throw, and decathlon.
The decathlon competition involves a combination of ten track and field
events: the 100 meters, long jump, shot put, high jump, 400 meters,
110-meter hurdles, discus, pole vault, javelin, and 1,500 meters.
Chapter 6
26
Chapter 6
Women compete in the 100 meters, 200 meters, 400 meters, 800
meters, 1,500 meters, 5,000 meters, 10,000 meters, 20-kilometer walk,
100-meter hurdles, 400-meter hurdles, 4x100-meter relay, 4x400-meter
relay, marathon, high jump, long jump, triple jump, pole vault, shot put,
discus, javelin, heptathlon, and hammer throw.
The heptathlon competition involves a combination of seven track and
field events: the 100-meter hurdles, high jump, shot put, 200 meters, long
jump, javelin, and 800 meters.
The high jump is an unaided jump over a raised crossbar that is
between two uprights. The competitor who has safely jumped the highest
over the bar (without knocking it off the uprights) wins.
The long jump is where competitors leap from a take-off board into a
landing area of sand. The competitor with the longest jump (distance)
wins.
Triple jump is comprised of a hop, skip, and jump sequence where the
winner is the competitor with the longest distance.
The pole vault has the competitor using a flexible pole to vault over a
raised crossbar between two uprights where the competitor who has
safely vaulted the highest over the bar (without knocking it off the
uprights) wins.
The shot put is tossed with one hand within a circle and must land
inside the marked area; the winner is the one who has the longest
distance.
The discus is thrown within a circle and must land inside the marked
area where the winner is the one with the longest distance.
The javelin is thrown from behind an arc and must land inside the
marked area; the winner is the one with the longest distance.
The hammer throw (a ball connected by steel wire to a ring) is thrown
within a circle and must land inside the marked area where the winner is
the one with the longest distance.
79 Trapshooting
Trapshooters use a shotgun to shoot saucer-shaped targets (called clay
pigeons). A pigeon is sprung from a trap six yards in front of the shooter.
Handicap games have the shooter standing 18 to 27 yards behind the trap.
80 Triathlon
The Olympic Games competition includes only the classic distance
triathlon, which is made up of a 1,500-meter swimming event, a 40-kilometer cycling event, and a 10-kilometer running event.
Other various multisport triathlon events throughout the world include
the long distance triathlon (4,000 meters swimming, 120 kilometers
cycling, 30 kilometers running), the ironman (3,800 meters swimming,
180 kilometers cycling, 42.2 kilometers running), the short distance
duathlon (10 kilometers running, 40 kilometers cycling, 5 kilometers running), the long distance duathlon (10 kilometers running, 60 kilometers
Game Ideas
27
81 Volleyball
Volleyball can be played indoors or outdoors, even at the beach. A standard
volleyball court is 60 feet long by 30 feet wide with a net dividing the two
sides that is 30 feet long by 3 feet long, hanging 8 feet from the ground.
The ball is 26 inches in circumference. In standard volleyball, each team
has six players (three near the net and three standing a few feet behind
them).
Points are scored by the serving side when their opponents fail to
return the ball over the net within three contacts. The volleyball cannot be
caught or thrownjust hit. If the serving side fails to return the ball
within three contacts or the serve doesnt go over the net, they lose the
serve (also called side out). Upon becoming the serving side, players
rotate their position. To win a volleyball game, a side must score 15 points
or more, winning by two points.
Options: professional, beach, Olympic
82 Wakeboarding
Wakeboarding is a water sport where boarders are propelled and attached
by a rope to a motorboat. Wakeboarders perform spins, flips, and air
maneuvers through a water course with ramps and sliders. Wakeboarding
is a combination of surfing, skateboarding, snowboarding, and water skiing. A wakeboard looks like a snowboard with a pair of bindings attached to
it. The wakeboarder carves turns with body leans and by rocking the
board. The performance is judged on the 100-point system for technical
difficulty (execution, worth 33.3 points), in-air acrobats (intensity,
worth 33.4 points), and the seamless flow of the routine (composition,
worth 33.3 points).
Water polo is a water sport where seven players per team (including the
goalkeeper) compete in a pool 20 to 30 meters long by 10 to 20 meters
wide and try to score by getting a ball into the opponents goal (two netted
goal posts, three meters apart with a crossbar). Water polo is similar to
soccer but with hand throws and swimming in lieu of kicks and running.
Canoe polo has four boated players and a boated goalie paddling their
crafts in a rectangular pool and scoring when the whole ball passes into
the floating goal.
Chapter 6
83 Water Polo
28
Chapter 6
84 Water Skiing
Water skiing is a sport where the skier is propelled forward by a motorized boat. Competition water skiing is divided into three events: slalom,
figures (formerly called tricks), and jumping, with a winner in each event
and an overall winner. Men and women compete separately.
Slalom is about strength, timing, balance, and beauty. The skier is
pulled through a set of six buoys, each the same fixed distance from the
boat path. Top speed in slalom is 36 mph for men and 34 mph for women.
If the skier successfully rounds all six buoys, the rope is shortened a predetermined amount, and the skier attempts to negotiate the course again.
The figures event is about agility, balance, speed, and control. Each
skier has two 20-second passes to execute as many tricks as possible.
Each trick has a listed, preset number of points, depending on the difficulty of the trick.
Jump is an event where speed, pose, and drama are crucial. Each skier
is given three passes by the jump ramp. The ramp is around 6.5 meters
long, around 4.2 meters wide, and can be set at three different heights.
Distance is the key to jumping, and the longest of the three jumps counts.
85 Wrestling
Wrestling is a sport involving two people (or sides), where the objective is
to pin your opponents back to the mat for a certain number of seconds or
win by scoring the most points. Wrestling has several forms, including
freestyle, Greco-Roman, and professional (WWF, WCW). Each offensive
and defensive maneuver has a predetermined point value for a successfully executed move.
In Greco-Roman wrestling, holds below the waist or leg holds are not
allowed, nor are leg moves or hooks. In freestyle wrestling, takedowns
and being in control are key elements, where leg and arm maneuvers,
holds, and hooks are allowed.
The standard wrestling mat is 24 feet square where the wrestlers start
the first of three periods standing, and the next two periods they alternate
starting in the referees position (one wrestler is down on his hands and
knees as the other is positioned on top holding the opponents elbow and
waist). Periods in high school last two minutes each, while in college the
first period lasts two minutes and the next two periods last three minutes.
In a roped ring (similar to boxing) two professional wrestlers (single
match), four to six wrestlers (tag team match), or multiple wrestlers (battle royal, king of the mat/ring) try to pin, throw an opponent(s) out of the
ring, or incapacitate the opponent(s) to win. Flying off the turn buckle or
ropes onto an opponent, lifting an opponent high into the air and slamming
him onto the mat, or firmly placing an extended foot in the chest of an
approaching opponent are samples of the kinds of audience-pleasing
maneuvers that the professional use.
Game Ideas
29
Options: pro (World Wrestling Federation, World Championship Wrestling, Wausau Wrestling Association, Southern Championship Wrestling),
college (mens and collegiate varsity womens freestyle wrestling), Olympic freestyle, and Greco-Roman
Board Games
1 Backgammon
2 Checkers
3 Chess
4 Dominoes
5 Go
6 Hangman (like Wheel of Fortune)
7 Mahjong
8 Othello
Chapter 6
Simulations
30
Chapter 6
8 Run a corporation
9 Manage a gaming company
10 Manage a hospital
11 Manage a movie studio
12 Manage a railroad
13 Manage a restaurant chain
14 Manage an amusement park
15 Manage a university
16 Run for senator
17 Operate a nuclear power plant
18 Simulate the stock market
19 Operate a semi-truck for cross-country delivery
20 Drive a motorcycle across the country
21 Pilot an airplane: Cessna, 727, 747, F-16, F-18
22 Be a brain surgeon
23 Be a doctor: diagnose patients
24 Run a car rental company
25 Manage a cinema chain
26 Manage a cruise line
27 Operate a golf resort
28 Manage a major newspaper
29 Manage a pizza delivery restaurant
30 Manage a resort island
31 Manage a zoo
32 Manage an overnight delivery carrier
33 Run for president
34 Simulate a human internal disease
35 Simulate an ant colony
36 Operate a brokerage company
Science
Ecology
1 Cleaning up toxic waste sites
2 Dealing with New York Citys landfill waste
3 Dealing with nuclear reactors
4 Fighting air pollution
5 Fighting land pollution
6 Fighting water pollution
7 Helping U.S. farmers
8 Helping world hunger
9 Managing the world oil supply
10 Saving coral reefs
11 Saving rain forests
12 Saving whales
Game Ideas
31
Chapter 6
Biology
32
Chapter 6
46 Biometeorology
47 Biosociology
48 Exobiology
49 Marine biology
50 Phytogeography
51 Zoogeography
52 Pathology
53 Physiology
54 Cell physiology
55 Embryology
56 Endocrinology
57 Pharmacology
58 Physiological chemistry
59 Phytopathology
60 Epidemiology
61 Gnotobiotics
62 Parasitology
63 Taxonomy
Chemistry
1 Organic chemistry
2 Inorganic chemistry
3 Colloid chemistry
4 Geochemistry
5 Polymer chemistry
6 Synthetic chemistry
7 Analytical chemistry
8 Analytical instrumentation
9 Qualitative analysis
10 Quantitative analysis
11 Radio chemistry
12 Applied chemistry
13 Agricultural chemistry
14 Industrial chemistry
15 Water and waste chemistry
16 Biochemistry
17 Biogeochemistry
18 Chemotherapy
19 Medicinal chemistry
20 Molecular biophysics
21 Pathological chemistry
22 Physical chemistry
23 Chemical thermodynamics
24 Electrochemistry
25 Nuclear chemistry
26 Photochemistry
Game Ideas
33
27 Radiation chemistry
28 Structural chemistry
29 Surface chemistry
Chemistry Topics
1 Decomposition
2 Evaporation
3 Fermentation
4 Pasteurization
5 Spontaneous combustion
Earth Science
1 Geology
2 Geography
3 Meteorology
4 Water erosion
5 Wind erosion
Physics
1 Mechanical
2 Fluid mechanical
3 Solid mechanical
4 Thermodynamics
5 Optics (light)
6 Electrical
7 Magnetic
8 Acoustics (sound)
9 Atomic mechanical
10 Nuclear mechanical
11 Solid state mechanical
Astronomy
1 Astrophysicist
2 Cosmologist
3 Celestrialmechanics
4 Radio astronomy
Chapter 6
Math
34
Chapter 6
7 Prime numbers
8 Word problems
History
People
1 Alexander the Great
2 Charlemagne
3 Cleopatra
4 George Patton
5 Ghengis Khan
6 Joan of Arc
7 Julius Caesar
8 Kublai Khan
9 Napoleon Bonaparte
10 William the Conqueror
11 Gandhi (a peaceful objective game)
Time Periods
1 Assyrian Empire
2 Aztec Empire
3 Babylonian Empire
4 Byzantine Empire
5 Carthaginian Empire
6 Chinese Dynasty
7 Colonial America
8 Egyptian Empire
9 Germany Unification
10 Great Britain Empire
11 Grecian Empire
12 India
13 Industrial America
14 Japanese Empire
15 Persian Empire
16 Roman Empire
17 Sumerian Empire
Wars
1
2
3
5
6
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
35
Chapter 6
Game Ideas
36
Chapter 6
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
Game Ideas
58
59
60
61
62
63
64
65
66
67
68
69
70
71
72
73
74
75
76
77
78
79
Chapter 6
52
53
54
55
56
57
37
38
Chapter 6
80
81
82
83
84
85
86
87
88
89
90
91
92
93
94
95
96
97
Revolution of 1848 or February Revolutionpart of the French Revolution that overthrew the monarchy of Louis Philippe and established the Second Republic
Russo-Japanese War, 1904-5imperialistic conflict that grew out of
the rival designs of Russia and Japan on Manchuria and Korea
Russo-Turkish War, 1768-74 (first)an indirect result of Russian
interference in Poland. A second Russo-Turkish War broke out in
1787, and in 1788 Joseph II entered the war as Catherines ally. The
third Russo-Turkish War of 1806-12 started in 1806 when the energetic Sultan Selim III deposed the Russophile governors of Moldavia
and Walachia.
Seven Years War, 1756-63worldwide war fought in Europe, North
America, and India between France, Austria, Russia, Saxony, Sweden, and (after 1762) Spain on the one side and Prussia, Great Britain, and Hanover on the other
Spanish American War, 1898brief conflict between Spain and the
United States arising out of Spanish policies in Cuba
Spanish Succession, War of the, 1701-14last of the general European wars caused by the efforts of King Louis XIV to extend French
power
Tripolitan War, 1801-5brought a temporary halt to the pirate activities of the Barbary States
Ten Years War, 1868-78struggle for Cuban independence from
Spain
Thirty Years War, 1618-48general European war fought mainly in
Germany
U.S. Civil War, 1861-1865America at war (North vs. South)
Here are some Civil War battles and campaigns. Even if a single battle or campaign is not enough to design a complete game, perhaps
combining a few of them together would make a good game.
Researching this list should be a great start and aid you in your game
design.
U.S. CW: Stonewall Jacksons Shenandoah Valley Campaign, Va.
(Battle of Kernstown, Battle of McDowell, Battle of Front Royal,
First Battle of Winchester, Battle of Cross Keys, Battle of Port
Republic)
U.S. CW: Battle of Seven Pines (Fair Oaks), Va.
U.S. CW: Seven Days Battles Around Richmond, Va. (Battle of Oak
Grove, Battle of Mechanicsburg, Battle of Gaines Mill, Battle of
Savages Station, Battle of Glendale (Frasers Farm), Battle of
Malvern Hill)
U.S. CW: Battle of Cedar Mountain, Va.
U.S. CW: Battle of Second Manassas (Bull Run), Va.
U.S. CW: Battle of Chantilly (Ox Hill), Va.
U.S. CW: Siege and capture of Harpers Ferry, Va. (now W.Va.)
U.S. CW: Battles of South Mountain and Antietam (Sharpsburg), Md.
98
99
100
101
102
103
104
105
106
107
108
109
110
111
112
113
114
115
116
117
118
119
120
121
122
123
124
125
126
127
128
129
130
131
132
133
39
Chapter 6
Game Ideas
40
Chapter 6
134
135
136
137
138
139
140
141
142
143
144
145
146
147
148
149
150
151
152
153
154
155
156
157
158
159
160
161
162
163
164
165
166
167
168
Game Ideas
41
182
183
184
185
186
187
188
189
190
191
192
193
194
195
196
197
198
199
200
201
Here are some U.S. Revolutionary War battles and campaigns. Even
if a single battle or campaign is not enough to design a complete
game, perhaps combining a few of them together would make a good
game. Researching this list should be a great start and aid you in
your game design.
U.S. RW: Paul Reveres Ride
U.S. RW: Battle of Concord and Lexington
U.S. RW: Battle of Bennington
U.S. RW: Battle of Saratoga
U.S. RW: Battle of Bunker Hill
U.S. RW: Battle of Monmouth
U.S. RW: Siege of Boston
U.S. RW: Siege of Charleston
U.S. RW: Battle of Valcour Bay
U.S. RW: Battle of White Plains
U.S. RW: Battle of Trenton
U.S. RW: Battle of Princeton
U.S. RW: Battle of Ridgefield, Conn.
U.S. RW: Battle of Long Island
U.S. RW: Battle of Brandywine
U.S. RW: First Battle of Saratoga
U.S. RW: Battle of Germantown
U.S. RW: Second Battle of Saratoga
U.S. RW: Battle of Camden
U.S. RW: Battle of Fishing Creek, S.C.
Chapter 6
42
Chapter 6
202
203
204
205
206
207
208
209
210
211
212
213
214
215
216
217
218
219
220
221
222
223
224
225
226
227
228
229
230
231
232
233
234
235
236
237
238
239
Game Ideas
43
265
266
267
268
269
270
Chapter 6
246
247
248
249
250
251
252
253
254
255
256
257
258
259
260
261
262
263
264
44
Chapter 6
Exploration
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
45
Chapter 6
Game Ideas
46
Chapter 6
Literature
The Bible
1 David
2 Joseph
3 Abraham
4 Jesus Christ
5 Gideon
6 Noah
7 Samson
8 Moses
9 King Solomon
10 Daniel
11 Jonah
12 Paul
Classics
1 A Wrinkle in Time by Madeleine LEngle
2 Aeneid by Virgil
3 Aesops Fables by Aesop
4 Aladdin (The Arabian Nights Entertainments) by Scheherazade
5 Ali Baba and the Forty Thieves by Scheherazade
6 Alice in Wonderland by Lewis Carroll
7 Through the Looking Glass (And What Alice Found There) by Lewis
Carroll
8 The Amityville Horror by Jay Anson
9 Animal Farm by George Orwell
10 Anna and the King of Siam by Margaret Landon
11 Anne of Avonlea by L. M. Montgomery
12 Around the World in 80 Days by Jules Verne
13 Black Arrow by Robert Louis Stevenson
14 Black Beauty by Anna Sewell
15 The Black Cauldron by Lloyd Alexander
16 Blood Island by H. P. Lovecraft
17 Bluebeard by Charles Perrault
18 The Body Snatcher by Robert Louis Stevenson
19 The Book of Hugh Flower by Lorna Beers
20 The Borrowers by Mary Norton
21 Brave New World by Aldous Huxley
22 The Brothers Karamazov by Fyodor Dostoevsky
23 Buck Rogers by Phil Nolan
24 The Caine Mutiny by Herman Wouk
25 Candide by Voltaire
26 The Canterbury Tales by Geoffrey Chaucer
27 Captain Blood by Rafael Sabatini
28 Captain Horatio Hornblower by C.S. Forester
29 The Castle of Otranto by Horace Walpole
30 Charlie and the Chocolate Factory by Roald Dahl
31 Charlottes Web by E. B. White
32 The Count of Monte Cristo by Alexandre Dumas
33 Crime and Punishment by Fyodor Dostoevsky
34 Cyrano de Bergerac by Edmond Rostand
47
Chapter 6
Game Ideas
48
Chapter 6
Game Ideas
49
Mythology
Egyptian Gods: Horus, Hathor, Anabis, Isis, Nepthys, Osiris, Re, Thoth,
Amon-Re, Ptah, Tefnut, Set
Roman Gods
Jupiter
Juno
Greek Gods
Zeus
Hera
Pluto
Hades
Apollo
Bacchus
Ceres
Diana
Mars
Mercury
Apollo
Dionysus
Demeter
Artemis
Ares
Hermes
Minerva
Neptune
Saturn
Cronus
Venus
Vesta
Vulcan
Athena
Poseidon
Aphrodite
Hestia
Hephaestus
Heroes
Hercules
Jason
Orpheus
Oedipus (king of Thebes, killed his father and married his mother)
The Trojan War
Theseus (King Minos and the Labyrinths Minotaur)
Mythological Creatures
Irish Mythology
1 Cooley Cattle Raid
2 The Fenian Cycle (or Ossianic Cycle)
3 The Ulster Cycle
Chapter 6
Pan dwells in the forest and pastures, Nymphs: Dryads (dwells in the forest), Nereids (dwells in the sea)
Argus, Centaur, Cerberus, Chimaera, Cyclops, Giants, Gorgon, Griffin,
Harpy, Hydra, Medusa, Minotaur, Pegasus, Phoenix, Unicorn, Atlantis,
Elysian Fields, River Styx
50
Chapter 6
Norse Mythology
Odin, ruler of Asgard where the great hall of Valhalla resides
Frigg, Odins wife
Balder, God of goodness and harmony
Bragi, God of poetry
Frey, Goddess of love and beauty
Hel, God of the underworld
Loki, Evil son, a trickster
Thor, God of thunder and lightning
Ragnarok, the great final battle
Authors
Hans Christian Andersen
1 The Emperors New Clothes
2 The Rags
3 The Tinder Box
4 The Ugly Duckling
5 Thumbelina
Earl Derr Biggers
1 Charlie Chan: House Without a Key
2 Charlie Chan: The Black Camel
3 Charlie Chan: The Chinese Parrot
Albert Camus
1 Caligula
2 The Fall
3 The Plague
4 The Stranger
Anton P. Chekhov
1 The Cherry Orchard
2 The Three Sisters
3 Uncle Vanya
Michael Crichton
1 Airframe
2 Congo
3 Disclosure
4 Eaters of the Dead
5 Jurassic Park
6 Rising Sun
7 Sphere
8 The Andromeda Strain
9 The Great Train Robbery
Game Ideas
51
Euripides
1 Alcestis
2 Andromache
3 Bacchae
4 Cyclops
5 Electra
6 Hecuba
7 Helena
8 Heracles
9 Hippolytus
10 Iphigenia in Aulis
11 Iphigenia in Tauris
12 Medea
13 Orestes
14 The Children of Heracles
15 The Phoenician Women
16 The Suppliants
17 The Trojan Women
Chapter 6
52
Chapter 6
Game Ideas
53
Chapter 6
Arthur Miller
1 All My Sons
2 Death of a Salesman
54
Chapter 6
9 Silence
10 The Masque of the Red Death
11 The Raven
12 Morella
13 Ligeia
14 William Wilson
15 The Purloined Letter
16 The Murders in the Rue Morgue
17 The Mystery of Marie Roget
Alexander S. Pushkin
1 Eugene Onegin
2 The Bronze Horseman
3 Boris Godunov
Jean Paul Sarte
1 The Flies
2 No Exit
3 Dirty Hands
4 The Condemned of Altona
William Shakespeare
1 A Midsummer Nights Dream
2 Alls Well That Ends Well
3 Antony and Cleopatra
4 As You Like It
5 Coriolanus
6 Cymbeline
7 Hamlet
8 Henry V
9 Henry VI
10 Henry VIII
11 Julius Caesar
12 King John
13 King Lear
14 Loves Labours Lost
15 Macbeth
16 Measure for Measure
17 Much Ado About Nothing
18 Othello
19 Pericles
20 Richard II
21 Richard III
22 Romeo and Juliet
23 The Comedy of Errors
24 The Merchant of Venice
Game Ideas
55
August Strindberg
1 A Dream Play
2 Dance of Death
3 Miss Julie
4 The Bridal Crown
5 The Creditors
6 The Father
7 The Red Room
8 The Spook Sonata
Chapter 6
John Steinbeck
1 The Winter of Our Discontent
2 The Grapes of Wrath
3 Of Mice and Men
4 Tortilla Flat
5 Cannery Row
6 Sweet Thursday
7 East of Eden
56
Chapter 6
Mark Twain
1 Huckleberry Finn
2 Tom Sawyer
3 The Prince and the Pauper
4 A Connecticut Yankee in King Arthurs Court
5 Puddnhead Wilson
6 The Mysterious Stranger
Oscar Wilde
1 Picture of Dorian Gray
2 The Importance of Being Earnest
3 Lady Windermeres Fan
Tennessee Williams
1 The Glass Menagerie
2 A Streetcar Named Desire
3 Cat On a Hot Tin Roof
4 The Rose Tattoo
5 Camino Real
6 The Night of the Iguana
Languages
1 Learn French
2 Learn Italian
3 Learn Chinese
4 Learn Japanese
5 Learn Spanish
6 Learn Russian
7 Learn Hebrew
8 Learn sign language
Art
How can artwork be made into a game?
We could design a game in which we are trying to locate various pieces
of artwork by famous painters. The museum would like you to acquire a
Renoir, and you venture into the world seeking Luncheon of the Boating
Party. Or as in the film The Thomas Crown Affair, you desire to steal
famous works of art and replace them with perfect forgeries.
You can even look at a masterpiece and create a story from it. Imagine
what actions and situations preceded the painting, as though it were a
photograph.
Game Ideas
57
1 Josef Albers
2 Jean Arp
3 Frdric Bazille
4 Umberto Boccioni
5 Sandro Botticelli
6 Michelangelo Buonarroti
7 Gustave Caillebotte
8 Mary Cassatt
9 Caravaggio
10 Annibale Carracci
11 Paul Czanne
12 Marc Chagall
13 Salvador Dal
14 Leonardo da Vinci
15 Giorgio de Chirico
16 Edgar Degas
17 Piero della Francesca
18 Albrecht Drer
19 Max Ernst
20 Maurits Cornelis (M.C.) Escher
21 Paul Gauguin
22 Domenico Ghirlandaio
23 Francisco Goya
24 George Grosz
25 Winslow Homer
26 Frida Kahlo
27 Wassily Kandinsky
28 Paul Klee
Chapter 6
Artists
58
Chapter 6
29 Gustav Klimt
30 Roy Lichtenstein
31 Joan Mir Ren Magritte
32 Ren Magritte
33 douard Manet
34 Franz Marc
35 Henri Matisse
36 Peter Max
37 Amadeo Modigliani
38 Claude Monet
39 Piet Mondrian
40 Grandma Moses
41 Edvard Munch
42 Georgia OKeeffe
43 Pablo Picasso
44 Camille Pissarro
45 Giovanni Battista Piazzetta
46 Jackson Pollock
47 Raphael (Raffaello Sanzio)
48 Robert Rauschenberg
49 Man Ray
50 Rembrandt van Rijn
51 Diego Rivera
52 Pierre-Auguste Renoir
53 Norman Rockwell
54 Henri Rousseau
55 Peter Paul Rubens
56 Alfred Sisley
57 Titian
58 Henri de Toulouse-Lautrec
59 Paolo Uccello
60 Hubert van Eyck
61 Jan van Eyck
62 Vincent van Gogh
63 Victor Vasarely
64 Jan Vermeer
65 Andy Warhol
66 Grant Wood
67 James Abbott McNeill Whistler
Music
How can music be made into a game?
We could go back in time and aid each composer in creating his or her
masterpiece. We could use the music as the basis for our game design as
in Tchaikovskys Peter and the Wolf or Rossinis William Tell
Game Ideas
59
Chapter 6
Composers
60
Chapter 6
Game Ideas
61
When obtaining game ideas from a film (or movie), we want to utilize the
films premise (plot, theme, and action) and not its character names, costumes, creature design and look, and names of places and objects.
The film Alien has a unique character (the alien), a specific spaceship
design, a famous cast, and particular character names. If we want to mimic
Alien in our game design, first we would call our game something interesting and descriptive like Space Predator or Space Cannibal to get the
Chapter 6
62
Chapter 6
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
63
Chapter 6
Game Ideas
64
Chapter 6
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
61
62
63
64
65
66
67
68
65
Chapter 6
Game Ideas
66
Chapter 6
69
70
71
72
73
74
75
76
77
78
79
80
81
Defending Your Life: A look at examining your life and fears in the
afterlife where existence is perfect, one can fall in love, and you can
eat everything without gaining any weight.
Die Hard: A New York City vacationing police officer visits his
ex-wife in Los Angeles at Christmas when terrorists take over the
large Japanese corporation building he is in.
Die Hard 2: Die Harder: A New York City vacationing police officer
awaiting his ex-wifes arrival at the airport at Christmas confronts
terrorists who have control of the airport.
Dirty Rotten Scoundrels: Two con men: one is a wealthy, elderly
European gentleman who is partners with the local chief of police,
and the other is a younger American hustler thought to be the
Jackal, a legendary con artist. After joining forces as mentor and
student, they decide to challenge each other in a winner-take-all
contest where a wealthy American soap queen is the target of the
con (she turns out to be the real Jackal).
D.O.A.: A college professor is given poison and has 24 hours to find
his killer as police suspect him of murder.
Edward Scissorhands: A scientist creates a boy-creature with scissors instead of hands. He unexpectedly dies leaving the boy to deal
with suburbia and an overly friendly Avon saleslady.
Eight Heads in a Duffel Bag: A mobster is hired to kill eight mob
low-lifes, and as proof he must return their heads to get payment. At
the airport, a Mexico bound college student and his girlfriends neurotic family accidentally receive the mobsters bag, which looks like
his bag. An adventure begins when the mobster seeks to recover his
bag and the college student deals with his new discovery and lack of
clothes.
Eight Millimeter: A detective is hired by a wealthy widow who
desires to know the truth about her deceased husband and his
involvement in illegal snuff films.
Empire Records: An independent record stores last day before it
joins an uncaring chain. The stores crazy staff (suicidal, sex-starved,
and kleptos) keep the manager on his toes as he tries to keep business going and acquire the needed cash to buy the store for himself.
The End: A terminally ill man decides to end his suffering and
attempts various methods of committing suicide.
End of Days: Satan must have an heir, and an alcoholic ex-cop is the
only hero who can save a young woman from this fate.
Enemy Mine: Two warring planets pilots (a human and a reptile
man) crash onto a planet where they are captured as slaves, and they
must unite to survive and escape.
Eraser: A federal marshal fakes elaborate deaths for people entering
the Witness Protection Program.
82
83
84
85
86
87
88
89
90
91
92
93
94
95
96
97
67
Chapter 6
Game Ideas
68
Chapter 6
98
99
100
101
102
103
104
105
106
107
108
109
110
Footloose: In a Midwest town controlled by a minister, dancing is forbidden, and a teen newcomer from the city tries to change public
views on rock music and dancing.
Freejack: Its a futuristic time when the super rich can buy young,
healthy bodies from the past to prolong their longevity. A racecar
driver assumed dead is transported into the future where he decides
to run away as a freejack.
Frequency: A modern day New York police officer discovers that he
can communicate with the past by operating his fathers old ham
radio. He can talk to his father who is living in 1969 to prevent the
fathers accidental death in a warehouse fire, his mothers murder,
and other events, which drastically alters the future.
From Dusk Till Dawn: Two vicious escaped criminals pick up a minister and his two teens and rendezvous at a sleazy biker bar that is
unknowingly operated by vampires.
The Game: An investment banker receives an unusual birthday present from his distant brother, a real life role-playing game that taps
into your life, business, and finances and blurs the line between reality, terror, and the game.
Ghost: An investment consultant deeply in love is murdered.
Through a fake psychic, he is able to communicate and must solve
his murder and protect his lover.
Ghostbusters: When college grants are terminated, three paranormal investigators go into business as New York City gets plagued
by the spirit world.
Gone in 60 Seconds: In order to save his brothers life, a retired legendary car thief must steal 50 specific modeled cars in one night by
recruiting his old associates.
Gotcha: A campus paintball assassination gameplayer on vacation in
Europe winds up getting involved with an exotic female international spy.
Grosse Point Blank: A hitman returns to attend his tenth year high
school reunion only to discover that his current target is the father
of his high school sweetheart and an interest to his number one
rival.
Groundhog Day: An obnoxious weatherman covering the groundhog
shadow story in Punxatawney, PA is trapped in a bizarre space-time
continuum of repeating the same day and events until he finds love,
happiness, and the meaning of life.
Hackers: Teenage cyber geeks get outhacked by a super hacker who
frames them for industrial conspiracy. The teens must use their
techno skills to resolve the problem as police, federal security, and
the superhacker all want to delete them.
Heaven Can Wait (Here Comes Mr. Jordan): A second string football
player (or a boxer) is taken too early by his guardian angel and is
111
112
113
114
115
116
117
118
119
120
121
122
123
124
125
69
Chapter 6
Game Ideas
70
Chapter 6
126 Labyrinth: A teen girl wishes for the Goblin King to take her baby
brother. Then, regretting her plea, she must enter the ever-changing
labyrinth and reach the castle before her brother becomes a goblin
forever.
127 Ladyhawke: In medieval times, a young thief escapes a fortress
prison and is saved by a knight, an ex-commander of the guards. The
thief must then protect the knights hawk, which turns into his lover
each night, while the knight becomes a wolf. Through adventures
and a repenting priests dream, the cursed couple must travel to the
fortress and face their destiny, their enslaver.
128 Last Action Hero: A youngster who idolizes a comic book character
(a movie, police action hero) gets a golden ticket to enter his favorite
movie world. The boy becomes his idols newfound friend and accidentally frees the evil villains from the movie world into the real
world. This forces his idol to come back to the real world to track
down and stop the villains. In the real world, their counterparts, the
real actors, interact with them at their latest movies premiere.
129 The Last Starfighter: A trailer park teen loner becomes an expert at a
newly arrived video game that unknowingly trains intergalactic
pilots in a real-life space war. The teen is recruited in an adventure
that he thought was only a game.
130 Lifeforce: A beautiful female space vampire in London drains human
life, not blood, and creates disappearing zombies.
131 Little Shop of Horrors: A strange plant attracts huge sales to a flower
shop, but its timid owner soon learns that his rapidly growing, popular plant needs warm human blood to survive.
132 Logans Run: In a futuristic domed world, pleasure-seeking people
exist for only 30 years, until a young officer is forced to either die in
the Coliseum or run away to find sanctuary. He gets hunted by his
best friend and fellow officer who eagerly wants him dead.
133 The Long Kiss Goodnight: A quiet engaged schoolteacher hires a
black private investigator to discover her past, which amnesia has
wiped out. As the search for truth continues, her nightmares about
her past and the CIA begin to evolve the brown-haired teacher into
her former self, a blonde, highly trained CIA assassin.
134 Lord of Illusions: A New York private investigator gets involved with
the widow of the magician he is investigating. A demonic cult with a
resurrecting demon and his psycho followers and the world of magicians unveil the secrets behind the seemingly obvious.
135 Made in Heaven: To remain eternal lovers, two heavenly souls are
reborn on Earth and must find each other or lose each other forever.
136 The Man Who Knew Too Little: A video store clerk from Iowa visits
his successful brother in London as his own birthday surprise. His
brother is having a very important business party with clients and
decides to send his naive American birthday boy on a special night
out, participating in a real-life role-playing theatre experience. He
137
138
139
140
141
142
143
144
145
146
71
Chapter 6
Game Ideas
72
Chapter 6
147 Night of the Living Dead: Space radiation creates flesh-eating zombies from the recently deceased as a group of scared humans occupy
an isolated farmhouse.
148 The Ninth Gate: An unscrupulous rare-book dealer gets hired by a
wealthy publishing mogul to search and authenticate three copies of
a 17th-century book, which has secret writings that can forcefully
enslave the devil.
149 Not Without My Daughter: An American woman married to an Arab
medical doctor travels to Iran only to find out that she has no rights,
doesnt speak the language, and since her husband has taken her
passport she cant leave the country.
150 Oceans Eleven: A gang of eleven friends decide to rob five Las Vegas
casinos at the same time.
151 The Omen: An American diplomat adopts the son of Satan who has
special powers. Sequels follow Damien (son of Satan) throughout his
life.
152 Other Peoples Money: A corporate raiders computer indicates top
profitable companies that are ready for a takeover like the New England Wire and Cable, a family owned company that is worth more
sold than to leave it operating. Whats a raider to do when a prime
target is worth more to his pocket, but the owners beautiful lawyer
daughter has stolen his heart?
153 Out of Towners: A naive Ohio couples misadventures in New York
City, where everything goes awry.
154 Planet of the Apes: A member of a space team accidentally lands on a
planet where apes rule and humans are their slaves.
155 Poseidon Adventure: A cruise ship capsizes and the surviving passengers must roam the leaking upside-down ship and survive until help
arrives.
156 Predator: A space-hunting alien visits Earth seeking humans as
trophies.
157 Proof of Life: When an American engineer is kidnapped by South
American anti-government guerrillas, a professional hostage negotiator is hired and begins to have an interest in his assignments wife.
158 Pure Luck (or La Chevre): An accident-prone heiress with extremely
bad luck disappears in Mexico, and a hard-nosed detective and a
clumsy accountant (himself a bad luck magnet) travel south to find
and rescue her.
159 Ringmaster: A trash TV show host must interview perverts, misfits,
and psychos to keep his ratings high and his addicted audience tuned
in.
160 The Rock: At the impenetrable prison on Alcatraz Island, a general
with a deep interest in settling a military benefit issue holds hostages and has a deadly gas bomb that will be unleashed upon San
Francisco. A biochemical weapons specialist and an ex-prisoner, the
161
162
163
164
165
166
167
168
169
170
171
172
173
73
Chapter 6
Game Ideas
74
Chapter 6
174 Total Recall: With nightly dreams of visiting Mars, a married construction worker buys an implanted vacation where he is a secret
agent in search of alien artifacts and interacts with the mutant
underground while evading government assassins. When he awakes,
his co-workers, his wife, and government agents want him dead,
forcing him to try to discover whether its all a dream or reality.
175 Wages of Fear: Four eager citizens who desperately want to leave a
Central American poor, desolate town volunteer for a suicide mission to transport trucks of nitroglycerine to extinguish a raging well
fire 300 treacherous miles away. Each person will receive $2,000,
enough money to happily leave town.
177 The Warriors: At a New York City street gang rally, the leader of
New Yorks toughest and largest gang is assassinated. The Warriors,
a Brooklyn-Coney Island gang, are mistakenly blamed for the murder, and they must safely return home as the word is spread through
the radio to destroy the Warriors.
178 West World: An adult resort island where human-like robots in a
western fantasy town interact with human vacationers until an electric malfunction turns friendly robots into terrorizing ones.
179 White Mans Burden: A reverse of life concept where blacks have all
the wealth and power and the white race struggles. A bigoted black
CEO fires the white main character who kidnaps his black boss and
shows him how the other half lives.
180 Wishmaster: An evil genie grants wishes to his victims in a destructive and evil version of their desires.